Alvarion Technologies IF-24-SYNC Broadband Wireless Access System User Manual
Alvarion Ltd. Broadband Wireless Access System Users Manual
Contents
- 1. Users Manual
- 2. Appendix
Users Manual
BreezeACCESS II Version 4.3 Revision 3.0 June 2003 System Manual Cat. No. 213397 Revision 3.0 © 2003 by Alvarion Ltd. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced in any material form without the written permission of the copyright owner. Trade Names Alvarion®, BreezeACCESS®, BreezeCOM®, BreezeLINK®, BreezePHONE®, BreezeNET®, WALKair®, WALKnet®, are trade names or trademarks of Alvarion Ltd. Other brand and product names are trade names or trademarks of their respective owners. Statement of Conditions The information contained in this manual is subject to change without notice. Alvarion shall not be liable for errors contained herein or for incidental or consequential damages in connection with the furnishing, performance, or use of this manual or equipment supplied with it. Warranties; Disclaimers All Alvarion Ltd. (Alvarion) products purchased from Alvarion or through any of Alvarion’s authorized resellers are subject to the following warranty and product liability terms and conditions. Exclusive Warranty Alvarion warrants that the Product hardware it supplies and the tangible media on which any software is installed, under normal use and conditions, will be free from significant defects in materials and workmanship for a period of fourteen (14) months from the date of shipment of a given Product to Purchaser (the Warranty Period). Alvarion will, at its sole option and as Purchaser’s sole remedy, repair or replace any defective Product in accordance with Alvarion’ standard RMA procedure. Disclaimer (a) UNITS OF PRODUCT (INCLUDING ALL THE SOFTWARE) DELIVERED TO PURCHASER HEREUNDER ARE NOT FAULT-TOLERANT AND ARE NOT DESIGNED, MANUFACTURED OR INTENDED FOR USE OR RESALE IN APPLICATIONS WHERE THE FAILURE, MALFUNCTION OR INACCURACY OF PRODUCTS CARRIES A RISK OF DEATH OR BODILY INJURY OR SEVERE PHYSICAL OR ENVIRONMENTAL DAMAGE (HIGH RISK ACTIVITIES). HIGH RISK ACTIVITIES MAY INCLUDE, BUT ARE NOT LIMITED TO, USE AS PART OF ON-LINE CONTROL SYSTEMS IN HAZARDOUS ENVIRONMENTS REQUIRING FAIL-SAFE PERFORMANCE, SUCH AS IN THE OPERATION OF NUCLEAR FACILITIES, AIRCRAFT NAVIGATION OR COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS, AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL, LIFE SUPPORT MACHINES, WEAPONS SYSTEMS OR OTHER APPLICATIONS REPRESENTING A SIMILAR DEGREE OF POTENTIAL HAZARD. ALVARION SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY OF FITNESS FOR HIGH RISK ACTIVITIES. (b) PURCHASER’S SOLE REMEDY FOR BREACH OF THE EXPRESS WARRANTIES ABOVE SHALL BE REPLACEMENT OR REFUND OF THE PURCHASE PRICE AS SPECIFIED ABOVE, AT ALVARION’S OPTION. TO THE FULLEST EXTENT ALLOWED BY LAW, THE WARRANTIES AND REMEDIES SET FORTH IN THIS AGREEMENT ARE EXCLUSIVE AND IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, EITHER IN FACT OR BY OPERATION OF LAW, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO WARRANTIES, TERMS OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, SATISFACTORY QUALITY, CORRESPONDENCE WITH DESCRIPTION, NON-INFRINGEMENT, AND ACCURACY OF INFORMATION GENERATED. ALL OF WHICH ARE EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMED. ALVARION’ WARRANTIES HEREIN RUN ONLY TO PURCHASER, AND ARE NOT EXTENDED TO ANY THIRD PARTIES. ALVARION NEITHER ASSUMES NOR AUTHORIZES ANY OTHER PERSON TO ASSUME FOR IT ANY OTHER LIABILITY IN CONNECTION WITH THE SALE, INSTALLATION, MAINTENANCE OR USE OF ITS PRODUCTS. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual ii (c) ALVARION SHALL NOT BE LIABLE UNDER THIS WARRANTY IF ITS TESTING AND EXAMINATION DISCLOSE THAT THE ALLEGED DEFECT IN THE PRODUCT DOES NOT EXIST OR WAS CAUSED BY PURCHASER’S OR ANY THIRD PERSON'S MISUSE, NEGLIGENCE, IMPROPER INSTALLATION OR IMPROPER TESTING, UNAUTHORIZED ATTEMPTS TO REPAIR, OR ANY OTHER CAUSE BEYOND THE RANGE OF THE INTENDED USE, OR BY ACCIDENT, FIRE, LIGHTNING OR OTHER HAZARD. Limitation Of Liability. (a) ALVARION SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO THE PURCHASER OR TO ANY THIRD PARTY, FOR ANY LOSS OF PROFITS, LOSS OF USE, INTERRUPTION OF BUSINESS OR FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, PUNITIVE OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, WHETHER ARISING UNDER BREACH OF CONTRACT, TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), STRICT LIABILITY OR OTHERWISE AND WHETHER BASED ON THIS AGREEMENT OR OTHERWISE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. (b) TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN NO EVENT SHALL THE LIABILITY FOR DAMAGES HEREUNDER OF ALVARION OR ITS EMPLOYEES OR AGENTS EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE PAID FOR THE PRODUCT BY PURCHASER, NOR SHALL THE AGGREGATE LIABILITY FOR DAMAGES TO ALL PARTIES REGARDING ANY PRODUCT EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE PAID FOR THAT PRODUCT BY THAT PARTY (EXCEPT IN THE CASE OF A BREACH OF A PARTY’S CONFIDENTIALITY OBLIGATIONS). Electronic Emission Notice This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference. 2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. FCC Radio Frequency Interference Statement This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense. FCC Radiation Hazard Warning To comply with FCC RF exposure requirements in section 1.1307, a minimum separation distance as defined in the following table is required between the antenna and all persons: Product SU-A/E and AU-A/E SU-I/I-D and AU-I/I-D SU-R Minimum Separation Distance 2 m (79 inches) 20 cm (8 inches) 20 cm (8 inches) Important Notice iii R&TTE Compliance Statement This equipment complies with the appropriate essential requirements of Article 3 of the R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC. Safety Considerations For the following safety considerations, “Instrument” means the BreezeACCESS units’ components and their cables. Caution To avoid electrical shock, do not perform any servicing unless you are qualified to do so. BS-GU Lithium Battery Caution: Danger of battery explosion if incorrectly replaced or disposed of. Replace only with the same or equivilant type battery, as recommended by the manufactuer. Dispose of used batterys according to manufactuer’s instructions. Line Voltage Before connecting this instrument to the power line, make sure that the voltage of the power source matches the requirements of the instrument. Power Cord Use only the power cord supplied with the unit. Radio The instrument transmits radio energy during normal operation. To avoid possible harmful exposure to this energy, do not stand or work for extended periods of time in front of its antenna. The long-term characteristics or the possible physiological effects of Radio Frequency Electromagnetic fields have not been yet fully investigated. Outdoor Unit and Antenna Installation and Grounding Be sure that the outdoor unit, the antenna and the supporting structure are properly installed to eliminate any physical hazard to either people or property. Verify that the outdoor unit and the antenna mast (when using external antenna) are grounded so as to provide protection against voltage surges and static charges. Make sure that the installation of the outdoor unit, antenna and cables is performed in accordance with all relevant national and local building and safety codes. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual iv Important Notice This user manual is delivered subject to the following conditions and restrictions: This manual contains proprietary information belonging to Alvarion Ltd. Such information is supplied solely for the purpose of assisting properly authorized users of the respective Alvarion Ltd. products. No part of its contents may be used for any other purpose, disclosed to any person or firm or reproduced by any means, electronic and mechanical, without the express prior written permission of Alvarion Ltd. The text and graphics are for the purpose of illustration and reference only. The specifications on which they are based are subject to change without notice. The software described in this document is furnished under a license. The software may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of that license. Information in this document is subject to change without notice. Corporate and individual names and data used in examples herein are fictitious unless otherwise noted. Alvarion Ltd. reserves the right to alter the equipment specifications and descriptions in this publication without prior notice. No part of this publication shall be deemed to be part of any contract or warranty unless specifically incorporated by reference into such contract or warranty. The information contained herein is merely descriptive in nature, and does not constitute an offer for the sale of the product described herein. Any changes or modifications of equipment not expressly approved by Alvarion Ltd. could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. Some of the equipment provided by Alvarion and specified in this manual, is manufactured and warranted by third parties. All such equipment must be installed and handled in full compliance with the instructions provided by such manufacturers as attached to this manual or provided thereafter by Alvarion or the manufacturers. Noncompliance with such instructions may result in serious damage and/ or bodily harm and/or void the user’s authority to operate the equipment and/or revoke the warranty provided by such manufacturer Table of Contents Table of Contents System Manual Book 1: System Description Introduction ............................................................. 1-1 Introducing BreezeACCESS ..................................................... 1-2 System Components ................................................ 2-1 Subscriber Units (Customer Premises Equipment) ............... 2-2 SU-A/E Units with an Outdoor Radio Unit and Antenna .... 2-2 SU-I/I-D Miniature Indoor Units .......................................... 2-4 SU-R High-Power Indoor Units .......................................... 2-6 Base Station Equipment ........................................................... 2-6 Modular Base Station Equipment ...................................... 2-7 AU-A/E-NI Standalone “Micro-Cell” Access Unit ............. 2-10 AU-I/I-D Miniature Indoor Units ........................................ 2-11 Networking Equipment ........................................................... 2-12 Management Systems ............................................................. 2-12 BreezeMANAGE .............................................................. 2-13 BreezeCONFIG ................................................................ 2-14 Specifications .......................................................... 3-1 System Specifications .............................................................. 3-2 BreezeACCESS II Radio Regulatory Standards ................ 3-3 Data Communication ......................................................... 3-3 Voice/Fax (Subscriber Units with voice support) ............... 3-4 Telephony (Subscriber Units with voice support) ............... 3-4 IF Indoor – Outdoor Communication .................................. 3-4 (SU-A/E, AU-A/E-NI, AU-A/E-BS) ...................................... 3-4 Configuration and Management ......................................... 3-5 GU-RA GPS Radio ............................................................ 3-5 GU-RA to BS-GU Communication ..................................... 3-5 Environmental .................................................................... 3-6 Standards Compliance, General ........................................ 3-6 Physical Specifications ............................................................ 3-7 SU-A/E Subscriber Unit ..................................................... 3-7 AU-A/E-NI Stand-Alone Access Unit ................................. 3-8 Modular Base Station Equipment ...................................... 3-9 Manual Revision 3.0 BreezeACCESS 4.3 System Manual ii SU-I/I-D ............................................................................ 3-11 AU-I/I-D ............................................................................ 3-12 SU-R Subscriber Units ..................................................... 3-13 System Manual Book 2: Installation IF-Based Equipment ................................................ 1-1 Modular Base Station Equipment ...................................... 1-2 Standalone AU-A/E-NI Access Unit ................................... 1-3 Other Items Required for Installation ................................. 1-3 Guidelines for Selection of Equipment Locations ................. 1-5 AU-RA and AU-RE ............................................................. 1-5 SU-RA and SU-RE ............................................................. 1-5 IF Cable ............................................................................. 1-6 Indoor Equipment ............................................................... 1-6 Installing the Outdoor Unit ....................................................... 1-7 The Outdoor Unit Bottom Panel ......................................... 1-7 Pole Mounting the Outdoor Unit ......................................... 1-9 Connecting the Antenna Cable (SU-RE and AU-RE) ...... 1-12 Installing the SU-NI and AU-NI Indoor Unit ........................... 1-13 Installing the SU-NI/AU-NI Unit ........................................ 1-14 Installing Modular Base Station Equipment ......................... 1-15 BS-SH Slot Assignments ................................................. 1-15 The BS-PS ....................................................................... 1-16 The BS-PS-AC ................................................................. 1-17 The BS-AU ....................................................................... 1-18 BS-SH Chassis and Modules Installation Procedure ....... 1-19 Installing the GU-A-BS GPS and Alarms System ................. 1-21 BS-GU Front Panel .......................................................... 1-21 Installing the GU-RA GPS Antenna ................................. 1-23 Installing the BS-GU module ............................................ 1-24 Daisy-chaining Two or More BS-GU Modules ................. 1-24 Indoor SU-R Units .................................................... 2-1 Packing Lists ............................................................................. 2-2 SU-R Subscriber Unit ......................................................... 2-2 Other Items Required for Installation ................................. 2-2 Installation Guidelines .............................................................. 2-3 Location of the Unit ............................................................ 2-3 Table of Contents Location of the Antenna(s) ................................................. 2-3 Antenna Diversity ............................................................... 2-4 Antenna Polarization .......................................................... 2-4 Antenna Seal ..................................................................... 2-4 Lightning Protection ........................................................... 2-4 Installing SU-R Indoor Units ..................................................... 2-5 Wall Mounting the Unit ....................................................... 2-5 Connecting the Omni Antennas ......................................... 2-6 Connecting a Detached Antenna ....................................... 2-6 Connecting the Unit to the Power Supply and to the CPE . 2-6 Indoor SU-I and AU-I Units ...................................... 3-1 Packing Lists ............................................................................. 3-2 SU-I/I-D Subscriber Unit ................................................... 3-2 AU-I/I-D Access Unit .......................................................... 3-2 Other Items Required for Installation ................................. 3-2 Installation Guidelines .............................................................. 3-4 Location of the Unit ............................................................ 3-4 Location of the Antenna(s) ................................................. 3-4 Antenna Diversity ............................................................... 3-4 Antenna Polarization .......................................................... 3-5 Antenna Seal ..................................................................... 3-5 Lightning Protection ........................................................... 3-5 Installing SU-I/I-D and AU-I/I-D Units ....................................... 3-7 Connectors and LEDs ........................................................ 3-7 Wall Mounting the Unit ....................................................... 3-9 Connecting Antenna(s) to the Units ................................. 3-11 Connecting the Unit to the Power Supply and to the CPE 3-11 Manual Revision 3.0 iii BreezeACCESS 4.3 System Manual iv System Manual Book 3: Commissioning Setting Basic Parameters ....................................... 1-1 Accessing the Monitor Program .............................................. 1-2 Accessing the Monitor Program using the RS 232 MON Connector .............................................. 1-2 Accessing the Monitor Program using Telnet .................... 1-3 Operating the Monitor Program ......................................... 1-4 Configuring Basic Parameters in Access and Subscriber Units ............................................................... 1-5 Configuring Parameters in GU-A-BS Units ............................. 1-6 Introduction ........................................................................ 1-6 Optimizing the Wireless Link .................................. 2-1 Configuring the Maximum Data Rate (Subscriber Units) ... 2-2 Aligning the Antenna of the SU-A/E Subscriber Unit ............ 2-3 Configuring the Transmit Power of the AU-RE ...................... 2-4 Positioning the SU-I or SU-R Subscriber Unit with Omni Antennas for Optimal Operation ........................... 2-5 Aligning the External Antenna of SU-R and SU-I-D Units ..... 2-6 BS-GU Connectors ................................................... 3-1 Connecting External Devices to the BS-GU AL IN and/or AL OUT Connectors ...................................................... 3-2 Alarms In Cable ................................................................. 3-2 Alarms Out Cable ............................................................... 3-3 GPS Cable ......................................................................... 3-3 SYNC Cable ....................................................................... 3-5 Verifying Proper Operation ...................................... 4-1 Verifying Connectivity .............................................................. 4-2 Verifying the Ethernet Connection ..................................... 4-2 Verifying Data Connectivity (Subscriber Unit) .................... 4-2 Verifying Telephone Connectivity (Subscriber Units with Voice support) ............................... 4-2 Verifying Proper Operation of the GU-A-BS GPS Unit ...... 4-3 LED Indicators ........................................................................... 4-4 SU-RA/RE Outdoor Units LEDs ......................................... 4-4 AU-RA/RE Outdoor Units LEDs ......................................... 4-4 SU-NI and AU-NI Indoor Units LEDs ................................. 4-5 Table of Contents BS-PS DC Power Supply Module LEDs ............................ 4-5 BS-PS-AC AC Power Supply Module LEDs ...................... 4-5 BS-AU LEDs ...................................................................... 4-6 BS-GU LEDs ...................................................................... 4-6 SU-R LEDs ........................................................................ 4-7 SU-I/SU-I-D LEDs .............................................................. 4-7 AU-I/AU-I-D LEDs .............................................................. 4-8 System Manual Book 4: Operations and Administration Accessing the Monitor Program .............................. 1-1 Accessing the Monitor Program using the RS 232 MON Connector ...................................................... 1-2 Accessing the Monitor Program using Telnet ........................ 1-3 Operating the Monitor Program ............................................... 1-4 Menus and Parameters ............................................ 2-1 Main Menu .................................................................................. 2-2 Info Screens Menu .................................................................... 2-3 Show Unit Status ............................................................... 2-3 Show Basic Parameters ..................................................... 2-5 Show Advanced Parameters ............................................. 2-5 Show All Parameters ......................................................... 2-5 Unit Control Menu ..................................................................... 2-6 Basic Configuration Menu ...................................................... 2-13 Site Survey Menu .................................................................... 2-15 Traffic Statistics (AU and SU) .......................................... 2-15 Voice Statistics (SU with Voice Support Only) ................. 2-18 Per Hop Statistics (AU and SU) ....................................... 2-18 Ping Test (AU, SU and GU) ............................................. 2-19 Continuous Link Quality Display (Available in SU Only) .. 2-20 MAC Address Database (Available in AU Only) .............. 2-20 Per-rate Counters (AU and SU) ....................................... 2-23 RSSI Display Option (AU and SU) ................................... 2-23 ATPC Counter (AU and SU) ............................................ 2-23 AU Alarms (IF-based AU Only) ........................................ 2-24 Advanced Configuration Menu .............................................. 2-36 IP Parameters (AU, SU and GU) ..................................... 2-36 Air Interface Parameters (AU and SU) ............................. 2-37 Manual Revision 3.0 BreezeACCESS 4.3 System Manual vi Network Management Parameters (AU, SU and GU) ..... 2-53 Bridge Parameters (AU, SU and GU) .............................. 2-56 Performance Parameters (AU and SU) ........................... 2-69 Service Parameters (AU and SU) .................................... 2-73 RADIUS Parameters Menu (Subscriber Units only) ....... 2-77 Security Parameters (AU and SU) ................................... 2-81 Voice Parameters (Subscriber Units with Voice Support Only) ................................................ 2-83 Dialing Parameters (Subscriber Units with Voice Support Only) ................................................ 2-84 Telephony Signals (Subscriber Units with Voice Support Only) ................................................. 2-91 Hopping Parameters (GU) ............................................... 2-97 Alarm Parameters (GU) ................................................... 2-99 System Manual: Appendices Appendix A: ..............................................................A-1 Configuration Download/Upload ..............................A-1 Appendix B: Software Version Loading Procedure B-1 General ...................................................................................... B-1 Loading an Upgrade to a Unit with FLASH Type: F .............. B-2 Loading an Upgrade to a Unit with FLASH Type: S .............. B-4 Appendix C: Supported MIBs and Traps .................C-1 BreezeACCESS System Object Identifiers ............................ C-2 brzAccessMIB ........................................................................... C-3 Service Parameters .......................................................... C-3 RADIUS General Parameters ........................................... C-4 Accounting Parameters ..................................................... C-4 RADIUS Authentication Parameters ................................. C-5 User Filtering Parameters ................................................. C-5 Network Management Parameters ................................... C-7 Bridge Parameters ............................................................ C-9 Air Interface Parameters ................................................. C-11 Performance Parameters ................................................ C-22 Site Survey Parameters .................................................. C-24 Special Operations Parameters ...................................... C-33 Unit Control Parameters ................................................. C-34 Table of Contents IP Parameters ................................................................. C-36 System Information Parameters ..................................... C-36 Alarms Parameters ......................................................... C-38 brzPhoneMIB (applicable to SU with voice only) ................ C-39 Dialing Parameters ......................................................... C-39 Voice Parameters ........................................................... C-42 Telephony Signals .......................................................... C-43 General Info MIB ............................................................. C-44 Supported Traps ..................................................................... C-44 Trap Associated Parameters .......................................... C-44 Traps ............................................................................... C-46 Appendix D: RSSI to dBm Conversion Table ...........D-1 SU-A/E, AU-A/E ......................................................................... D-1 SU-R and SU-I ........................................................................... D-2 Appendix E: Parameters List ...................................E-1 Unit Control Parameters .......................................................... E-1 Site Survey Parameters ........................................................... E-2 IP Parameters ........................................................................... E-3 Air Interface Parameters .......................................................... E-4 Network Management Parameters .......................................... E-7 Bridge Parameters ................................................................... E-9 Performance Parameters ....................................................... E-11 Service Parameters ................................................................ E-12 RADIUS Parameters ............................................................... E-13 Security Parameters ............................................................... E-13 Voice Parameters ................................................................... E-14 Dialing Parameters ................................................................. E-15 Telephony Signals .................................................................. E-17 Hopping Parameters .............................................................. E-19 Alarm Parameters ................................................................... E-19 Appendix F: Hopping Sequences ............................ F-1 Hopping Standard: Australia ..............................................F-1 Hopping Standards: Canada, Mexico ................................F-3 Hopping Standards: Europe ETSI, US FCC, International F-4 Hopping Standards: France ...............................................F-6 Hopping Standards: Israel .................................................F-7 Hopping Standards: Japan ................................................F-8 Hopping Standards: Korea ...............................................F-10 Hopping Standards: Spain ...............................................F-12 Manual Revision 3.0 vii viii BreezeACCESS 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS II Version 4.3 Revision 3.0 System Manual Book 1: System Description System Description Table of Contents Introduction .............................................................1-1 Introducing BreezeACCESS .....................................................1-2 System Components ................................................2-1 Subscriber Units (Customer Premises Equipment) ...............2-2 SU-A/E Units with an Outdoor Radio Unit and Antenna .....2-2 SU-I/I-D Miniature Indoor Units ..........................................2-4 SU-R High-Power Indoor Units ..........................................2-6 Base Station Equipment ...........................................................2-6 Modular Base Station Equipment .......................................2-7 AU-A/E-NI Standalone “Micro-Cell” Access Unit ..............2-10 AU-I/I-D Miniature Indoor Units ........................................2-11 Networking Equipment ............................................................2-12 Management Systems .............................................................2-12 BreezeMANAGE ..............................................................2-13 BreezeCONFIG ................................................................2-14 Specifications ..........................................................3-1 System Specifications ...............................................................3-2 BreezeACCESS II Radio Regulatory Standards ................3-3 Data Communication ..........................................................3-3 Voice/Fax (Subscriber Units with voice support) ................3-4 Telephony (Subscriber Units with voice support) ...............3-4 IF Indoor – Outdoor Communication ..................................3-4 (SU-A/E, AU-A/E-NI, AU-A/E-BS) ......................................3-4 Configuration and Management .........................................3-5 GU-RA GPS Radio .............................................................3-5 GU-RA to BS-GU Communication .....................................3-5 Environmental ....................................................................3-6 Standards Compliance, General ........................................3-6 Physical Specifications .............................................................3-7 SU-A/E Subscriber Unit ......................................................3-7 AU-A/E-NI Stand-Alone Access Unit ..................................3-8 Modular Base Station Equipment .......................................3-9 SU-I/I-D ............................................................................3-11 AU-I/I-D ............................................................................3-12 ii BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description SU-R Subscriber Units ..................................................... 3-13 Chapter 1 Introduction About This Chapter This chapter introduces the BreezeACCESS system, its components and its functions. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 1-2 Introducing BreezeACCESS BreezeACCESS IP Broadband Wireless Access system is an IP based access system that supports wireless data and voice services, employing wireless packet-switched data technology to support high-speed IP services, including fast access to the Internet and Virtual Private Networks. BreezeACCESS users are provided with a network connection that is always on, supporting access to the Internet and other IP services at data rates of up to 3 Mbps. BreezeACCESS can also support high quality telephony using the ITU-T H.323 industry standard for Voice over IP communications. The system is designed for cellular-like deployment, allowing systems of various sizes and structures to be constructed. A system may include any number of cells, each containing several Access Units, to better cover densely populated areas. The BreezeACCESS system allows the Maximum (data burst) Information Rate (MIR) and Committed Information Rate (CIR) for both uplink and downlink to be defined separately for each subscriber. This enables a variety of Class of Service (CoS) packages, bandwidth allocations and traffic-shaping schemes. In addition, the system supports Virtual LANs based on IEEE 802.1Q, enabling secure operation and Virtual Private Network (VPN) services as well as allowing tele-workers or remote offices to conveniently access their enterprise networks. The system also supports Layer 2 traffic prioritization according to IEEE 802.1p and ToS based Layer 3 traffic prioritization according to RFC791. BreezeACCESS II operates in the 2.4 GHzTime Division Duplex (TDD) mode. It employs wireless packet data switching technology, utilizing Frequency Hopping Spread Spectrum (FH-SS) radios. A BreezeACCESS-based system consists of the following: Customer Premise Equipment (CPE) – BreezeACCESS Subscriber Units. Base Station Equipment (BSE) – BreezeACCESS Access Units and supporting equipment. Networking Equipment – Standard Routers and/or Gateways/Gatekeepers supporting connections to the Internet and/or the PSTN or private telephony network. Management Systems – SNMP based Management, Billing and Customer Care, and other Operations Support Systems. Manual Revision: 3.0 Chapter 2 System Components About This Chapter This chapter describes BreezeACCESS system components. It includes the following sections: Subscriber Units (Customer Premises Equipment)‚ page 2-2, describes BreezeACCESS equipment installed at the customer’s premises. Base Station Equipment‚ page 2-6, describes the equipment used in BreezeACCESS Base Stations. Networking Equipment‚ page 2-12, describes how BreezeACCESS Base Station units are connected to one another and to other equipment in a network environment. Management Systems‚ page 2-12, introduces the management features built into the BreezeACCESS system and describes the use of various standard and proprietary management systems. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-2 Subscriber Units (Customer Premises Equipment) The BreezeACCESS Subscriber Unit (SU) installed at the customer premises provides data only or data and telephone connections. The data connection is a standard IEEE 802.3 Ethernet 10BaseT (RJ 45) interface while the voice connection (in units that support voice) is a standard RJ 11 Plain Old Telephone (POTS) interface. The Subscriber Unit provides an efficient platform for high rate Internet and Intranet services, providing subscribers with fast access to IP based services at a burst data rate of up to 3 Mbps. The use of packet switching technology provides the user with a connection to the network that is practically always on, allowing for immediate access to services. There are 3 lines of Subscriber Units with different architectures: SU-A/E units with an outdoor radio unit SU-I miniature indoor units SU-R high-power, small-footprint indoor units. SU-A/E Units with an Outdoor Radio Unit and Antenna SU-A and SU-E series Subscriber Units are comprised of an indoor unit (SU-NI) and an outdoor unit. In the SU-A series, the outdoor unit (SU-RA) contains the radio module and an integral flat antenna. In the SU-E series, the outdoor unit (SU-RE) contains the radio module and an RF connector for an external antenna. The indoor SU-NI unit connects to the user’s equipment and is powered from the mains via its SU-PS power supply unit. The SU-NI is connected to the outdoor unit via a 50-ohm coaxial Intermediate Frequency (IF) cable. This cable carries 440 MHz IF signals between the indoor and the outdoor units and also serves for transferring power (12 VDC), management and control signals from the indoor unit to the outdoor unit. Manual Revision: 3.0 System Components 2-3 Figure 2-1: BreezeACCESS SU-A/E Outdoor and Indoor Units BreezeACCESS II SU-A/E units are available with several different levels of output power at the antenna port: 26 dBm (HP) 15 dBm (GP) 7 dBm (MP) 4 dBm (LP) The following products are available: Data-only Units: SU-X-1D-2.4-YP The unit supports one Ethernet device. SU-X-BD-2.4-YP The unit provides bridge functionality and can support up to a full LAN. Data and Voice Units: SU-X-1D1V-2.4-YP The unit supports one Ethernet device and has an interface to a standard analog telephone set (POTS). SU-X-BD1V-2.4-YP The unit provides bridge functionality and can support a full LAN. It also has an interface for a standard analog telephone (POTS). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-4 X=A: The outdoor radio unit includes an integral high gain flat antenna X=E: The outdoor radio unit has a connector for an external antenna. Y=H: HP model. The maximum output power at the antenna port is 26 dBm Y=G: GP model. The maximum output power at the antenna port is 15 dBm Y=M: MP model. The maximum output power at the antenna port is 7 dBm Y=L: LP model. The maximum output power at the antenna port is 4 dBm SU-I/I-D Miniature Indoor Units The SU-I/I-D line includes miniature units that are designed for indoor desktop or wall-mount installations. Figure 2-2: BreezeACCESS SU-I Unit The SU-I products include two integral 2dBi omni antennas. The SU-I-D products have two RF connectors for connecting to one or two detached antennas. Manual Revision: 3.0 System Components 2-5 The following types of units are available: Data-only Units: SU-X-1D-2.4 The unit supports one Ethernet device SU-X-BD-2.4 The unit provides bridge functionality and can support up to a full LAN Data and Voice Units: SU-X-1D1V-2.4 The unit supports one Ethernet device and has an interface to a standard analog telephone set (POTS). SU-X-BD1V- The unit provides bridge functionality and can support a full LAN. It also has an interface for a standard analog telephone (POTS). X=I: The unit is supplied with two integral 2 dBi omni antennas X=I-D: The unit is supplied with two connectors for detached antenna(s) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-6 SU-R High-Power Indoor Units The SU-R line includes small-footprint, high-power units that are designed for indoor desktop or wall-mount installations. SU-R units are available with three different antenna configurations: Two clip-on omni antennas. A wall mountable antenna. An outdoor high-gain antenna. Figure 2-3: BreezeACCESS SU-R Unit The following types of units are available: Data-only Units: SU-R-1D The unit supports one Ethernet device. SU-R-BD The unit provides bridge functionality and can support up to a full LAN. Data and Voice Units: SU-R-1D1V The unit supports one Ethernet device and has an interface to a standard analog telephone set (POTS). Base Station Equipment The BreezeACCESS Access Units (AU) installed at the base station site provide all the functionality necessary to communicate with the remote Subscriber Units as well as to connect to the backbone of the service provider. Each AU connects to the network through a standard IEEE 802.3 Ethernet 10BaseT (RJ 45) interface. There are 3 lines of Access Units with different architectures: Modular Base Station Equipment Manual Revision: 3.0 System Components 2-7 Standalone “Micro-Cell” Access Unit AU-I/I-D miniature indoor units Modular Base Station Equipment The Base Station equipment is based on the BS-SH 3U chassis, which is suitable for installation in 19” racks. The chassis contains one or two power supply modules, up to six active Access Unit Network Interface (BS-AU) modules and an optional BS-GU GPS and Alarms module. Two different types of power supply modules are available: the BS-PS which is powered from a –48 VDC power source, and the BS-PS-AC, powered from the 110/230 VAC mains. The optional use of two power supply modules is for fail-safe operation through power supply redundancy. Each BS-AU module, together with its outdoor radio unit comprises an AU-A/E-BS Access Unit that serves a single sector. In the AU-A-BS series, the AU-RA outdoor unit contains a radio unit and an integral antenna. In the AU-E-BS series, the AU-RE outdoor unit contains the radio module and a RF connector for a separate external antenna. The BS-AU modules connect to the network through standard IEEE 802.3 Ethernet 10BaseT (RJ 45) interfaces. A coaxial Intermediate Frequency (IF) cable connects the indoor module to the outdoor unit. This cable carries 440 MHz IF signals, power (12 VDC) and management and control signals from the indoor unit to the outdoor unit. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-8 Figure 2-4: BreezeACCESS Base Station Module and Outdoor Units BreezeACCESS II AU-A/E-BS units are available with several different levels of maximum output power at the antenna port: 26dBm (HP) 15dBm (GP) 7dBm (MP) 2dBm (LP) GU-A-BS GPS and Alarms System The optional GU-A-BS system can be used to synchronize the frequency hopping mechanisms of collocated AU-A/E-BS BreezeACCESS units (where such synchronization is permitted by local regulations) as well as to provide alarm management. The GU-A-BS system is comprised of two units: An outdoor GPS Receiver and Antenna unit, the GU-RA. An indoor GPS and Alarms module, the BS-GU. Manual Revision: 3.0 System Components 2-9 Figure 2-5: BreezeACCESS GU-A-BS System Components The BreezeACCESS BS-GU module is designed to be inserted into the BS-SH 19” base station chassis to provide hopping synchronization signals to the BS-AU Access Unit modules. The card uses timing signals derived from signals received from the GU-RA GPS antenna. These signals, generated by the GPS global satellites network, allow accurate synchronization of systems located in different locations. Any number of base stations can be synchronized, guaranteeing that all AUs (Access Units) hop in unison from frequency to frequency. In addition, the GPS signal insures that all units begin their pre-defined hopping sequence at the same time. The BS-GU module is connected to the GU-RA GPS antenna via a cable that carries power from the module to the antenna, timing signals from the antenna to the module and management signals between the two units. The BS-GU also provides synchronization signals to other BS-GU modules by daisy-chaining any number of modules, using a single GU-RA GPS antenna to synchronize multiple AUs in several collocated BS-SH chassis. When a GU-RA GPS antenna is not connected to the module (or if the connected GPS antenna is not functioning properly), the BS-GU module provides self-generated synchronization signals to all AUs. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-10 Daisy-chained BS-GU modules use the synchronization signals generated by the first module in the chain (the Master module. The BS-GU module also supports the management of alarm inputs and outputs. The module receives Alarms In indications from other BreezeACCESS modules in the base station shelf (internal alarms) and external alarms from other devices via the AL IN connector. Alarms Out management allows activation of external devices upon occurrence of user-defined events, using relays via the AL OUT connector. AU-A/E-NI Standalone “Micro-Cell” Access Unit The AU-A/E-NI line includes standalone Access Units that are very similar to the AU-A/E-BS units, the only difference being that the indoor unit, the AU-NI, is a standalone desktop or wall-mountable unit rather than a 19” module. Figure 2-6: BreezeACCESS AU-NI Unit The AU-RA/RE outdoor units are identical to those of the AU-A/E-BS line. The AU-NI indoor unit is powered from the mains (100-250 VAC) through an external power transformer and connects to the network through a standard IEEE 802.3 Ethernet 10BaseT (RJ 45) interface. A coaxial Intermediate Frequency (IF) cable connects between the AU-NI indoor unit and the outdoor unit. This cable carries 440 MHz IF signals, power (12 VDC) and management and control signals from the indoor unit to the outdoor unit. Manual Revision: 3.0 System Components 2-11 AU-I/I-D Miniature Indoor Units The AU-I/I-D line includes miniature units that are designed for indoor desktop or wall-mount installations and comprise a single unit that is powered from the mains (100-250 VAC). The AU-I products include two integral 2 dBi omni antennas. The AU-I-D products have two RF connectors for detached diversity antennas. Figure 2-7: BreezeACCESS AU-I-D Unit BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-12 Networking Equipment The base station equipment is connected to the backbone through standard data communication and telecommunication equipment. For improved security, the 10BaseT ports of the AU modules are connected directly to a multi-port router. This router is connected by any means of point-to-point link to the backbone. In cases where security is less important and cost is the main concern, the Access Units can be connected to an Ethernet switch and then to a single port router. The point-to-point link from the base station to the backbone may be wired or wireless links. The data to the Internet is routed to the Internet backbone through standard routers. The voice traffic is routed via standard Gateways/Gatekeepers to the PSTN. Management Systems The end-to-end IP based architecture of the system allows full management of all components from any point in the system. BreezeACCESS components can be managed using standard management tools through SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) agents that implement standard and proprietary MIBs for remote setting of operational modes and parameters. The same SNMP management tools can also be used for management of other system components including Switches, Routers, Gateways/Gatekeepers and transmission equipment. The Ethernet WAN can also be used to connect to other Operation Support Systems including servers, Customer Care systems and AAA (Authentication, Authorization and Admission) tools. Manual Revision: 3.0 System Components 2-13 BreezeMANAGE Alvarion’s SNMP-based BreezeMANAGE network management application provides a powerful tool for configuring, controlling, monitoring and effectively managing BreezeACCESS networks from a single, central network management station. BreezeMANAGE, together with the powerful tools available through its use under leading network management platforms, provides numerous benefits to operators of BreezeACCESS networks. BreezeMANAGE system requirements are: BreezeMANAGE for SNMPc: Castle Rock Computing SNMPc version 5.0.7d or higher (excluding 5.0.8), running under Windows 98/2000/NT. BreezeMANAGE for HP-OV under UNIX: HP OpenView version 5.0.1 or higher running on a UNIX machine under Solaris Version 2.5 or higher. BreezeMANAGE for HP-OV under NT: HP OpenView version 5.0.1 or higher running on a PC under Windows NT version 4.0 or higher with service pack 5. Client: Any system supported by the network management platform such as HP-UX Xterm (HP-OV) or Windows 95/98/2000/NT. Database: Any database supported by the network management platform such as Oracle, Sybase, Informix or Ingress. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 2-14 BreezeCONFIG The BreezeCONFIG ACCESS configuration utility can also be used to manage BreezeACCESS system components. It is an SNMP-based application that provides a consistent view of the network and the system administrator can use it to control a large number of units from a single location. BreezeCONFIG has the following system requirements: Windows 95/98/NT/2000/ME/XP 128 MB RAM recommended, 64 MB Minimum Some of the features BreezeCONFIG supports are: Verifying units’ status and current configuration Changing the configuration of a selected unit Simultaneously changing the configuration of multiple units Viewing traffic statistics and performance data Monitoring traps Performing firmware upgrade to a single or multiple units NOTES: The BreezeCONFIG utility can be downloaded from the Alvarion Web site: www.alvarion.com. Manual Revision: 3.0 Chapter 3 Specifications About This Chapter This chapter lists the technical specifications of BreezeACCESS and includes the following sections: System Specifications‚ page 3-2, outlines the technical specifications of the BreezeACCESS system. Physical Specifications‚ page 3-7, lists the physical and electical specifications for different types of BreezeACCESS units. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 3-2 System Specifications Radio and Modem Parameter Value Frequency 2.400-2.500 GHz (according to country standard) Operation Mode Time Division Duplex Radio Access Method FH-CDMA Standard Compliance FCC Part 15.247, ETS 300 328 Channel Bandwidth 1 MHz Central Frequency Resolution 1 MHz Antenna SU-RA 16 dBi, 20o horizontal x 20 o vertical, vertical polarization, EN 301 525, Class TS 2 compliant AU-RA 16 dBi, 60o horizontal x 10o vertical, vertical polarization, EN 302 085 V1.1.1 Class CS3 compliant SU-RE, AU-RE N-Type connector, 50 ohm SU-I, AU-I 2 integral 2 dBi omni antennas SU-I-D, AU-I-D 2 50 ohm SMA connectors SU-R 2 proprietary connectors, 50 ohm SU-A/E, AU-A/E 2dBm typical (LP model) 7dBm typical (MP model) 15dBm typical (GP model) 26dBm typical (HP model) Output control range: 20dB typical SU-I/I-D, AU-I/I-D 17 dBm (H) or 10 dBm (L), software configurable. SU-R 27 dBm typical Output Power (at antenna port) Maximum Input Power (at antenna port) -20 dBm Gross Bit Rate 1, 2, 3 Mbps Receive Nominal Sensitivity (at antenna port, BER 10E-6) 1 Mbps 2 Mbps 3 Mbps SU-A/E, AU-A/E -87 dBm -81 dBm -73 dBm SU-I/I-D, AU-I/I-D -81 dBm -74 dBm -67 dBm SU-R -84 dBm -77 dBm -68 dBm Modulation GFSK modulation, with 2, 4, 8 modulation states (1, 2, 3 bits / symbol). Symbol rate 1 Msymbol/sec. Manual Revision: 3.0 Specifications 3-3 BreezeACCESS II Radio Regulatory Standards The systems support different “country standards” for compliance with the applicable local radio regulations. The country standards are configured at the factory. The country standards determine the following: a: Hopping frequency band and hopping sequences b: Support of synchronization among Access Units (AU-A/E-BS units). In some countries such synchronization is not permitted. The following table provides a summary of the supported country standards: Channels’ Frequency Range [MHz] Number of Channels Australia 2402 to 2461 60 20 Not Available Canada 2452 to 2481 30 10 Not Available Europe ETSI 2402 to 2480 79 26 Yes France 2448 to 2482 35 11 Yes Israel 2421 to 2452 35 11 Yes Korea 2430 to 2454 23 Yes Japan 2473 to 2495 23 Yes Netherlands 2454 to 2468 15 Yes US FCC 2402 to 2480 79 26 Not Available Spain 2447 to 2473 27 yes Mexico 2452 to 2481 30 10 Yes International 2402 to 2480 79 26 Yes Country Standard Hopping Sequences per Hopping Set Hopping Sync Support Data Communication Parameter Value Standard Compliance IEEE 802.3 CSMA/CD VLAN support Based on IEEE 802.1Q Layer-2 Traffic Prioritization Based on IEEE 802.1p Layer-3 Traffic Prioritization ToS according to RFC791 MIR (Maximum Information Rate) and CIR (Committed Information Rate) Programmable for each user, separately for uplink and downlink. Range: 0 – 2200 Kbps, 1 Kbps resolution. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 3-4 Voice/Fax (Subscriber Units with voice support) Parameter Value Standard Compliance ITU-T H.323 Ver. 2 VoIP standard Compression G.711 (A-Law and µ-Law) - 64 Kbps (transparent) G.723.1 - 6.3 Kbps G.729 - 8 Kbps (G.729, G.729 with Annex A and/or Annex B) Silence Compression G.723.1 - Voice Activity Detection (VAD), G.729 - Annex B Echo Cancellation ITU-T G.168 and G.131 Fax Transmission According to T.38 Protocol Telephony (Subscriber Units with voice support) Parameter Value Call Progress Tones Selectable per country standard or user definable Line Type Loop Start On-hook Voltage -48 V Ringer Voltage Min. 50 V r.m.s. unbalanced Ringer Frequency Selectable: 17, 20, 25, 50 Hz REN Max. 2 Off-hook DC current 30mA Off-hook impedance 600 ohm or complex Maximum input level +3 dBm Cable length Max. 300 m, 26 AWG IF Indoor – Outdoor Communication (SU-A/E, AU-A/E-NI, AU-A/E-BS) Parameter Value IF Frequency 440 MHz IF Cable Impedance 50 ohm Maximum IF Cable Attenuation 15 dB Maximum IF Cable DC Resistance 1.5 ohm Manual Revision: 3.0 Specifications 3-5 Configuration and Management Parameter Value Management Options a. Via the MON port, using terminal emulation with the built-in monitor program b. Telnet, using the monitor program c. TFTP, using the Configuration upload/download utility d. SNMP Remote Management Access From Wired LAN, Wireless Link Management Access Protection a. Multilevel password b. Configuration of remote access direction (from Ethernet only, from wireless link only or from both sides) c. Configuration of IP addresses of authorized stations SNMP Agents SNMP ver 1 client. MIB II, Bridge MIB, Private BreezeACCESS MIB Security a. Association protocol – ESSID b. RC4 WEP option (encryption of the authentication process) c. VLAN according to IEEE 802.1Q d. IP level filtering for user addresses or protocols e. Access direction and IP address filtering for management Authentication and Accounting RADIUS client in the SU according to RFC 2865 and 2866 Allocation of IP Parameters Configurable or automatic (DHCP client) Software Upgrade Via TFTP GU-RA GPS Radio Parameter Value General L1 frequency, C/A code (SPS) continuous tracking receiver Update Rate 1 Hz GU-RA to BS-GU Communication Parameter Value Physical interface RS 422 Cable Type EIA RS 422 3 x 2 x 26AWG + 1 x 2 x 24 AWG FTP Shielded. 3 x 26 AWG twisted pairs for RS 422 communication and 1x 24 AWG pair for power supply Cable Impedance 100 +/- 15 ohm @ 1 MHz (RS 422 pairs) DC Resistance RS 422 pairs: 145 ohm/km Power supply pair: 94 ohm/km Maximum Cable Length 120 meters BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 3-6 Environmental Parameter Unit Value Operating Temperature Outdoor Units -400C to 550C (GU-RA: -400C to 850C) Indoor equipment 00C to 400C Operating Humidity Outdoor Units 5%-95% non-condensing, weather protected Indoor equipment 5%-95% non-condensing Standards Compliance, General Type Standard EMC FCC part 15.247, EN 300 826 Safety UL 1950, EN 60950 Environmental ETS 300 019 part 2-3 class 3.2E for indoor units ETS 300 019 part 2-4 class 4.1E for outdoor units Radio FCC part 15.247, ETSI ETS 300 328 Manual Revision: 3.0 Specifications 3-7 Physical Specifications SU-A/E Subscriber Unit Connectors Unit Connector SU-NI SU-RE SU-RA Description IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected ETH 10BaseT Ethernet (RJ 45) with 2 embedded LEDs. Cable connection to a PC: SU-A/E-1D/1D1V – straight SU-A/E-BD/BD1V - crossed TEL (units with voice support) RJ 11 jack (POTS) DC-12 V DC phone jack for the SU-PS power supply MON RS 232, 3-pin low profile jack IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected ANT N-Type jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected Electrical Unit Details General Power consumption: 25 W SU-NI External power supply AC input power: 100-240 Vr.m.s., 47-63 Hz DC power output: 12 V, 4 A SU-RA, SU-RE 12 VDC from the SU-NI unit over the IF cable Mechanical Unit Structure Dimensions Weight General An indoor SU-NI unit with an external SU-PS power supply unit and an outdoor SU-RE or SU-RA radio unit SU-NI Metal box, desktop or wall mountable 15 x 8.7 x 3.7 cm 0.34 kg. SU-PS Desktop unit, 1.5 m DC cable 12 x 6 x 3.6 cm 0.28 kg. SU-RE Metal box, pole or wall mountable 30.8 x 12 x 4.7 cm 1.58 kg. SU-RA Metal box plus an integral antenna in plastic enclosure, pole or wall mountable 30.6 x 30.6 x 7.2 cm (30.6 x 12 x 4.7 cm + 30.6 x 30.6 x 2.5 cm) 3.1 kg. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 3-8 AU-A/E-NI Stand-Alone Access Unit Connectors Unit Connector AU-NI AU-RE AU-RA Description IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected ETH 10BaseT Ethernet (RJ 45) with 2 embedded LEDs Cable connection to a PC: crossed DC-12 V DC phone jack for the AU-PS power supply MON RS 232, 3-pin low profile jack IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected ANT N-Type jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected Electrical Unit Details General Power consumption: 25 W AU-NI External power supply AC input power: 100-240 Vr.m.s., 47-63 Hz DC power output: 12 V, 4 A AU-RA/AU-RE 12 VDC from the AU-NI unit over the IF cable Mechanical Unit Structure Dimensions Weight General An indoor AU-NI unit with an external AU-PS power supply unit and an outdoor AU-RE radio unit AU-NI Metal box, desktop or wall mountable 15 x 8.7 x 3.7 cm 0.34 kg AU-PS Desktop unit, 1.5 m DC cable 12 x 6 x 3.6 cm 0.28 kg AU-RE Metal box, poll or wall mountable 30.6 x 12 x 4.7 cm 1.58 kg AU-RA Metal box plus an integral antenna, poll or wall mountable 72.5 x 13 x 6.2 cm (30.6 x 12 x 4.7 cm + 72.5 x 13 x 1.5 cm) 2.8 kg Manual Revision: 3.0 Specifications 3-9 Modular Base Station Equipment Connectors Unit AU-A/E-BS Connector AU-BS Description IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected ETH 10BaseT Ethernet (RJ 45) with 2 embedded LEDs Cable connection to a PC: crossed MON RS 232, 3-pin low profile jack IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected ANT N-Type jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected IF TNC jack, 50 ohm, lightning protected BS-PS -48V 3 pin DC power plug BS-PS-AC AC IN 3 pin AC power plug BS-GU ETH 10BaseT Ethernet (RJ 45) with 2 embedded LEDs Cable connection to a PC: straight SYNC IN 9-pin Micro D-Type jack, Molex 83619-9003 (mates with Molex 83421-9014 or similar); 4 contact closure alarm indicators SYNC OUT 9-pin Micro D-Type jack, Molex 83619-9003 (mates with Molex 83421-9014 or similar); 3 non-latching relays, rating = 24 V (DC or AC) @ 1 A max. AL IN 9-pin Micro D-Type jack, Molex 83619-9003 (mates with Molex 83421-9014 or similar) AL OUT 9-pin Micro D-Type jack, Molex 83619-9003 (mates with Molex 83421-9014 or similar) AU-RE AU-RA GU-RA 12-pin round BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual Specifications 3-11 SU-I/I-D Connectors Connector Description Antenna (SU-I-D) 2 x SMA jacks, 50 ohm ETH 10Base-T Ethernet (RJ-45) with 2 embedded LEDs. Cable connection to a PC: SU-I/I-D -1D/1D1V – straight SU-I/I-I-D-BD/BD1V - crossed TEL (units with voice support) RJ 11 jack (POTS) DC IN 5V Standard DC phone jack to external power supply MON RS 232, 3-pin low profile jack Electrical Unit Data only units (SU-I/I-D-xD) Details Power consumption: External power supply AC input power: 100-240Vr.m.s.,47-63 Hz DC power output: 5.1V, 2A max. Data and voice units Power consumption: (SU-I/I-D-xD1V) External power supply AC input power: 100-240Vr.m.s., 47-63 Hz DC power output: 5V, 5A max. Mechanical Unit Structure Dimensions Weight General An indoor unit with an external power supply unit SU-I/I-D (excluding antennas) Metal box, desktop or wall mountable. 15 x 8.7 x 3.7 cm 0.35 kg. Power supply, Data only units (SU-I/I-D-xD) Plugged directly into the mains socket (3 AC power pins), 1.5 meter DC cable with a right angle phone plug. 7.5 x 3.1 x 5 cm 0.38 kg. 12 x 5.9 x 3.5 cm 0.5 kg. Power supply, Data and Desktop unit, 1.5m DC cable. voice units (SU-I/I-D-xD1V) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description 3-12 AU-I/I-D Connectors Connector Description Antenna (AU-I-D) 2 x SMA jacks, 50 ohm ETH 10Base-T (RJ-45) with 2 embedded LEDs. Cable connection to a PC: crossed DC IN 5V Standard DC phone jack to external power supply MON RS 232, 3-pin low profile jack Electrical Unit AU-I/I-D Details Power consumption: External power supply AC input power: 100-240Vr.m.s., 47-63 Hz DC power output: 5.1V, 2A max. Mechanical Unit Structure Dimensions General An indoor unit with an external power supply unit AU-I/I-D Metal box, desktop or wall mountable. Power supply unit Plugged directly into the mains socket (3 AC 7.5 x 3.1 x 5 cm power pins), 1.5 meter DC cable with a right angle phone plug. Manual Revision: 3.0 15 x 8.7 x 3.7 cm Weight 0.35 kg. 0.38 kg. Specifications 3-13 SU-R Subscriber Units Connectors Connector Description Antenna 2 proprietary jacks, 50 ohm (with special SMA adapters if needed) ETH 10BaseT Ethernet (RJ 45) with 2 embedded LEDs Cable connection to a PC: straight TEL (units with voice support) RJ 11 jack (POTS) DC IN Standard DC phone jack to external power supply MON RS 232, 3-pin low profile jack Electrical Unit All SU-R units Details External power supply AC input power: 100-240 Vr.m.s., 47-63 Hz DC power output: , max. Mechanical Unit Structure Dimensions SU-R (excluding antennas) Metal box, desktop or wall mountable Power Supply Desktop unit, 1.m DC cable 15.5 x 11.5 x 3.5 cm Weight 0.7 kg 0.5 kg BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 3-14 Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Description BreezeACCESS II Version 4.3 Revision 3.0 System Manual Book 2: Installation Installation Table of Contents IF-Based Equipment .................................................1-1 Modular Base Station Equipment .......................................1-2 Standalone AU-A/E-NI Access Unit ...................................1-3 Other Items Required for Installation ..................................1-3 Guidelines for Selection of Equipment Locations ..................1-5 AU-RA and AU-RE .............................................................1-5 SU-RA and SU-RE .............................................................1-5 IF Cable ..............................................................................1-6 Indoor Equipment ...............................................................1-6 Installing the Outdoor Unit .......................................................1-7 The Outdoor Unit Bottom Panel .........................................1-7 Pole Mounting the Outdoor Unit .........................................1-9 Connecting the Antenna Cable (SU-RE and AU-RE) .......1-12 Installing the SU-NI and AU-NI Indoor Unit ...........................1-13 Installing the SU-NI/AU-NI Unit ........................................1-14 Installing Modular Base Station Equipment ..........................1-15 BS-SH Slot Assignments ..................................................1-15 The BS-PS .......................................................................1-16 The BS-PS-AC .................................................................1-17 The BS-AU .......................................................................1-18 BS-SH Chassis and Modules Installation Procedure .......1-19 Installing the GU-A-BS GPS and Alarms System .................1-21 BS-GU Front Panel ..........................................................1-21 Installing the GU-RA GPS Antenna ..................................1-23 Installing the BS-GU module ............................................1-24 Daisy-chaining Two or More BS-GU Modules ..................1-24 Indoor SU-R Units ....................................................2-1 Packing Lists ..............................................................................2-2 SU-R Subscriber Unit .........................................................2-2 Other Items Required for Installation ..................................2-2 Installation Guidelines ..............................................................2-3 Location of the Unit ............................................................2-3 Location of the Antenna(s) .................................................2-3 Antenna Diversity ...............................................................2-4 Antenna Polarization ..........................................................2-4 ii BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation Antenna Seal ..................................................................... 2-4 Lightning Protection ........................................................... 2-4 Installing SU-R Indoor Units ..................................................... 2-5 Wall Mounting the Unit ....................................................... 2-5 Connecting the Omni Antennas ......................................... 2-6 Connecting a Detached Antenna ....................................... 2-6 Connecting the Unit to the Power Supply and to the CPE . 2-6 Indoor SU-I and AU-I Units ...................................... 3-1 Packing Lists ............................................................................. 3-2 SU-I/I-D Subscriber Unit ................................................... 3-2 AU-I/I-D Access Unit .......................................................... 3-2 Other Items Required for Installation ................................. 3-2 Installation Guidelines .............................................................. 3-4 Location of the Unit ............................................................ 3-4 Location of the Antenna(s) ................................................. 3-4 Antenna Diversity ............................................................... 3-4 Antenna Polarization .......................................................... 3-5 Antenna Seal ..................................................................... 3-5 Lightning Protection ........................................................... 3-5 Installing SU-I/I-D and AU-I/I-D Units ....................................... 3-7 Connectors and LEDs ........................................................ 3-7 Wall Mounting the Unit ....................................................... 3-9 Connecting Antenna(s) to the Units ................................. 3-11 Connecting the Unit to the Power Supply and to the CPE ..................................................... 3-11 Chapter 1 IF-Based Equipment About This Chapter This chapter describes the basic installation of BreezeACCESS IF-based equipment, including SU-A/E subscriber units, modular base station equipment and stand-alone AU-A/E-NI access units. It includes the following sections: Packing Lists‚ page 1-2, lists the equipment that is packed with each BreezeACCESS IF-based unit. Guidelines for Selection of Equipment Locations‚ page 1-5, gives tips and guidence for locating BreezeACCESS equipment for optimum performance. Installing the Outdoor Unit‚ page 1-7, explains how to install the outdoor elements of BreezeACCESS systems. Installing the SU-NI and AU-NI Indoor Unit‚ page 1-13, outlines the installation procedures for SU-NI and AU-NI units. Installing Modular Base Station Equipment‚ page 1-15, outlines the installation procedures for modular base station equipment. Installing the GU-A-BS GPS and Alarms System‚ page 1-21, outlines the installation procedures for a GPS and Alarms system. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-2 Packing Lists SU-A/E Subscriber Unit SU-NI Indoor unit Outdoor unit: SU-RA with integral antenna –Or– SU-RE with a connector to an external antenna (not included) SU-PS power supply with a mains power cord Pole mounting kit for the outdoor unit Wall mounting kit for the SU-NI unit Modular Base Station Equipment BS-SH Base Station Chassis BS-SH chassis (with blank panels) Rubber legs for optional desktop installation BS-PS DC power supply DC power cable Documentation CD BS-SH-AC Base Station Chassis BS-SH-AC Chassis (with blank panels) Rubber legs for optional desktop installation BS-PS-AC AC Power Supply AC Power Cable Documentation CD AU-A/E-BS Access Units (up to six per chassis) Outdoor unit: AU-RA with integral antenna –Or– AU-RE with a connector to an external antenna (not included) Pole mounting kit for the outdoor unit BS-AU Network Interface module Monitor cable Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-4 GPS cable (30, 60 or 120 meter – supplied separately according to order)* SYNC cable* – for daisy-chaining GPS modules (if necessary) Alarms-In and Alarms-Out cables* for the GPS module (if necessary) Installation tools and materials For local configuration of parameters: A portable PC with Terminal Emulation software and Monitor cable* (Monitor cable is supplied with Access Units) –Or– A portable PC equipped with an Ethernet card and with Telnet software, and an Ethernet cable (see Table 1-1‚ page 1-4) Items marked with an asterisk (*) are available as options from Alvarion. NOTE: The BS-GU does not have an external Monitor port and it should be configured via the Ethernet port using Telnet. Table 1-1: Required Type of Ethernet Cable Unit Type Connection to a PC Connection to a Hub Subscriber Unit that supports a single Ethernet device (SU-1D, SU-1D1V) Straight NA Subscriber Unit that supports multiple Ethernet devices (SU-BD, SU-BD1V) Crossed Straight Access Units Crossed Straight GPS module Straight Crossed Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-5 Guidelines for Selection of Equipment Locations NOTE: Outdoor units and antennas should be installed ONLY by experienced installation professionals who are familiar with local building and safety codes and, wherever applicable, are licensed by the appropriate government regulatory authorities. Failure to do so may void the BreezeACCESS product warranty and may expose the end user or the service provider to legal and financial liabilities. Alvarion and its resellers or distributors are not liable for injury, damage or violation of regulations associated with the installation of outdoor units or antennas. Select appropriate locations for the outdoor unit and for the indoor equipment using the following guidelines: The outdoor unit can be pole or wall mounted. Its location should allow easy access to the unit for installation and testing. The higher the antenna, the better the achievable link quality. Units with an external antenna should be installed as near as possible to the antenna. AU-RA and AU-RE The AU-RA unit with its integrated antenna or the external antenna connected to the AU-RE unit, should be installed where it provides coverage of all Subscriber Units in the area it is intended to serve. The higher the AU-RA or the antenna, the better coverage it can provide. NOTE: The distance between any two antennas should be greater than 40 cm. SU-RA and SU-RE The SU-RA outdoor unit with its integrated antenna, or the external antenna connected to the SU-RE unit, should be installed where it has a direct line of sight with the Base Station antenna. The antenna (integrated on the front side of the SU-RA outdoor unit or external if using SU-RE) should be directed towards the Base Station. The unit should be installed in a way that allows optimal alignment towards the Base Station. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-6 IF Cable The outdoor unit is connected to the indoor unit by means of an IF cable carrying signaling, control signals and power. The IF frequency is 440 MHz. The maximum allowed attenuation of the IF cable connecting the outdoor unit to the indoor unit is 15 dB at 440 MHz, and the maximum allowed DC resistance (the sum of the DC resistance of the inner and outer conductors) is 1.5 ohm. This allows for cable length of up to 30 m when using the standard RG 58 cable. If longer cables are required, a cable with lower attenuation and/or DC resistance should be used. Table 1-2‚ page 1-6 provides details regarding some popular cables such as the RG 58 and RG 213. If the spectral environment is polluted with noise in the 440 MHz band, it is recommended to use a higher quality double-shielded cable such as the LMR 200, LMR 240 and LMR 400 (manufactured by Times Communications). Table 1-2: IF Cables Cable Type RG 58 RG 213 LMR 200 LMR 240 LMR 400 Maximum cable length (m) 30 100 45 65 150 Indoor Equipment The Indoor unit should be installed as close as possible to the point where the IF cable enters the building. The location of the indoor unit should also take into account the need to connect it to a power mains outlet and to the CPE. NOTE: The system complies with the ETS 300 385 standard and is protected against secondary lightning strikes when its outdoor unit is properly grounded according to the applicable country-specific industry standards for protection of structures against lightning. The system complies with EN 61000-4-5, test level 3 (2kV). Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-7 Installing the Outdoor Unit NOTE: Outdoor units must be installed by a professional installer only. The Outdoor Unit Bottom Panel The SU-RA and AU-RA outdoor units include the radio and an integral high-gain flat antenna located on the front of the unit. The SU-RE and AU-RE outdoor radio units have an RF connector for connection to an external antenna. Figure 1-1: SU-RA/RE Bottom Panel Table 1-3: SU-RA/RE LEDs LED Description Functionality ETH Ethernet activity Blinking – Data received from or transmitted to Ethernet LAN Off – No activity on the Ethernet LAN WLNK Wireless link activity Blinking – Receiving packet from the wireless link Off – No reception of packets from the wireless link ALARM Alarm indication On – A problem with the power amplifier or in the locking process of any of the synthesizers Off – Normal operation BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-8 Table 1-4: SU-RA/RE Bar Display Description LED Description Functionality Yellow LED Power On – power is present Off – power is not received from the indoor unit 8 Green LEDs Received signal strength indication Received RF signal level indication in 4 dB resolution, starting from –91 dBm Red LED High RF signal level Received signal level is –40 dBm or higher Figure 1-2: AU-RA/RE Bottom Panel Table 1-5: AU-RA/RE LEDs LED Description Functionality ETH Ethernet activity Blinking – Data received from or transmitted to Ethernet LAN Off – No activity on the Ethernet LAN 12V IN Power On – 12 VDC power is supplied to the unit Off – 12 VDC power is not available ALARM Alarm indication On – A problem with the power amplifier or in the locking process of any of the synthesizers Off – Normal operation Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-9 Pole Mounting the Outdoor Unit The outdoor unit can be secured to the pole using one of the following options: Special brackets and open-ended bolts (supplied with each unit). There are two pairs of threaded holes on the back of the unit, allowing use of the special brackets with various pole widths. Metal bands (9/16" wide, minimum 12" long). Figure 1-3‚ page 1-10 shows the locations of the band grooves and threaded holes on the rear side of the outdoor unit. Figure 1-4‚ page 1-10 illustrates the method of installing an outdoor unit on a pole, using the brackets and open-ended bolts. NOTE: Make sure to install the unit with the bottom panel (the panel with the IF connector) facing downward. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-10 Figure 1-3: Grooves/Threaded Holes Figure 1-4: 3" Pole Mounting Installation Using the Special Brackets NOTE: When inserting the open-ended bolts, make sure to insert them with the grooves pointing outwards; these grooves are intended to allow fastening of the bolts with a screwdriver. Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-11 The integral antenna of the AU-RA is relatively long. The top of the antenna should also be secured to the pole, as shown in Figure 1-5:. Figure 1-5:: Pole Mounting the AU-RA Figure 1-6:: Pole Mounting the AU-RA (Top View) NOTE: The top of the AU-RA antenna must be secured to the pole only in order to keep it from moving due to strong winds or other adverse conditions. Do not over tighten the screws in order to avoid damaging the antenna. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual IF Based Equipment 1-13 Installing the SU-NI and AU-NI Indoor Unit Figure 1-7: SU-NI with Voice Support Rear Panel Figure 1-8: SU-NI/AU-NI Front Panel NOTE: The rear panel pictured above in Figure 1-7 is a SU-NI with voice support; AU-NI units and SU-NI units that belong to Subscriber Units without voice support are identical, except that they have no TEL port. Table 1-6: SU-NI/AU-NI LEDs LED Description Functionality PWR Power Supply On – After successful power up, indicating that 12 VDC is supplied to the outdoor unit. Off – Power off or failure to supply 12 VDC to the outdoor unit. WLNK Wireless Link Activity Blinking – Receiving packets from the wireless media Off – No reception of packets from the wireless media BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-14 The SU-NI/AU-NI provides the following interfaces: An Ethernet connector (marked ETH) for connecting the unit to the network. See Table 1-1‚ page 1-4 for information on the required type of Ethernet cable. An IF connector for connecting the unit to an outdoor unit. A DC-12V connector for the power supply. A MON connector for connecting an ASCII terminal with terminal emulation software for configuration and maintenance purposes. A TEL connector (Sunscriber Units with voice support only) for connecting a regular telephone. Installing the SU-NI/AU-NI Unit 1. Place the unit in an appropriate location on a shelf or a table. The unit can be wall mounted using the installation materials provided with the unit. Use a 6 mm (1/4") drill and the supplied template plate for easy and accurate marking of the holes. 2. Connect the power supply DC power cord to the DC In jack (marked DC-12V) located on the rear panel of the unit (shown in Figure 1-7‚ page 1-13). 3. Connect the IF cable to the IF connector (marked IF). The other side of the IF cable should already be connected to the outdoor unit. 4. Connect the mains power cord to the power supply unit. Connect the mains power plug to a mains power outlet. 5. Verify that the Power LED (marked PWR) located on the front panel of the unit, as shown in Figure 1-8‚ page 1-13, is lit. Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-15 Installing Modular Base Station Equipment BS-SH Slot Assignments The base station chassis has ten slots. Figure 1-9: BS-SH Chassis Slot Assignments The two wide slots on both sides of the shelf accommodate the BS-PS or BS-PS-AC power supply modules. The shelf is designed to support power supply redundancy through the use of two power supply modules. If a single power supply is used, it can be inserted in any of the two available slots. When using two power supply modules, both modules must be the same type (either both BS-PS or both BS-PS-AC). The remaining eight slots can accommodate up to six active BS-AU modules. Two extra slots are for an optional BS-GU GPS module and/or for future use. BS-AU and BS-GU modules can be installed in any of the eight slots. Unused slots should be covered by blank panels. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-16 The BS-PS The BS-PS provides power to all the modules installed in the BS-SH chassis. The BS-PS front panel is shown in Figure 1-10‚ page 1-16. Figure 1-10: BS-PS Front Panel The BS-PS provides a power input connector (marked -48V) for connecting the -48VDC power source to the module. The color codes of the cable wires are: Black Red -48 VDC + (Return) The power switch turns the mains power to the power supply ON and OFF. Table 1-7: BS-PS LEDs LED Description ON -48 VDC is available and power supply is on 5V The 5V power supply module is OK and power is consumed (at least one BS-AU module is inserted) 12V The 12V power supply module is OK and power is consumed (at least one AU-RA/RE unit is connected) Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-17 The BS-PS-AC The BS-PS-AC is an AC to DC converter that provides power to all the modules installed in the BS-SH chassis. The BS-PS-AC front panel is shown in Figure 1-11‚ page 1-17. Figure 1-11: BS-PS-AC Front Panel The BS-PS-AC provides a power input connector (marked AC IN) for connecting the AC power cable to the mains. The ON/OFF power switch controls the connection of the mains power to an AC to DC converter. Table 1-8: BS-PS-AC LEDs LED Description 3.3V Green LED. Indicates that the 3.3V power supply module is OK (3.3V power supply is not used by current BreezeACCESS modules) 5V Green LED. Indicates that the 5V power supply module is OK 12V Green LED. Indicates that the 12V power supply module is OK OVER TEMP Red LED. Indicates an Over Temperature condition in the power supply module NOTE: If the Over Temp indication stays on for more than 10 seconds, the power supply module will shut itself offautomatically to prevent damage. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-18 WARNING: If two power supply modules are used in the same chassis for redundancy, both power supplies must be of the same type. Do not use a mix of AC and DC power supply modules in the same chassis. The BS-AU Figure 1-12: BS-AU Front Panel Table 1-9: BS-AU LEDs Name Description Functionality PWR Power supply 12 VDC On – After successful power up, indicating that 12 VDC is supplied to the outdoor unit. Off – Power off or DC/DC converter failure (12 VDC not supplied to the outdoor unit) WLNK Wireless link activity Blinking – Receiving packets from the wireless media Off – No reception of packets from the wireless media ALRM Alarm On – Loss of hopping synchronization (in Slave mode) MASTER Master unit On – The unit is configured as Master Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-19 The BS-AU provides the following interfaces: An Ethernet connector (marked ETH) for connecting the BS-AU to the network. A straight Ethernet cable should be used to connect the module to a hub, router or switch. An IF connector for connecting the BS-AU to an outdoor unit (AU-RE or AU-RA). A MON connector for connecting an ASCII terminal with terminal emulation software for configuration and maintenance purposes. The switch on the BS-AU front panel controls the supply of 12 VDC power to the outdoor unit via the IF cable. The momentary RESET position of this switch is for resetting the outdoor unit. In the OFF position, power is not supplied to the outdoor unit, even when the BS-AU unit is still on. BS-SH Chassis and Modules Installation Procedure 1. Install the BS-SH chassis in a 19" cabinet (or place on an appropriate shelf/table). When mounting the BS-SH chassis on a desktop, screw on the rubber legs shipped with the unit. To prevent over-heating, leave a free space of at least 1 U between the upper/lower covers of the chassis and other units. 2. Connect a ground cable between the ground terminal (located on the back panel of the BS-SH chassis) and a grounding point (or to the rack when appropriate). 3. Carefully insert the BS-PS or BS-PS-AC Power Supply and the BS-AU modules into their intended slots and push firmly until they are securely locked. Before inserting the modules, verify that the switches of all BS-AU modules are in the OFF position. Close the captive screws attached to each module. Place blank covers over all the unused slots. 4. Connect the IF cable(s) to the connector(s) marked IF located on the front panel(s) of the BS-AU module(s) as shown in Figure 1-12‚ page 1-18. The other side of the IF cable should already be connected to the outdoor unit. 5. If a BS-PS DC power supply is used, connect the DC power cable to the – 48 VDC In jack (marked –48V) located on the front panel of the BS-PS power supply. If a redundant power supply module is installed, connect a power cable to it as well. Connect the power cable(s) to the –48 VDC BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-20 power source and the black wire to the -48 VDC contact of the power source. Connect the red wire to the + (Return) contact. Connect the shield to the ground. 6. If a BS-PS-AC AC power supply is used, connect the AC power cable to the AC jack (marked AC IN) located on the front panel of the BS-PS-AC power supply. If a redundant power supply module is installed, connect a power cable to that unit as well. Connect the power cable(s) to the AC mains. 7. Switch the BS-PS or BS-PS-AC power supplies to ON. Verify that all the power indicator LEDs on the front panel are on. If you are using a BS-PS-AC power supply module, verify that the OVERTEMP alarm indicator is off. 8. Configure the basic parameters in all BS-AU modules as described in Book 3: Commissioning. Set the switches on the front panel of all BS-AU modules in the chassis to ON only after all the basic parameters have been configured properly. This is to avoid transmitting at undesired frequencies. NOTE: Disconnect the IF cable from the BS-AU module before inserting or removing it to/from the BS-SH chassis. Manual Revision: 3.0 IF Based Equipment 1-21 Installing the GU-A-BS GPS and Alarms System BS-GU Front Panel Figure 1-13: BS-GU Front Panel BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-22 Table 1-10: BS-GU Connectors Connector Name Functionality SYNC IN Receives signals from the GPS antenna unit. If more than one collocated BS-GU module is daisy-chained, this connector is used by a “Slave” module to receive signals from the “Master” module’s SYNC OUT connector. SYNC OUT Transfers the signals received on the SYNC IN port. If the module is a “Master” operating in “local” mode, the internally generated synchronization signals are also transferred to the “Slave” via this connector.S AL IN Four connections to receive indications from external devices. AL OUT Three relay outputs to external devices. ETH Ethernet 10BaseT interface. Use a straight cable to connect directly to a PC. Use a crossed cable to connect to a hub. Table 1-11: BS-GU LEDs and Switches LED Name Functionality LED Name Functionality PWR (green) On – Power supply functioning properly. Off – Power supply not functioning properly. OK (green) On – Proper signals are being received from the GPS antenna. Off – The GPS antenna is not connected or it is not functioning properly. A1 (red) On – Alarm In 1 (external) is activated. A2 (red) On – Alarm In 2 (external) is activated. A3 (red) On – Alarm In 3 (external) is activated. A4 (red) On – Alarm In 4 (external) is activated. A5, A6 (red) Reserved for future use. Ethernet Activity -Ethernet Connector embedded LED (green) On – Receiving traffic on the Ethernet port. Off – No activity on the Ethernet port. Ethernet Integrity -Ethernet On – Unit is connected to an Ethernet segment. Connector Embedded LED Off – Unit is not connected to an Ethernet segment. (orange) Reset Manual Revision: 3.0 Press this button with a paper clip or similar object in order to reset the unit. IF Based Equipment 1-23 Installing the GU-RA GPS Antenna 1. Screw the GPS antenna firmly to the special 1” threaded pole. 2. Use the mounting kit supplied with the unit (or any other suitable means) to secure the GPS antenna pole to an existing pole (e.g. any pole used for mounting base station antennas or the outdoor units of the BreezeACCESS Access Units). Choose the location to ensure an obstacle-free line of sight from the GPS antenna to the sky, extending at least 30 degrees in all directions. Figure 1-14: GPS Installation 3. Secure the GPS cable to the mounting pole, leaving a free length of cable (with the 12-pin round connector at the end) sufficient for connecting to the antenna module. WARNING: The cable is very heavy and connecting it to the antenna without first securing it to the pole may damage the connector. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 1-24 4. Connect the 12-pin round connector to the GPS antenna. 5. Route the cable to the location intended for installation of the BS-GU module. NOTE: Outdoor units and antennas should be installed ONLY by experienced installation professionals who are familiar with local building and safety codes and, wherever applicable, are licensed by the appropriate government regulatory authorities. Failure to do so may void the BreezeACCESS product warranty and may expose the end user or the service provider to legal and financial liabilities. Alvarion and its resellers or distributors are not liable for injury, damage or violation of regulations associated with the installation of outdoor units or antennas. Installing the BS-GU module NOTE: When adding the BS-GU to an active base station, it is recommended to start by reconfiguring the AU previously defined as Master to Slave, then immediately inserting and configuring the Number of Hopping Frequencies parameter in the BS-GU module. Otherwise both the Master AU and the BS-GU will send conflicting synchronization signals to the Slave AUs. During this process, connectivity with the Subscriber Units will be interrupted. It is recommended to perform the upgrade during a planned downtime or at a time of minimal traffic. Properly configuring the value of the Number of Hopping Frequencies parameter in the BS-GU is mandatory for proper operation of the base station. All other parameters of the BS-GU module may be configured later as they do not impact the operation of the system. Inserting the BS-GU Module and Connecting It to the Antenna 1. Carefully insert the BS-GU module into any of the free suitable slots in the BS-SH chassis and push firmly until it is securely locked. Close the captive screws attached to the module. 2. Connect the 9-pin micro D-Type connector of the GPS cable to the SYNC IN connector (the top-left connector) of the BS-GU module. WARNING: Deactivate the power to the BS-GU unit before connecting it to a GPS antenna. Switch on the BS-GU only after the GPS antenna has been connected. Daisy-chaining Two or More BS-GU Modules If two or more BS-GU modules are installed in different collocated BS-SH chassis, use a synchronization cable (supplied separately) to connect the SYNC OUT connector of the first (Master) module to the SYNC IN connector of the second module. The SYNC OUT of this second module may be connected to the SYNC IN of a third module, and so on. Manual Revision: 3.0 Chapter 2 Indoor SU-R Units About This Chapter This chapter explains how to install BreezeACCESS SU-R units and includes the following sections: Packing Lists‚ page 2-2, lists the equipment that is packed with each BreezeACCESS SU-R unit. Installation Guidelines‚ page 2-3, gives general tips and instructions for installing BreezeACCESS SU-R units. Installing SU-R Indoor Units‚ page 2-5, outlines the installation procedures for SU-R units. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 2-2 Packing Lists SU-R Subscriber Unit The SU-R units are shipped with the following units and accessories. The exact packing list varies depending on system configuration and ordered equipment. SU-R unit Antenna unit: Two clip-on omni antennas –Or– A wall/window mountable antenna –Or– A high-gain outdoor antenna A power supply Wall mounting kit for the SU-R unit An Ethernet cable (straight) Other Items Required for Installation Antenna* and RF cable* according to specific installation conditions. Ethernet cable to connect the equipment to the Ethernet outlet (see Table 2-1‚ page 2-3) Telephone cord for connecting a Subscriber Unit with voice support to a telephone set (RJ 11 connector at the Subscriber Unit side) Installation tools and materials. For local configuration of parameters: A portable PC with terminal emulation software and monitor cable* (monitor cable is supplied with Access Units) –Or– A portable PC equipped with an Ethernet card and with Telnet software, and an Ethernet cable (see Table 2-1‚ page 2-3) Items marked with an asterisk (*) are available as options from Alvarion. Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 2-3 Table 2-1: Required Type of Ethernet Cable Unit Type SU-R Subscriber Unit Connection to a PC Connection to a Hub Straight Crossed Installation Guidelines This section describes the installation guidelines and the various considerations that must be taken into account when planning the installation. Location of the Unit The unit can be placed on a desktop or a shelf, or can be attached to a wall. The unit should be installed as near as possible to the antenna (models with detached antenna). The RF cable connecting the unit to the antenna should be as short as possible to guarantee minimum power loss. Keep the units well away from sources of heat, such as radiators, air-conditioners, and so on. Units with voice support should be installed at a distance of at least 3m from an indoor antenna to prevent interference to telephony services. If a directional indoor antenna is used, do not install the unit in the area covered by the antenna’s radiation pattern. Location of the Antenna(s) Any physical object in the path between two units can cause signal attenuation. Common obstructions are buildings and trees. If a unit’s antenna is installed indoors, the walls and/or windows between the two sites are physical obstructions. Any buildings or other physical structure, such as trees, mountains or other natural geographic features higher than the antenna and situated in the path between the two sites, can constitute obstructions. Install indoor antennas as close as possible to a window (or wall if a window is not accessible) facing the required direction. Avoid metal obstacles such as metal window frames or metal film anti-glare windows in the transmission path. Install outdoor antennas high enough to avoid any obstacles, which may block the signal. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 2-4 Position the antennas clear of metal furniture and away from moving metal objects such as metal fans or doors. Antenna Diversity Multipath propagation is to be expected when there are potential reflectors between the Access Unit and Subscriber Units. These reflectors may be buildings or moving objects such as airplanes and motor vehicles. If this is the case, the radio signal does not travel in a straight line, but is reflected or deflected off of the object, creating multiple propagation paths. In applications where no multipath propagation is expected, a single antenna is sufficient to ensure good performance levels. However, in cases where multipath propagation exists, Alvarion recommends that two antennas be used. This takes advantage of space diversity capabilities. By using two antennas per unit, the system can select the best antenna on a per-packet basis (every several milliseconds). When installing a single antenna, configure the Transmit Antenna option to either Antenna 1 or Antenna 2, according to the antenna being used. When using two antennas, configure the Transmit Antenna option to Both Antennas. Antenna Polarization Antenna polarization must be the same at either end of the link. In most applications, the preferred orientation is vertical polarization. Above ground propagation of the signal is better when the antenna is polarized vertically. For omni antennas, make sure that the antennas are extended upward vertically in relation to the floor to achieve vertical polarization. To verify polarization of detached antennas, refer to the assembly instructions supplied with the antenna set. Antenna Seal When using outdoor antennas, you must seal the antenna connectors against rain. Otherwise the antennas are not suitable for use in outdoor installations. Lightning Protection Lightning protection is designed to protect people, property and equipment by providing a path to the ground for the lightning’s energy. The lightning arrestor diverts the strike energy to the ground along a deliberate and controlled path instead of allowing it to choose a random path. Lightning protection for a building is more forgiving than protection of electronic devices. A building can withstand up to 100,000 volts, but electronic equipment may be damaged by just a few volts. Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 2-5 Lightning protection entails connecting an antenna discharge unit (also called an arrestor) to each cable as close as possible to the point where it enters the building. It also entails proper grounding of the arrestors and of the antenna mast (if the antenna is connected to one). The lightning arrestor should be installed and grounded at the point where the cable enters the building. The arrestor is connected to the unit at one end and to the antenna at the other end. The professional installer you choose must be knowledgeable about lightning protection. The installer must install the lightning protector in a way that maximizes lightning protection. Installing SU-R Indoor Units Wall Mounting the Unit NOTE: To avoid drilling unnecessary holes, it is recommended to verify connectivity with the base station prior to drilling holes in the locations intended for the SU-R unit and/or the indoor antenna. The template on the packaging box can be used to mark the locations of the screws on the wall (drill right through the markings on the box). After insertion of the anchors and screws, hang the unit on the two screws with the bottom panel (the side with the connectors) facing downward. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 2-6 Connecting the Omni Antennas 1. Connect the omni antennas to antenna ports 1 and/or 2 on the sides of the unit. Push each antenna connection carefully into a port with the antenna facing downward and carefully turn the antenna upward to firmly lock it. 2. Extend the antennas upward vertically in relation to the floor to achieve vertical polarization. Connecting a Detached Antenna 1. Connect the special adapter to antenna port 1 (marked 1) on the side of the unit. Push the adapter carefully into the hole using the alignment markings on the adapter and the unit, and turn it 180 degrees to firmly lock it. 2. Connect the antenna cable to the adapter. If you use a heavy cable, secure the cable so as to prevent applying excessive force on the adapter and connector. Connecting the Unit to the Power Supply and to the CPE The unit operates on a power input of 5VDC, supplied by the power transformer included with the unit. Figure 2-1: SU-R Unit with Voice Support Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 2-7 1. Plug the output jack of the power transformer into the DC input jack (marked DC IN) located on the bottom panel of the unit. 2. Connect the supplied universal power transformer to a power outlet -110/ 220VAC. 3. Use a straight Ethernet 10BaseT cable to connect the Ethernet port (marked ETH) to a PC or to a hub’s uplink port. Use a crossed Ethernet10BaseT cable to connect to a hub. 4. For units with voice support, use the standard RJ 11 cable connected to the telephone set to connect the telephone to the telephone port (marked TEL). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 2-8 Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation Chapter 3 Indoor SU-I and AU-I Units About This Chapter This chapter explains how to install BreezeACCESS SU-I and AU-I units and includes the following sections: Packing Lists‚ page 3-2, lists the equipment that is packed with each BreezeACCESS SU-I and AU-I units. Installation Guidelines‚ page 3-4, give general tips and instructions for installing BreezeACCESS SU-I and AU-I units. Installing SU-I/I-D and AU-I/I-D Units‚ page 3-7, outlines the installation procedures for SU-I and AU-I units. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 3-2 Packing Lists SU-I/I-D Subscriber Unit Subscriber Unit: SU-I with 2 integral omni antennas –Or– SU-I-D with connectors to external antenna(s) Power Supply 5 VDC universal power adaptor (Data only units) –Or– Desktop universal power transformer with an AC power cable (Data + Voice units) Mounting bracket for wall or ceiling installation A torque key for the antenna connectors (SU-I-D units) AU-I/I-D Access Unit Access Unit: AU-I with 2 integral omni antennas –Or– AU-I-D with connectors to external antenna(s) 5 VDC universal power adaptor Mounting bracket for wall or ceiling installation A torque key for the antenna connectors (AU-I-D units) Monitor cable Documentation CD Other Items Required for Installation Antenna* and RF cable* according to specific installation conditions for units with external separate antennas Ethernet cable to connect the equipment to the Ethernet outlet (see Table 3-1‚ page 3-3) Telephone cord for connecting a Subscriber Unit with voice support to a telephone set (RJ 11 connector at the Subscriber Unit side) Installation tools and materials. Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 3-3 For local configuration of parameters: A portable PC with Terminal Emulation software and Monitor cable* (Monitor cable is supplied with Access Units) –Or– A portable PC equipped with an Ethernet card, Telnet software and an Ethernet cable (see Table 3-1‚ page 3-3) Items marked with an asterisk (*) are available as options from Alvarion. Table 3-1: Required Type of Ethernet Cable Unit Type Connection to a PC Connection to a hub SU-I/I-D Subscriber Unit that supports a single Ethernet Straight devices (SU-1D, SU-1D1V) NA SU-I/I-D Subscriber Unit that supports multiple Ethernet devices (SU-8D, SU-8D1V, SU-BD, SU-BD1V) Crossed Straight AU-I/I-D Access Units Crossed Straight BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 3-4 Installation Guidelines This section describes the installation guidelines and the various considerations that must be taken into account when planning the installation. Location of the Unit The unit can be placed on a desktop or a shelf, or can be attached to a wall. The unit should be installed as near as possible to the antenna (models with detached antenna). The RF cable connecting the unit to the antenna should be as short as possible to guarantee minimum power loss. Keep the units well away from sources of heat, such as radiators, air-conditioners, etc. Location of the Antenna(s) Any physical object in the path between two units can cause signal attenuation. Common obstructions are buildings and trees. If a unit’s antenna is installed indoors, the walls and/or windows between the two sites are physical obstructions. Any buildings or other physical structure such as trees, mountains or other natural geographic features higher than the antenna and situated in the path between the two sites can constitute obstructions. Install indoor antennas as close as possible to a window (or wall if a window is not accessible) facing the required direction. Avoid metal obstacles such as metal window frames or metal film anti-glare windows in the transmission path. Install outdoor antennas high enough to avoid any obstacles, which may block the signal. Position the antennas clear of metal furniture and away from moving metal objects such as metal fans or doors. Antenna Diversity Multipath propagation is to be expected when there are potential reflectors between the Access Unit and Subscriber Units. These reflectors may be buildings or moving objects such as airplanes and motor vehicles. If this is the case, the radio signal does not travel in a straight line, but is reflected or deflected off of the object, creating multiple propagation paths. In applications where no multipath propagation is expected, a single antenna is sufficient to ensure good performance levels. However, in cases where multipath propagation exists, Alvarion recommends that two antennas be used. This takes advantage of space diversity Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 3-5 capabilities. By using two antennas per unit, the system can select the best antenna on a per-packet basis (every several milliseconds). When installing a single antenna, configure the Transmit Antenna option to either Antenna 1 or Antenna 2, according to the antenna being used. When using two antennas, configure the Transmit Antenna option to Both Antennas. Antenna Polarization Antenna polarization must be the same at either end of the link. In most applications, the preferred orientation is vertical polarization. Above ground propagation of the signal is better when it is polarized vertically. For omni antennas, make sure that the antennas are extended upward vertically in relation to the floor to achieve vertical polarization. To verify polarization of detached antennas, refer to the assembly instructions supplied with the antenna set. Antenna Seal When using outdoor antennas, you must seal the antenna connectors against rain. Otherwise the antennas are not suitable for use in outdoor installations. Lightning Protection Lightning protection is designed to protect people, property and equipment by providing a path to ground for the lightning’s energy. The lightning arrestor diverts the strike energy to the ground along a deliberate and controlled path instead of allowing it to choose a random path. Lightning protection for a building is more forgiving than protection of electronic devices. A building can withstand up to 100,000 volts, but electronic equipment may be damaged by just a few volts. Lightning protection entails connecting an antenna discharge unit (also called an arrestor) to each cable as close as possible to the point where it enters the building. It also entails proper grounding of the arrestors and of the antenna mast (if the antenna is connected to one). The lightning arrestor should be installed and grounded at the point where the cable enters the building. The arrestor is connected to the unit at one end and to the antenna at the other end. The professional installer you choose must be knowledgeable about lightning protection. The installer must install the lightning protector in a way that maximizes lightning protection. AL 1 Lightning Arrestor - Part No. 872905 5 ft (1.5m), “N” Male to “N” Female is available from Alvarion. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 3-6 NOTE: Detached outdoors antennas should be installed ONLY by experienced antenna installation professionals who are familiar with local building and safety codes and, wherever applicable, are licensed by the appropriate government regulatory authorities. Failure to do so may void the BreezeACCESS Product Warranty and may expose the end user to legal and financial liabilities. Alvarion and its resellers or distributors are not liable for injury, damage or violation of government regulations associated with the installation of detached antennas. Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 3-7 Installing SU-I/I-D and AU-I/I-D Units Connectors and LEDs The unit provides the following interfaces: Figure 3-1: SU-I Rear Panel An Ethernet connector (marked ETH) for connecting the unit to the network. See Table 3-1‚ page 3-3 for information on the required type of Ethernet cable. A TEL connector (Subscriber Units with voice support only) for connecting a regular telephone. Figure 3-2:: SU-I/AU-I Side View A DC-IN 5V connector for the power transformer. A MON connector for connecting an ASCII terminal with terminal emulation software for configuration and maintenance purposes. Two ANT connectors for external antennas (SU-I-D/AU-I-D units only) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 3-8 Figure 3-3: SU-I Front Panel Table 3-2: SU-I LEDs Name Description Functionality POWER Power supply On – After successful power up Off – Power off WIRELESS LINK Wireless Link Activity Blinking – Receiving packets from the wireless link Off – no reception of packets from the wireless link ETHERNET Ethernet activity Blinking – Reception of data from Ethernet LAN Off – No reception of data from Ethernet LAN SIGNAL QUALITY Quality of received RF signal Very low quality reception or not synchronized with Access Unit. Low quality reception (usually enabling 1Mbps traffic). Medium quality reception (usually enabling 2 Mbps traffic). High quality reception (usually enabling 3 Mbps traffic). Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 3-9 Figure 3-4:: AU-I Front Panel Table 3-3: AU-I LEDs Name Description Functionality POWER Power supply On – After successful power up Off – Power off WIRELESS LINK Wireless Link Activity Blinking – Receiving packets from the wireless link Off – no reception of packets from the wireless link LOAD Number of active subscriber units No subscribers 1-8 subscribers 9-16 subscribers 17 or more subscribers Wall Mounting the Unit Use the supplied brackets for wall mounting to install the unit on a wall or a ceiling. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 3-10 1. Turn the unit so the rear panel is facing you. 2. Unscrew the two screws located at the antennas end of the unit (the top screws). 3. Align the Unit Mounting Slots (see Figure 3-6) with the slots you have just unscrewed. 4. Using the longer screws supplied with the wall mounts, screw the wall mount to the unit. 5. Align the Convenience Mounting Slots (see Figure 3-2) with the nails, push the wall mount against the wall and let it slide down until it rests on the nails. Figure 3-5: Wall Mounting the Unit Special slots have been added to the wall mounts to allow for unobtrusive cable installation. These slots should be used to fasten cables coming out of the unit to the wall mounts, eliminating loose or tangled cable installations. Convenience Mounting Slots Unit Mounting Slots Cable Fastening Slots Figure 3-6: Wall Mounting Plate Manual Revision: 3.0 Indoor SU-R Units 3-11 Connecting Antenna(s) to the Units For installation convenience, a torque key is included with all BreezeACCESS SU-ID and AU-ID units. WARNING: The use of improper tools for tightening antenna connection cables to BreezeACCESS units may result in damage to the cable connectors. Use the included torque key to tighten the cable(s) to the connector(s) on the side of the unit. The key is designed to prevent over tightening of the screws and protects the connectors from damage. Tighten the cable(s) to the connector(s) using the torque key. Figure 3-7: Tightening the Cable(s) to the Connector(s) If excessive pressure is applied to tighten the screws, the torque key will break. NOTE: Do not attempt to tighten the screws any further. This may damage the connectors on the BreezeACCESS unit. Connecting the Unit to the Power Supply and to the CPE The unit operates on a power input of 5VDC, supplied by the power transformer included with the unit. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Installation 3-12 1. Plug the output jack of the power transformer into the DC input jack (marked DC IN 5V) located on the side of the unit. 2. Connect the power transformer to a power outlet - 110/ 220VAC. 3. Use an Ethernet 10BaseT cable to connect a PC or a hub to the Ethernet port located on the rear panel of the unit. See Table 3-1‚ page 3-3 for details on the required type of the Ethernet cable. 4. For Subscriber Units that support voice, use the telephone cord to connect the telephone port, located on the rear panel of the unit, to the user’s telephone set. Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS II Version 4.3 Revision 3.0 System Manual Book 3: Commissioning Commissioning Table of Contents Setting Basic Parameters .......................................1-1 Accessing the Monitor Program ..............................................1-2 Accessing the Monitor Program using the RS 232 MON Connector ..............................................1-2 Accessing the Monitor Program using Telnet .....................1-3 Operating the Monitor Program ..........................................1-4 Configuring Basic Parameters in Access and Subscriber Units .................................................................1-5 Configuring Parameters in GU-A-BS Units .............................1-6 Introduction .........................................................................1-6 Optimizing the Wireless Link ...................................2-1 Configuring the Maximum Data Rate (Subscriber Units) ....2-2 Aligning the Antenna of the SU-A/E Subscriber Unit .............2-3 Configuring the Transmit Power of the AU-RE .......................2-4 Positioning the SU-I or SU-R Subscriber Unit with Omni Antennas for Optimal Operation ............................2-5 Aligning the External Antenna of SU-R and SU-I-D Units ......2-6 BS-GU Connectors ...................................................3-1 Connecting External Devices to the BS-GU AL IN and/or AL OUT Connectors ......................................................3-2 Alarms In Cable ..................................................................3-2 Alarms Out Cable ...............................................................3-3 GPS Cable .........................................................................3-3 SYNC Cable .......................................................................3-5 Verifying Proper Operation ......................................4-1 Verifying Connectivity ...............................................................4-2 Verifying the Ethernet Connection ......................................4-2 Verifying Data Connectivity (Subscriber Unit) ....................4-2 Verifying Telephone Connectivity (Subscriber Units with Voice support) ...............................4-2 Verifying Proper Operation of the GU-A-BS GPS Unit .......4-3 LED Indicators ...........................................................................4-4 SU-RA/RE Outdoor Units LEDs .........................................4-4 ii BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Commissioning AU-RA/RE Outdoor Units LEDs ......................................... 4-4 SU-NI and AU-NI Indoor Units LEDs ................................. 4-5 BS-PS DC Power Supply Module LEDs ............................ 4-5 BS-PS-AC AC Power Supply Module LEDs ...................... 4-5 BS-AU LEDs ...................................................................... 4-6 BS-GU LEDs ...................................................................... 4-6 SU-R LEDs ........................................................................ 4-7 SU-I/SU-I-D LEDs .............................................................. 4-7 AU-I/AU-I-D LEDs .............................................................. 4-8 Chapter 1 Setting Basic Parameters About This Chapter This chapter explains how to configure the basic parameters of the BreezeACCESS system and includes the following section: Accessing the Monitor Program‚ page 1-2, explains how to accessyour BreezeACCESS units for configuration. Configuring Basic Parameters in Access and Subscriber Units‚ page 1-5, outlines the basic configuration process for BreezeACCESS AU and SUs. Configuring Parameters in GU-A-BS Units‚ page 1-6, outlines the basic configuration process for BreezeACCESS BS-GU units. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Commissioning 1-2 Accessing the Monitor Program Accessing the Monitor Program using the RS 232 MON Connector 1. Use the monitor cable to connect the MON connector of the unit to the COM port of your ASCII ANSI terminal or PC. The COM port connector on the monitor cable is a 9-pin D-type plug. 2. Run a terminal emulation program (such as HyperTerminal™). 3. Set the communication parameters as follows: Baud Rate 9600 Data Bits Stop Bits Parity None Flow Control Xon/Xoff Connector Connected COM port 4. Press Enter. The Select Access Level menu appears. Select the access level according to your authorized access level. You will be requested to enter your password. After entering the correct password, press Enter. Table 1-1‚ page 1-2 lists the default passwords for each of the access levels. Table 1-1: Default Passwords Access Rights Password Read Only public Installer user Administrator private NOTE: Following three unsuccessful login attempts (using incorrect passwords) from either the monitor port or via Telnet, the monitor program will be blocked for five minutes. To access the monitor program during this time, the unit must be reset (via SNMP or by disconnecting/reconnecting power). Manual Revision: 3.0 Setting Basic Parameters 1-3 BreezeACCESS/AU-BS Official Release Version – 4.0.40 Release Date: Thu Dec 20 20:21:36 2001 Main Menu ===================== 1 – Info Screens 2 – Unit Control 3 – Basic Configuration 4 – Site Survey 5 – Advanced Configuration X – Exit >>> Figure 1-1: Main Menu – Administrator Access Rights (SU and AU) The appearance of the Main Menu varies in accordance with the set access level. For users with Read Only access rights, only the Info Screens option is displayed. Users with this access level cannot access the Unit Control, Basic Configuration, Site Survey and Advanced Configuration menus. For users with Installer access rights, the first four menu items (Info Screens, Unit Control, Basic Configuration and Site Survey) are displayed. Users with this access level cannot access the Advanced Configuration menu. For users with Administrator access rights, the full Main Menu will be displayed. These users can access all the menu items. NOTE: The Main Menu of the BS-GU (GPS and Alarms module) does not include the Basic Configuration option. Accessing the Monitor Program using Telnet 1. Connect a PC to the Ethernet port of the unit. See the table below to determine the type of cable. Configure the PC’s IP parameters to enable connectivity with the unit (the default IP Address is 10.0.0.1). Run the Telnet application. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Commissioning 1-4 Table 1-2: Required Type of Ethernet Cable Unit Type Connection to a PC Connection to a Hub All SU-R Units and Subscriber Units that support a single Ethernet device (SU-1D, SU-1D1V) Straight NA Subscriber Units (excluding SU-R Units) that support multiple Ethernet devices (SU-BD, SU-BD1V) Crossed Straight Access Units Crossed Straight GPS module Straight Crossed 2. The Select Access Level menu appears. Select the access level according to your authorized access rights. You will be requested to enter your password. After entering the correct password press Enter. Default passwords are listed in Table 1-1‚ page 1-2. 3. The Main Menu appears. Proceed as you would after connecting via the MON port. Operating the Monitor Program 1. Type an option number to open/activate the option. You may need to press Enter in some cases. 2. Press Esc to exit a menu or option. 3. You can log-out and exit the monitor program from the Main Menu by selecting X (exit). (To get to the Main Menu from anywhere in the program, press the Esc key several times). You can also exit the monitor program from anywhere in the program by simultaneously pressing the Ctrl and X keys. NOTE: The program will terminate automatically after a given period of inactivity specified by the Log-Out Timer parameter. 4. Reset the unit after making configuration changes for the new values to take effect. Manual Revision: 3.0 Setting Basic Parameters 1-5 Configuring Basic Parameters in Access and Subscriber Units The Basic Configuration menu in the Monitor program includes all the parameters necessary for the initial operation of BreezeACCESS Subscriber and Access Units. In many installations, most of these parameters should not be changed from their default values. The following list includes the basic parameters and their default values: Table 1-3: Subscriber and Access Units Basic Parameters Parameter Default Value Comment IP Address 10.0.0.1 Subnet Mask 255.0.0.0 Default Gateway Address 0.0.0.0 DHCP Option Disable Access to DHCP AU: From Ethernet Only SU: From Wlan Only Hopping Set (AU) Hopping Sequence (AU) Hopping Sync (AU-BS only) Idle Transmit Antenna (SU-R, SU-I/AU-I) Antenna 1 Transmit Power Control (IF-based units) 15 Power Level (SU-R, SU-I/AU-I with HW revision C or lower) High Transmit Level (SU-I/AU-I with HW revision D or higher) 17 ATPC Option (IF-based units) AU Disable SU: Enable 1. Cannot be changed in units configured to country standard US FCC, Canada and Australia. 2. If synchronization without GPS is to be supported, one AU should be configured to Master, all other AUs should be configured to Slave. 3. When GPS is used for synchronization, all AUs should be configured to Slave. Cannot be changed in units configured in the factory to “Low” for compliance with local regulations. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Commissioning 1-6 Table 1-3: Subscriber and Access Units Basic Parameters Parameter Default Value Receive Attenuation Control (IF-based SU) Scanning Mode (SU) Active ESSID ESSID1 Operator ESSID Option (AU) Enable Operator ESSID (AU) ESSID1 Best AU Support (SU) Disable Preferred AU MAC Address (SU) 00-00-00-00-00-00 (none) VLAN Link Type Hybrid Link VLAN ID – Management 65535 Authentication Algorithm Open System Default Key ID (SU) WEP Key 1-4 0000000000 (none) Comment Applicable only when Best AU Support is enabled In the SU, can be changed to Shared Key only after configuring the WEP Key and the applicable Default Key ID. In the AU at least one WEP key must be configured. : Subscriber and Access Units Basic Parameters: Once the basic parameters are configured, the unit must be reset in order to activate the new configuration. Configuring Parameters in GU-A-BS Units Introduction This section describes all the parameters that are necessary for the initial installation and operation of GU-A-BS units. Once the unit is properly installed and operational, other parameters can be configured using the monitor program via Telnet or SNMP management. NOTE: The BS-GU does not have an external MON port, and therefore must be configured using Telnet. Since all the parameters needed are found in the Advanced Configuration menu, Administrator level access is required in order to configure a GU-A-BS unit. Manual Revision: 3.0 Setting Basic Parameters 1-7 Refer to Book 4: Operation and Administration for detailed information on the applicable parameters. In many installations, most of these parameters should not be changed from their default values. The following list includes the basic parameters and their default values: Table 1-5: GU-A-BS Units Basic Parameters Parameter Default Value IP Address 10.0.0.1 Subnet Mask 255.0.0.0 Default Gateway Address 0.0.0.0 DHCP Option Disable Number of Hopping Frequencies Comment According to the Number of Hopping Frequencies in the AUs Automatic Recovery Option Disable VLAN ID – Management 65535 Not Applicable to “slave” modules. Once the basic parameters are configured, the unit must be reset in order to activate the new configuration. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-8 Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Commissioning Chapter 2 Optimizing the Wireless Link About This Chapter This chapter explains how to optimize the performance of the wireless link of BreezeACCESS Subscriber Units and includes the following sections: Configuring the Maximum Data Rate (Subscriber Units)‚ page 2-2, explains how to read the RSSI measurement and to configure the optimum value for the Maximum Data Rate parameter. Aligning the Antenna of the SU-A/E Subscriber Unit‚ page 2-3, gives tips and instructions for aligning the antenna of the SU-A/E for optimum performance. Configuring the Transmit Power of the AU-RE‚ page 2-4, gives instructions on configuring the transmit power for compliance with FCC rules. Positioning the SU-I or SU-R Subscriber Unit with Omni Antennas for Optimal Operation‚ page 2-5, gives tips and instructions for setting up units for optimum signal strength. Aligning the External Antenna of SU-R and SU-I-D Units‚ page 2-6, gives tips and instructions for setting up the external antennas of units for optimal signal strength. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Commissioning 2-2 Configuring the Maximum Data Rate (Subscriber Units) The BreezeACCESS units transmit at data rates of 3 Mbps, 2 Mbps and 1Mbps. If the quality of the link is not sufficient, it is recommended to decrease the value of the Maximum Data Rate. Note that the higher the data rate, the higher the error rate. Before reaching a decision on the optimum value for the Maximum Data rate for a specific SU, it is recommended to acquire the RSSI results from the AU. These indicate the level at which the AU receives transmissions from the specific SU (uplink RSSI). The per SU uplink RSSI can be viewed at the AU as follows: 1. From the Main Menu, select Site Survey. 2. In the MAC Address Database submenu, select the Display Association Info option. If the installer cannot access the AU (e.g. using Telnet) and cannot obtain the measurements from the system administrator, the link quality can be estimated based on the RSSI measurement in the SU as follows: 1. From the Main Menu, select Site Survey. 2. Select the Continuous Link Quality Display option. Using the assumption that the link is more or less symmetrical, this value is a good indication to the level at which the SU is received by the AU. Once the RSSI results have been obtained, proceed as follows: 1. If the measured RSSI is less than a certain threshold, it is recommended to decrease the Maximum Data Rate of the SU in accordance with the following table (including a 3 dB safety margin above the applicable sensitivity thrshold). Table 2-1: Maximum Data Rates and RSSI Maximum Data Rate 3 Mbps 2 Mbps 1 Mbps SU-A/E RSSI>-70dBm -78dBm-64dBm -71dBm -65dBm -74dBm >> Figure 1-1: Main Menu – Administrator Access Rights (SU and AU) The appearance of the Main Menu varies in accordance with the set access level.For users with Read Only access rights, only the Info BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 1-4 Screens option is displayed. Users with this access level cannot access the Unit Control, Basic Configuration, Site Survey and Advanced Configuration menus. For users with Installer access rights, the first four menu items (Info Screens, Unit Control, Basic Configuration and Site Survey) are displayed. Users with this access level cannot access the Advanced Configuration menu. For users with Administrator access rights, the full Main Menu will be displayed. These users can access all the menu items. NOTE: The Main Menu of the GU-BS (GPS and Alarms module) does not include the Basic Configuration option. Operating the Monitor Program 1. Type an option number to open/activate the option. You may need to press Enter in some cases. 2. Press Esc to exit a menu or option. 3. You can log-out and exit the monitor program from the Main Menu by selecting X (exit). To get to the Main Menu from anywhere in the program, press the Esc key several times. You can also exit the monitor from anywhere in the program by simultaneously pressing the Ctrl and X keys. NOTE: The program will terminate automatically after a given period of inactivity specified by the Log-Out Timer parameter. 4. Reset the unit after making configuration changes for the new values to take effect. NOTE: Most parameters take effect only after the unit is reset. However, some parameters take effect immediately (run-time configurable). Appendix D includes information on all parameters, including which are run-time configurable. Manual Revision: 3.0 Chapter 2 Menus and Parameters About This Chapter This chapter describes the BreezeACCESS configuration menus and parameters. It includes the following sections: Main Menu‚ page 2-2. Info Screens Menu‚ page 2-3. Unit Control Menu‚ page 2-6. Basic Configuration Menu‚ page 2-13. Site Survey Menu‚ page 2-15. Advanced Configuration Menu‚ page 2-36. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-2 Main Menu From the Main Menu you can access the following menus, depending on your access level: Info Screens – Provides read-only display of current parameter values. Available at all access levels. Unit Control – Enables access to general operations such as resetting the unit, loading the default parameters, changing passwords and switching between software versions. Available at the Installer and Administrator access levels. Basic Configuration – Enables access to the set of parameters that should be configured as a part of the installation process. These parameters are also accessible from the Advanced Configuration menu. Available at the Installer and Administrator access levels in SU and AU (does not exist in GU). Site Survey – Enables activation of certain tests and viewing of various system counters. Available at the Installer and Administrator access levels. Advanced Configuration – Enables access to all system parameters, including the parameters that are included in the Basic Configuration menu. Available only at the Administrator access level. Exit – Enables log-out and exit from the monitor program. Available at all access levels. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-3 Info Screens Menu BreezeACCESS/AU-BS Official Release Version – 4.0.40 Release Date: Thu Dec 20 21:05:08 2001 Info Screens ==================== 1 – Show Unit Status 2 – Show Basic Parameters 3 – Show Advanced Parameters S – Show All Parameters >>> Figure 2-1: Info Screens Menu The Info Screens menu enables viewing of the current values of various parameter sets. The parameter sets are identical to the main parameter groups in the configuration menus. The user can view a specific parameter set or can elect to view all parameters (S). This menu is available for all access levels. Show Unit Status The Show Unit Status menu displays the current values of the following parameters: Unit Type – Identifies the unit’s function as one of the following: Access Unit, Subscriber Unit or GPS and Alarms Module. Unit MAC Address – Displays the unit’s unique IEEE MAC address. Unit Hardware Version – Displays the hardware version of the unit (the indoor module of IF based products). Flash Type – Displays the type and size of the Flash memory. Flash Versions Current Version – Displays the software version that is currently active. Shadow Version – Displays the software version currently defined as the shadow (backup) version. Version After Reset – Displays the software version that will be used after the next reset. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-4 Console Speed – Displays the speed defined in the unit for the connected terminal, used for running the terminal emulation program. Number of Associations Since Last Reset – For SUs - displays the total number of associations with any AU since the last reset, including duplicate associations with the same AU. For AUs - displays the number of SUs that have associated with the AU since the last reset, including duplicate associations with the same SU. The following parameters appear for Subscriber Units only: Voice Hardware Version (SU with voice support only) – Displays the hardware version of the voice module. Unit Status – Displays the current status of the SU. There are two possible values: SCANNING – The SU is searching for an AU with which to associate. ASSOCIATED – The SU is associated with an AU. AU MAC Address – Displays the MAC address of the AU with which the unit is currently associated. If the unit is not associated with any AU, the address will be that of the IEEE broadcast address: FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF. The following parameter appears for Access Units only: Current Number of Associations – Displays the total number of SUs associated with this AU. This number may include units that are not currently active, as there is no aging algorithm for associated SUs. NOTE: An SU will be removed from the list of associated SUs only upon occurrence of any of the following: (1) The AU received from another AU a SNAP frame with the SU MAC address indicating that the SU has become associated with the other AU, or (2) The AU has decided that the SU aged out following its failure to acknowledge a certain number of consecutive frames transmitted to it. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-5 The following parameter appears for GPS Modules only: Unit Status – Indicates the status of the GPS antenna. Either one of the following messages may be displayed: UTC is available; date..; time..: This message indicates that the GPS antenna has synchronized with the satellite system and that the BS-GU is functioning properly. The message may include an incorrect time and date, such as a date in 1999. This indicates that the GPS antenna has not yet synchronized with the GPS satellites system. –Or– UTC time is not available: This message indicates that the BS-GU is not getting timing signals from the GPS antenna. If the antenna is functioning and properly connected to the module, this may be because the antenna has not yet synchronized with the GPS satellite system. Show Basic Parameters The Show Basic Parameters menu displays the current values of the parameters included in the Basic Configuration menu (see Basic Configuration Menu‚ page 2-13). When using Read-Only access rights the ESSID parameters (ESSID, Operator ESSID, Run Time ESSID and Neighboring AU ESSID) and WEP Keys are not displayed. The display includes some additional useful read-only information such as the Number of Hopping Frequencies in SU and AU. Show Advanced Parameters The Show Advanced Parameters menu enables access sub-menus that display the current values of the parameters included in the applicable sub-menus of the Advanced Configuration menu (see Advanced Configuration Menu‚ page 2-36). When using Read-Only access rights the ESSID parameters (ESSID, Operator ESSID, Run Time ESSID and Neighboring AU ESSID in Air Interface Parameters), WEP Keys (Security Parameters) and User Password and Shared Secret (RADIUS Parameters) are not displayed. The display includes some additional read-only information such as Number of Hopping Frequencies (Air Interface Parameters). Show All Parameters The Show All Parameters menu displays the current values of all the parameters included in the Advanced Configuration menu.When using Read-Only access rights the ESSID parameters (ESSID, Operator ESSID, Run Time ESSID and Neighboring AU ESSID in Air Interface Parameters), WEP Keys (Security Parameters) and User Password and Shared Secret (RADIUS Parameters) are not displayed. The display BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-6 includes some additional useful read-only information such as the Number of Hopping Frequencies (SU and AU). Unit Control Menu The Unit Control menu includes the following options: Reset Unit – Resets the BreezeACCESS unit and applies any changes made to the system parameters. Defaults Settings – Resets the unit to a predefined set of default parameters or to save the current configuration as Operator Defaults. The available options are: Set Defaults – Resets the unit to a set of default parameters. The following options are available: Cancel Request – Exits to the Unit Control menu without any change. Set Complete Factory Defaults – Available only with Administrator access rights. Resets the unit to the set of Alvarion’s standard default values. These are the default values as defined in this manual for each of the parameters. After the next reset all parameters will revert to their Factory Defaults value, except for the parameters that are marked in the “Complete” column of Table 2-1‚ page 2-7. NOTE: Activating Set Complete Factory Defaults will result in loss of connectivity. If the unit is managed remotely, you may lose the ability to communicate with it. Set Partial Factory Defaults – Reverts all parameters to the values of the Factory Defaults configuration after the next reset, except for parameters that are necessary to maintain connectivity and to enable management of the unit and some other sensitive parameters. The exact list of parameters that are not changed depends on the access rights of the user. Referring to Table 2-1‚ page 2-7, the parameters that are not changed after activating Set Partial Factory Defaults using Administrator access rights are marked in the “Partial-Admin” Column. The parameters that are not changed after activating Set Partial Factory Defaults using Installer access rights are marked in the “Partial-Installer” Column. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-7 Table 2-1: Parameters not changed after Set Complete/Partial Factory Defaults Parameter Complete Partial – Admin Partial Installer Unit Control Parameters √ Passwords √ √ Event Log Policy √ Auto Configuration Option √ IP Parameters IP Address √ √ Subnet Mask √ √ Default Gateway Address √ √ DHCP Option √ √ Access to DHCP √ √ ESSID √ √ Operator ESSID Option √ √ Operator ESSID √ √ Best AU Support √ √ Preferred AU MAC Address √ √ ACSE Option √ √ Dwell Time √ √ √ √ Hopping Set √ √ Hopping Sequence √ √ Transmit Antenna (SU-R, SU-I, AU-I) √ √ Acknowledge Delay Limit √ √ MAC Address Black List √ √ VLAN Link Type √ √ VLAN ID – Data √ √ VLAN ID – Management (or Management & Voice) √ √ VLAN Forwarding Support √ √ Forwarding VLAN IDs √ √ VLAN Relaying Support √ √ Relaying VLAN IDs √ √ VLAN Priority – Data √ √ VLAN Priority – Management √ √ Air Interface Parameters √ VLAN Parameters BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-8 (Continued) Parameter Complete Partial – Admin Partial Installer VLAN Priority – Voice √ √ VLAN Priority Threshold √ √ VLAN Priority Tag √ √ Authentication Algorithm √ √ Default Key ID √ √ WEP Key 1 to 4 √ √ Security Parameters Network Management Parameters Access To Network Management √ Network Management Filtering √ Network Management IP Addresses √ Send SNMP Traps √ Per Trap Control (all Send Trap Parameters) √ SNMP Traps IP destination √ SNMP Traps Community √ Ports Control Parameters Ethenet Port Control √ √ Voice Port Control √ √ RADIUS Parameters √ RADIUS User Name √ RADIUS User Password √ RADIUS Shared Secret √ Authentication Option √ RADIUS Server Authentication IP address √ RADIUS Server Authentication Port √ Accounting Option √ RADIUS Server Accounting IP address √ RADIUS Server Accounting Port √ Accounting Interval √ Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-9 Set Complete Operator Defaults – Available only with Administrator access rights. Set the unit to its’ Operator Defaults configuration. After the next reset, all parameters will revert to their Operator Defaults values, except for the parameters that are marked in the “Complete” column of Table 2-1‚ page 2- . Operator Defaults configuration can be defined by the Administrator (see Save Current Configuration As Operator Defaults below). It may also be defined at the factory according to customer’s definition. The default Operators Defaults configuration is the Factory Defaults configuration. The complete Operator Defaults Configuration file can be downloaded/uploaded using TFTP with the SNMP Write community string. The procedure is the same as for downloading/uploading configuration files, except that the extension used for the file name is .cmr. Examples (using the default SNMP Write community string): To upload the configuration file using DOS based TFTP Client to an SU whose IP address is 206.25.63.65: tftp 206.25.63.65 put Suconf private.cmr. To download the configuration file from the same unit: tftp 206.25.63.65 get private.cmr Suconf NOTE: Activating Set Complete Operator Defaults will result in loss of connectivity. If the unit is managed remotely, you may lose the ability to communicate with it. Set Partial Operator Defaults – Reverts all parameters to the values of the Operator Defaults configuration after the next reset, except for parameters that are necessary to maintain connectivity and to enable management of the unit and some other sensitive parameters. The exact list of parameters that are not changed depends on the access rights of the user. Referring to Table 2-1‚ page 2-7, the parameters that are not changed after activating Set Partial Operation Defaults using Administrator access rights are marked in the “Partial-Admin” Column. The parameters that are not changed after activating Set Partial Operator Defaults using Installer access rights are marked in the “Partial-Installer” Column. Save Current Configuration As Operator Defaults – Defines the current configuration of the unit as the Operator Defaults configuration. This option is only available with Administrator access rights. Change Unit Name – Changes the name of the unit, which is also the system name in MIB2. This name is also used as the prompt of the monitor program menus. Valid values: A string of up to 32 printable ASCII characters. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-10 Change Password – Changes the password(s). A user with Installer access rights can change the passwords for Read Only and Installer levels. A user with Administrator access rights can change the passwords of all levels. Valid values: A string of up to 8 printable ASCII characters. Table 1-1‚ page 1-2 lists the default passwords for each of the access levels. NOTE: The Passwords are not changed upon setting the unit to default values (either Partial or Complete). Flash Memory Control – Selects the active software version. The following options are available: Reset and Boot from Shadow Version – Activates the Shadow (backup) software version. The unit resets automatically and loads the shadow firmware. Use Current Version After Reset – Defines the current version as the one that will be activated and used after the next reset. The flash memory can store two software versions. One version is called Current and the other is called Shadow. New software versions are loaded as the Shadow version. You can select the Shadow version as the new active version by selecting Reset and Boot from Shadow Version. However, after the next reset, the Current version will be activated again. If you wish to continue using the currently active version after the next reset, select Use Current Version After Reset. The parameters configured in the unit are not changed as a result of downloading new software versions (unless the new version includes additional parameters or other changes in the list of parameters). New parameters are loaded with their default values. Console Speed – Defines the speed at which the unit communicates with the terminal running the terminal emulation program. This parameter must be changed prior to changing the speed of the terminal connected to it. The allowed speeds are: 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600 and 115200 baud. The default value is 9600 baud. Log Out Timer – Enters a new Log Out Timer value. If the monitor program is not used for the specified time, the unit will automatically exit the monitor program. The allowed range is 1 to 999 minutes. The default value is 5 minutes. Event Log Menu – Controls the event log feature. The event log is an important debugging tool and a flash memory sector is dedicated Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-11 for storing it. Events are classified according to their severity level: Trace (lowest severity), Message, Warning, Error or Fatal (highest severity). The severity at which events are saved in the Event Log is configurable. Events from the configured severity and higher are saved and may be displayed upon request. Log history can be displayed up to the full number of current active events. In the log an event is defined as active as long as it has not been erased (a maximum of 1000 events may be displayed). The error log may be read using TFTP, with remote file name .log (the default SNMP Read Community is public). The Event Log Menu includes the following options: Event Log Policy – Determines the minimal severity level. All events whose severity is equal to or higher than the defined severity are logged. Valid values are: Log All (TRC) Level, Message (MSG) Level, Warning (WRN) Level, Error (ERR) Level, Fatal (FTL) Level, Log None. The default selection is Fatal (FTL) Level. Display Event Log – Displays how many events are logged and selects the number of events to be displayed (up to 1000). The display of each event includes the event time (elapsed time since last reset), the severity level and a message string. The events are displayed in descending order, with the most recent event displayed first. Erase Event Log – Clears the event log. Auto Configuration Parameters – A sub-menu that contains the parameters related to using the Auto Configuration mechanism. The Auto Configuration mechanism is intended to simplify the configuration process through automatic loading of a configuration file from a TFTP server. The Auto Configuration process is based on getting from a DHCP server the address of the TFTP server and the name of the configuration file to be loaded. This information is used by the unit to initiate a session with the TFTP server, requesting transfer of the applicable configuration file. Upon completing the process of loading the new configuration file, the unit will reset automatically so that the new configuration will take effect. The following conditions must be met to enable the use of the Auto Configuration process: a. The DHCP Option (see page 2-37) in the unit must be configured to either DHCP Only or Automatic mode to enable communication with the DHCP server. b. The unit must be able to communicate with the DHCP server, according to the configured option of the Access to DHCP parameter (see page 2-37). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-12 c. The address of the TFTP server and the proper name of the configuration file must be configured in the DHCP server: The Server Address should be specified in the ‘sname’ field of the DHCP header. The code for this option is 66, and the minimum length is 1. It must include a legal IP address, with a maximum length of 64 characters (maximum length includes spaces. Extra characters will be ignored). The Configuration File Name should be specified in the ‘file’ field of the DHCP header. The code for this option is 67, and the minimum length is 1. The maximum length is 128 characters (maximum length includes spaces. Extra characters will be ignored). The unit shall initiate a request for a configuration file in the following cases (provided the DHCP Option is enabled): a. After power-up reset (HW reset), provided the Auto Configuration Option is enabled. b. Upon enabling the Auto Configuration Option. c. Upon a user initiated request. NOTE: If the response messages from the DHCP server after the requests for TFTP Server Name and Boot File Name do not include these options, or if invalid values have been received, this DHCP server will not be used for automatic IP parameters assignment. The Auto Configuration Parameters sub-menu includes the following options: Auto Configuration Option – To disable or enable the Auto Configuration mechanism. The default is Disable. Request Auto Configuration – To initiate an Auto Configuration process. NOTE: Upon completion of the Auto Configuration process the unit will reset automatically. Show Auto Configuration Parameters – Displays the status of the Auto Configuration Option and the Auto Configuration Received Status (Received/Not Received), indicating whether an Auto Configuration File has been received. SNMP Read ESSID – This parameter is available only under Administrator access rights. For security reasons, the values of some parameters, including ESSID and Run Time ESSID, can be viewed (get) using SNMP only with the Write Community string, and are not available with the Read Community string. When this parameter is enabled, it allows viewing (get) the values of ESSID and Run Time ESSID with the Read Community string as well. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-13 Basic Configuration Menu The Basic Configuration menu includes all the parameters that are necessary for the initial installation and operation of the unit. Once the unit is properly installed and operational, other parameters can be configured either locally using the monitor program or remotely using Telnet, SNMP management or TFTP for loading to the unit a pre-prepared configuration file. For more information about the initial configuration of BreezeACCESS units, see Book 3: Commissioning. The Basic Configuration menu includes the following submenu parameters: IP Parameters IP Address (see page 2-36) Subnet Mask (see page 2-36) Default Gateway Address (see page 2-36) DHCP Client (see page 2-37) Air Interface Parameters ESSID (see page 2-40) Operator ESSID Parameters (AU) (see page 2-40) Hopping Sequence (see page 2-37) Hopping Set (see page 2-38) Hopping Sync (AU-BS) (see page 2-39) Transmit Antenna (SU-R, SU-I/I-D) (see page 2-50) Transmit Power Control (IF-based units) (see page 2-44) ATPC Option (IF-based units) (see page 2-47) Receive Attenuation Control (IF-based SU) (see page 2-50) Power Level (SU-R and SU-I/AU-I only) (see page 2-45) Best AU Parameters (SU) (see page 2-41) Best AU Support Preferred AU MAC Address Maximum Data Rate (SU) (see page 2-47) Scanning Mode (SU) (see page 2-52) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-14 VLAN Parameters VLAN ID – Management (AU and SU without voice support) (see page 2-57) VLAN ID – Voice & Management (SU with voice support) (see page 2-58) VLAN Link Type (see page 2-59) Security Parameters Authentication Algorithm (see page 2-81) Default Key ID (see page 2-82) WEP Key # 1 (see page 2-82) WEP Key # 2 (see page 2-82) WEP Key # 3 (see page 2-82) WEP Key # 4 (see page 2-82) NOTE: All parameters in the Basic Configuration menu are also available in the appropriate submenus of the Advanced Configuration menu. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-15 Site Survey Menu The Site Survey menu provides various tests and counters for verifying the quality of the wireless link and the proper operation of the unit. These tests can be used to help determine where to position the units for optimal coverage, to align antennas and to assist in troubleshooting. Traffic Statistics (AU and SU) The traffic statistics can be used to monitor, interpret and analyze the wired and wireless links performance. The traffic statistics counters display statistics concerning wireless link and Ethernet frames. The menu includes the following options: Display Counters – Choose this option to display the current value of the Ethernet and Wireless Link Counters. Reset Counters – Choose this option to reset all the counters. Ethernet Counters The unit receives Ethernet frames from its Ethernet port and forwards them to its internal bridge which decides whether the frame should be transmitted to the wireless media. Frames that were discarded by the unit’s hardware filter are not counted by the Ethernet counters. The unit transmits valid data frames that were received from the wireless media to the Ethernet port, as well as some internally generated frames (e.g. responses to management queries and pings that reached the unit from the Ethernet port). Total received frames via Ethernet – Displays the total number of frames received from the Ethernet port. Transmitted wireless to Ethernet – Displays the number of frames transmitted by the unit to the Ethernet port. These are usually frames that have been received from the wireless side, but also frames generated by the unit itself. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-16 Wireless Link Counters The unit transmits data frames received from the Ethernet port, as well as self-generated control and wireless management frames, to the wireless media. After transmission of a unicast frame, the unit waits for an acknowledgement (ACK) message from the receiving unit. Some control and wireless management frames as well as broadcast and multicast frames that are sent to more than one unit are not acknowledged. If an ACK is not received after a predefined time (determined by the Acknowledge Delay Limit parameter, see page 2-48), the unit will retransmit the frame until it receives an ACK. If an ACK is not received before the number of retransmissions has reached a maximum predefined number (Number of Retransmissions parameter, see page 2-69), it stops retransmitting and drops the frames. Total transmitted frames to wireless – Displays the number of frames transmitted to the wireless media. The total includes one count for each data or RTP frame (internally generated voice frame) that was transmitted successfully (excluding retransmissions) as well as the number of transmitted control and wireless management frames. If the ACSE Option (see page 2-51) is enabled, then in addition to the total count, there are also separate counters for the total number of data frames, voice (RTP) frames and beacon frames. The voice frames include fax frames. This is true also for Subscriber Units that do not support voice in cells where the ACSE Option parameter in the AU is enabled. In this case the Voice count should be 0. Total transmitted unicast frames to wireless - Displays the number of unicast frames successfully transmitted to the wireless media, excluding retransmissions. This count is useful for calculating the rates of retransmissions or dropped frame, since only unicast frames are retransmitted if not acknowledged. Total submitted frames (bridge) – Displays the total number of data and RTP frames submitted to the bridge for transmission to the wireless media. The count does not include control frames, wireless management frames, and retransmissions. In addition to the total count, there are also separate counts for frames according to the priority queue to which they were routed (Low, Mid, or High). If the ACSE Option is enabled, then the Low, Mid and High counts are for data frames only and there is an additional counter for voice (RTP) frames. The voice frames count includes fax frames. This is true also for Subscriber Units that do not support voice in cells where the ACSE Option in the AU is enabled. In this case the Voice count should be 0. Frames dropped (too many retries) – Displays the number of dropped frames. The frames that were retransmitted to the extent of the maximum allowed number of retransmissions without being acknowledged. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-17 If the ACSE Option is enabled, then in addition to the total count, there are also separate counters for total number of data frames and voice (RTP) frames. The voice frames count includes fax frames. This is true also for Subscriber Units that do not support voice in cells where the ACSE Option in the AU is enabled. In this case the Voice count should be 0. Total retransmitted frames – Displays the total number of retransmissions of frames (counts all unsuccessful transmissions/retransmissions). If the ACSE Option is enabled, then in addition to the total count, there are also separate counters for total number of Data frames and Voice (RTP) frames. This is true also for Subscriber Units that do not support voice in cells where the ACSE Option in the AU is enabled. In this case the Voice count should be 0. Total Tx errors – Displays the number of transmit errors that have occurred. The total number of Tx errors includes transmissions that were not acknowledged properly, transmissions that were aborted and transmissions that were delayed for various reasons (e.g. not enough time until the end of the current dwell period). In addition, the following special counters are displayed to indicate the reason for the error: H/W: An internal hardware problem in the modem. ABR: The transmission was aborted before completion because of internal problems in the DSP. CSL: The transmission was cancelled because the modem was busy in receiving data. ACKTOUT (Acknowledge Timeout): The frame was not acknowledged within the time defined by the Acknowledge Delay Limit parameter. FAIL: There was an internal timeout in the modem. ACKCRC: There was a CRC error in the ACK message. RTSC: The RTS was sent but no CTS was received (RTS collision). EOD (End of Dwell): There was not enough time left to transmit the message Total received frames from wireless – Displays the total number of frames that were received from the wireless media. The count includes data, control and wireless management frames, including beacons received from the AU. The count does not include frames that were discarded internally, bad frames and duplicate frames. Total received data frames – Displays the total number of data frames received from the wireless media, including duplicate frames (see Duplicate frames discarded, below). In addition to the total count, there are also separate counts for data frames according to the receive priority queue to which they were routed (Low or High). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-18 Bad fragments received – Displays the number of frames received from the wireless media with errors (CRC errors). Duplicate frames discarded – Displays the number of frames discarded due to receiving multiple copies. If an acknowledge message was not received by the originating unit, the same data frame can be properly received twice (or more). Although duplicate frames are included in all counters that count data frames, only the first copy is forwarded to the Ethernet port. Internally discarded MIR/CIR – Displays the number of data frames received from the Ethernet port that were discarded by the MIR/CIR mechanism to avoid exceeding the maximum allowed information rate. Voice Statistics (SU with Voice Support Only) The voice statistics counters display information concerning voice and fax traffic, including T.38 redundant fax traffic. The displayed information includes the accumulated numbers since the last reset for transmitted and received RTP frames and bytes. Display Counters – Displays the current value of the following voice counters. Voice Frames Transmitted Voice Frames Received Voice Bytes Transmitted Voice Bytes Received Reset Counters – Resets the voice counters. Per Hop Statistics (AU and SU) The Per Hop Statistics provide information on performance of the wireless signal at different hopping frequencies. The Per Hop Statistics menu includes the following options: Display Counters – Displays the continuously updated statistics. Reset Counters – Resets the Per Hop Statistics counters. The Display Counters option displays various statistics for each of the hopping frequencies. In addition, it displays some general wireless link performance statistics. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-19 Hopping Statistics Num The number of the information row, assigned automatically and sequentially by the program. Freq The hopping frequency, according to the hopping sequence. Rx The accumulated number of frames received at the specified frequency since last reset. Tx The accumulated number of frames transmitted successfully at the specified frequency since last reset. RTx The accumulated number of frames re-transmitted at the specified frequency since last reset. avrDBM (avrRSSI) The average RSSI (Received Signal Strength Indication) in dBm or RSSI units (according to the RSSI Display Option) of all the frames received at the specified frequency since the last reset. If no frames have been received, the avrRSSI is NA (Not Available). The Rx, Tx and RTx per hop counters accumulate the number of applicable frames since last reset. The counters can also be reset using the Reset Counters option in either the Per Hop Statistics menu or in the Traffic Counters menu. The general rate (Frames per second) statistics is the average rate during the last 64 hops. The display is continuously updated. Press any key to exit. Ping Test (AU, SU and GU) The Ping Test menu includes the following options: Destination IP Address – Displays the IP address of the destination unit for pinging. Allows entering an IP address (4 x 3 digit octets, separated by dots). The default IP address is 192.000.000.001. No. of Pings – Enter the number of ping attempts per session. The allowed range is from 0 to 9999. Select 0 for continuous pinging. The default value is 1. Ping Frame Length – Enter the ping packet size. The allowed range is from 60 to 1472 bytes. The default value is 64 bytes. Ping Frame Timeout – Enter the ping frame timeout, which is the amount of time (in ms) to wait between ping attempts. The allowed range is from 200 to 60000 ms, in increments of 200 milliseconds (200, 400, 600,……60000). The default value is 200 ms. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-20 Start Sending – Starts transmission of ping frames. Stop Sending – Stops the transmission of ping frames. The test will end automatically once the number of pings that were sent has reached the value specified in the No. of Pings parameter (described above). The Stop Sending option can be used to end the test before completing the specified number of pings, or if continuous pinging was selected. Show Ping Test Values – To display the current values of the ping test parameters, the transmission status (sending or not), the number of pings sent, and the number of pings received (acknowledged frames). Continuous Link Quality Display (Available in SU Only) This option displays continuously updated entries that include information on the quality of the received signal (Received Signal Strength Indication or RSSI). Press any key to abort the test. Each line includes the number of Beacon frames that were received since the last measurement (total Rx), the average RSSI in dBm or RSSI units (according to the RSSI Display Option) for these frames (avrDBM/avrRSSI) and the Error rate (number of retransmitted frames in the last 100 transmitted frames). The Error rate is meaningful only when there is traffic from the SU to the AU. It is recommended to use the Ping Test (see page 2-19) with a Ping Frame Length of 1472 bytes. MAC Address Database (Available in AU Only) The MAC Address Database displays information on the subscriber units associated with the AU as well as bridging (forwarding) information. The following options are available: Display Bridging & Association Info – Displays a list of all the Subscriber Units and stations in the Forwarding Database of the AU. For stations behind an SU, the SU’s MAC address is also displayed. Each MAC address entry is followed by a description, as follows: Et (Ethernet): Addresses that have been learned from the Ethernet port. Vp (Virtual port): Addresses of the nodes behind an associated SU. For these addresses, the address of the SU is displayed in parenthesis. St (Static): An associated SU. These entries also include the SW Version of the SU. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-21 Sp (Special): 5 Addresses that always exist: The MAC address of the AU (appears twice as it is learned from both the Ethernet and the wireless ports) Alvarion’s Multicast address (01:20:D6:00:00:01, also twice). The system handles this address as a Broadcast address. The Ethernet Broadcast address (FF-FF-FF-FF-FF-FF) In addition, a summary table displays information about the Forwarding Database (Bridging Info), the Associated Subscriber Units Database (Association Info) and the Subscriber Units that are currently conducting a voice call (Call Info). For each of these databases, the displayed information includes: The current number of entries. The number of entries in the Bridging Info includes the Et (Ethernet) and the Vp (Virtual ports) entries. The number of entries in the Association Info includes the associated units. NOTE: There is no aging algorithm for associated SUs. An SU will be removed from the associations database only upon occurrence of any of the following: (1) The AU received from another AU a SNAP frame with the SU MAC address indicating that the SU has become associated with the other AU, or (2) The AU has decided that the SU aged out following its failure to acknowledge a certain number of consecutive frames transmitted to it. The aging time specified for entries in these tables (the defaults are 300 seconds for the Bridge Aging Time, No Aging for the Association Aging Time and 1800 seconds for the Call Info table). The maximum allowed number of entries for these tables (1019 for the Bridging Info and as specified by the Maximum Number of Associations parameter for the Association Info and the Call Info. The default value of the Maximum Number of Associations is 512). Display Association Info – Displays details of the associated SUs. Each entry in the list includes the following information: The MAC address of the associated Subscriber Unit The Maximum Data Rate of the SU. The average level of RF signals received from the Subscriber Unit. The wireless status of the SU. There are three options: Associated Authenticated Not Authenticated (a temporary status) Refer to Table 2-2 for details on the status of the SU during the various stages of the association process. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-22 The SW version of the SU. Table 2-2: Association Process (Active Scanning) Message Direction Status in AU SU Scanning* Probe Request (including ESSID) - Scanning SU → AU Probe Response (only if correct ESSID in Probe Request) AU → SU Authentication Request SU → AU Not Authenticated Challenge Text AU → SU Not Authenticated Challenge Text Encrypted SU → AU Not Authenticated Authentication Successful AU → SU Authenticated Association Request SU → AU Authenticated Association Successful AU → SU Associated ACK SU → AU Associated Data Traffic SU ↔ AU Associated SU Synchronized SU Authenticated * When passive scanning is used, the Scanning Phase is comprised of searching for a Beacon frame with the correct ESSID. Display CIR/MIR Info: Displays details of the CIR/MIR parameters of the associated SUs. Each entry in the list includes the following information: The MAC address of the associated Subscriber Unit. The SW version of the SU. MIR/CIR info for the SU: CIR Tx (SU to AU) MIR Tx (SU to AU) CIR Rx (AU to SU) MIR Rx (AU to SU) Max. Delay. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-23 Per-rate Counters (AU and SU) Resets or displays the per-rate counters. The per-rate counters display the number of frames (excluding retransmissions) transmitted since the last reset at each of the rates (1 Mbps, 2 Mbps, 3 Mbps) and the total number of frames that were retransmitted at each of the rates. In the AU the information is provided for each of the associated SUs, identified by their MAC address. The counters in the AU are reset when there is a new association with an SU (including reassociations). RSSI Display Option (AU and SU) In BreezeACCESS units running SW versions 3.X and below, all measurements of received RF signal levels are displayed using arbitrary RSSI units. From version 4.0 onward, the conventional dBm measurement units can be used. However, to support users that prefer to continue using RSSI units, the RSSI Display option enables selecting the measurement units to be used for displaying received signal level values. Available selections: dBm, RSSI. Default selection: RSSI. ATPC Counter (AU and SU) The ATPC Counter display information related to the number of ATPC power-up/power-down messages sent or received by the unit since last reset. Display Counter – Displays the current value of the ATPC Counter: ATPC Transmitted Messages (IF-based AU only) – The number of ATPC power-up/power-down messages that were sent by the AU since last reset. ATPC Received Messages (SU only) - The number of ATPC power-up/power-down messages that were received by the SU since last reset. This counter is displayed also in units that do not use ATPC, since the AU sends ATPC messages to all SUs, including SUs in which the ATPC Option is disabled and SUs that do not support the ATPC option. Reset Counter – Resets the ATPC Counter. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-24 AU Alarms (IF-based AU Only) The AU Alarms feature enables to identify and alert upon the detection of a potential problem in the outdoor unit of the AU, or another problem that causes significant degradation in the performance of the wireless link. When the AU Alarms Option is enabled, three types of tests are performed: Traffic Statistics tests, Power tests and Associations test. Information is gathered continuously and various calculations used for decision making are performed each test cycle period that is defined by the configurable Test Cycle parameter. Alarms can be generated only after a sufficient time, defined by the configurable Learning Period parameter, has elapsed since the last reset (or since the AU Alarm Option was enabled). Traffic Statistics Tests The AU gathers traffic information that is used to calculate various traffic statistics. The calculated statistics are used for estimating the performance of the wireless link. The following traffic statistics rates are calculated for each test cycle period: a. Current Retransmission Rate - Defined as Nr/(Nt+ Nr), Where: Nr - Number of retransmissions during the last test cycle period. Nt - Number of successfully transmitted unicast frames during the last test cycle. The minimum value of Nt+ Nr for a meaningful test is 50 (otherwise the result is NA). b. Current Dropped Frames Rate - Defined as Nd/Nt, where Nd is the number of dropped frames during the last test cycle period. Dropped frames are frames that were drooped because they were retransmitted to the extent of the maximum allowed number of retransmissions without being acknowledged. The minimum value of Nt for a meaningful test is 50 (otherwise the result is NA). c. Current CRC Error Rate - Defined as Ncrc/(Nrx+Ncrc), where: Ncrc - Number of frames received with a CRC error during the last test cycle period. Nrx - Number of successfully received frames during the last test cycle period. The minimum value of Nrx+Ncrc for a meaningful test is 50 (otherwise the result is NA). d. Current Duplicate Frames Rate - Defined as Ndup/Nrx, where Ndup is the number of dropped frames during the last test cycle period. The minimum value of Nrx for a meaningful test is 50 (otherwise the result is NA). Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-26 Based on the RSSI information responses from the SUs, the AU performs a calculation of the SU Rx Power Average Delta, defined as the average difference for all SUs between the last RSSI at the SU and the previous (one before last) RSSI. The average is calculated only for SUs that responded to both of the last two polling message. The average is calculated as: Σn=1-N [SURSSIn(t) - SURSSIn(t-1)]/N, where: SURSSIn(t) - The last RSSI value received from responding SU number n. SURSSIn(t-1) - The previous RSSI value received from responding SU number n. N - The number of SUs that responded to both last and previous polling requests. A Tx Power Level Decrease major severity alarm is generated if the decrease in the SU Rx Power Average Delta is higher than the value of the configurable SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold parameter: -(SU Rx Power Average Delta) > SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold. The alarm is generated only if the number of SUs used in calculating the SU Rx Power Average Delta (responded to both of the last two polling messages) is at least 5. NOTE: SUs with SW version below 4.3 will respond to the polling message. However, the last RSSI value will not be included in the response message. Therefore, this test is not applicable to cells where all SUs use SW version below 4.3. The AU also gathers for all responding SUs the RSSI level at which each SU was received by the AU. Based on these measurements, the AU performs a calculation of the AU Rx Power Average Delta, defined as the average difference for all responding SUs between the last RSSI at he AU and the previous (one before last) RSSI: Σn=1-N [AURSSIn(t) - AURSSIn(t-1)]/N, where: AURSSIn(t) - The last RSSI value at which the responding SU number n was received by the AU. AURSSIn(t-1) - The previous RSSI value at which the responding SU number n was received by the AU. An Rx Signal Strength Decrease major severity alarm is generated if the decrease in the AU Rx Power Average Delta is higher than the value of the configurable AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold parameter: -(AU Rx Power Average Delta) > AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold. The alarm is generated only if the number of responding SUs used in calculating the AU Rx Power Average Delta (responded to both of the last two polling messages) is at least 5. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-27 Association Tests If the AU was reset 3 times because no SU became associated with it, a No Associations critical alarm will be generated, provided that previously the AU was associated with at least Minimum Number Of SUs. An All Associations Lost major alarm is generated if no response was received by the AU to the last three polling messages, provided that prior to that, the average number of responding SUs was not lower than the Minimum Number Of SUs. AU Alarms Summary A prerequisite for all alarms except the No Associations alarm, is that the elapsed time since last power-up (or since the AU Alarms Option was enabled) is not lower than the Learning Period. The AU Alarms are summarized below. No Associations Alarm Severity: Critical On Conditions: Three consecutive resets due to no response from any SU, and prior to that the AU was associated with at least Minimum Number Of SUs. Off Conditions: a. At lease one SU became associated with the AU -ORb. All alarms were cleared, -ORc. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: Unlocked synthesizer, very low Tx power or another major HW problem. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-28 All Associations Lost Alarm Severity: Major On Conditions: No response from any SU to the last 3 polling messages, and prior to that the average number of responding SUs was not lower than the Minimum Number Of SUs. Off Conditions: a. At lease one SU became associated with the AU -ORb. All alarms were cleared -ORc. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: Unlocked synthesizer, very low Tx power or another major HW problem. Tx Power Level Decrease Alarm (not applicable if SUs use SW version lower than 4.3) Severity: Major On Conditions: The inverse (minus) of SU Rx Power Average Delta is higher than SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold, and the number of SUs that responded to the last two polling messages is at least 5. Off Conditions: a. All alarms were cleared -ORb. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: A transmitter fault resulting in a significant decline of the Tx power level. Rx Signal Strength Decrease Alarm Severity: Major On Conditions: The inverse (minus) of AU Rx Power Average Delta is higher than AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold, and the number of SUs that responded to the last two polling messages is at least 5. Off Conditions: a. All alarms were cleared, -ORb. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: Manual Revision: 3.0 A receiver fault. Menus and Parameters 2-29 High Retransmissions Rate Alarm Severity: Minor, Major On Conditions: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The Retransmissions Current Rate exceeds the Retransmissions Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the Retransmissions Average Rate by at least Retransmissions Minor Alarm Minimum Delta, -ORb. The Retransmissions Current Rate has dropped below the Retransmissions Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the Retransmissions Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Retransmissions Current Rate is higher than the Retransmissions Major Alarm Threshold. Off Conditions: a. The Retransmissions Current Rate has dropped below the Retransmissions Minor/Major Alarm Threshold, -ORb. All alarms were cleared, -ORc. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: a. Transmitter or receiver fault b. Poor link conditions, strong interference, or an overloaded network. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-30 High Dropped Frames Rate Alarm Severity: Minor, Major On Conditions: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The Dropped Frames Current Rate exceeds the Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the Dropped Frames Average Rate by at least Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta, -ORb. The Dropped Frames Current Rate has dropped below the Dropped Frames Major Alarm Threshold, but is still higher than the Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Dropped Frames Current Rate is higher than the Dropped Frames Major Alarm Threshold. Off Conditions: a. The Dropped Frames Current Rate has dropped below the Dropped Frames Minor/Major Alarm Threshold, -ORb. All alarms were cleared -ORc. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: Manual Revision: 3.0 a. Transmitter or receiver fault Menus and Parameters 2-31 High CRC Error Rate Alarm Severity: Minor, Major On Conditions: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The CRC Error Current Rate exceeds the CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the CRC Error Average Rate by at least CRC Error Minor Alarm Minimum Delta, -ORb. The CRC Error Current Rate has dropped below the CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The CRC Error Current Rate is higher than the CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold. Off Conditions: a. The CRC Error Current Rate has dropped below the CRC Error Minor/Major Alarm Threshold, -ORb. All alarms were cleared, -ORc. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: a. Receiver fault b. Strong interference BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-32 High Duplicate Frames Rate Alarm Severity: Minor, Major On Conditions: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The Duplicate Frames Current Rate exceeds the Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the Duplicate Frames Average Rate by at least Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta, -ORb. The Duplicate Frames Current Rate has dropped below the Duplicate Frames Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Duplicate Frames Current Rate is higher than the Duplicate Frames Major Alarm Threshold. Off Conditions: a. The Duplicate Frames Current Rate has dropped below the Duplicate Frames Minor/Major Alarm Threshold, -ORb. All alarms were cleared, -ORc. AU Alarms Option was disabled Possible Problem: a. Transmitter fault b. Strong interference, preventing the SU from receiving the AU’s ACKs. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-33 The AU Alarms Menu The AU Alarms menu enables to configure relevant parameters and to view current statistics. The AU Alarms menu is available only with Administrator access rights, except for Show All AU Alarms Parameters and Data that is also available with Installer access rights. AU Alarms Option - Enables to enable or disable the AU Alarms feature. The default is Disable. Learning Period - Enables to define the period dedicated to accumulating information without generating alarms (except for the No association alarm). Valid values: 1 to 1440 (minutes) Default: 30 (minutes) Test Cycle - Enables to define the time between two consecutive transmissions of a polling message and for calculating the current averages for the various traffic statistics. Valid values: 1 to 1440 (minutes) Default: 10 (minutes) Traffic Statistics - A sub menu that includes the following options: Retransmissions Rate Parameters Dropped Frames Rate Parameters CRC Error Rate Parameters Duplicate Frames Rate Parameters For each of these traffic statistics types, a sub menu enables to configure three parameters: Minor Alarm Minimum Delta - The minimum difference between the Current Rate and the previous Average Rate, for activating a minor severity alarm, for the relevant statistics type. Another prerequisite for activating the alarm is that the relevant Current Rate exceeds the applicable Minor Alarm Threshold. Valid range: 0 to 100 (%) Minor Alarm Threshold - The threshold for activating a minor severity alarm for the relevant traffic statistics type. Another prerequisite for activating the alarm is that the difference between the applicable Current Rate and the previous Average Rate exceeds the Minor Alarm Minimum Delta. Valid range: 1 to 100 (%) Major Alarm Threshold - The threshold for activating a major severity alarm for the relevant statistics type. Valid range: 1 to 100 (%) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-34 The default parameters for these alarms is as follows: Parameter Default (%) Retransmission Minor Alarm Minimum Delta 20 Retransmission Minor Alarm Threshold 30 Retransmission Major Alarm Threshold 60 Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta 10 Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold 10 Dropped Frames Major Alarm Threshold 20 CRC Error Minor Alarm Minimum Delta 20 CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold 40 CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold 70 Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold Duplicate Frames Major Alarm Threshold 15 NOTE: The value of the Major Alarm Threshold must be higher than the applicable Minor Alarm Threshold. The system will not accept a Major Alarm Threshold that is lower than the current Minor Alarm Threshold, and vice versa. Show Traffic Statistics Parameters and Data - Displays for each statistics type the configured parameters as well as the applicable Current and Average Rates. SU Rx Power Test - A sub menu that includes the following options: SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold - The minimum inverse (negative) value of the SU Rx Power Average Delta that will trigger an alarm. Valid values: 1 to 99 (dBm). Default value: 15 (dBm). Show SU Rx Power Test Parameters and Data - Displays the value of the SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold and the current SU Rx Power Average Delta. AU Rx Power Test - A sub menu that includes the following options: AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold- The minimum inverse (negative) value of the AU Rx Power Average Delta that will trigger an alarm. Valid values: 1 to 99 (dBm). Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-35 Default value: 15 (dBm). Show AU Rx Power Test Parameters and Data - Displays the value of the AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold and the current AU Rx Power Average Delta. Responding SUs - a sub menu that includes the following options: Minimum Average Number Of SUs - Enables to define the minimum average number of SUs required for association tests. Valid values: 1 to 254 (SUs) Default value: 5 (SUs) Show Responding SUs Parameters and Data - Displays the value of the Minimum Average Number Of Responding SUs and the Current and Average Number Of Responding SUs. Alarms Status - a sub menu that includes the following options: Clear All alarms - Enable to clear (set off) all the AU Alarms. Show Turned On Alarms - Displays a list of all the alarms that are turned on and the severity of each of these alarms. Show All AU Alarms Parameters and Data - Displays the values of all AU Alarms parameters as well as all the current results available in Show Traffic Statistics Parameters and Data, in Show SU Rx Power Test Parameters and Data, in Show AU Rx Power Test Parameters and Data and in Show Turned On Alarms. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-36 Advanced Configuration Menu The Advanced Configuration menu provides access to all the parameters, including the parameters that are available through the Basic Configuration menu. The Advanced Configuration menu provides access to the following menus: IP Parameters (AU, SU and GU) (see page 2-36) Air Interface Parameters (AU and SU) (see page 2-37) Network Management Parameters (AU, SU and GU) (see page 2-53) Bridge Parameters (AU and SU) (see page 2-56) VLAN Parameters (GU) (see page 2-56) Performance Parameters (AU and SU) (see page 2-69) Service Parameters (AU and SU) (see page 2-73) RADIUS Parameters (SU) (see page 2-77) Security Parameters (AU and SU) (see page 2-81) Voice Parameters (SU with voice support) (see page 2-83) Dialing Parameters (SU with voice support) (see page 2-84) Telephony Signals Parameters (SU with voice support) (see page 2-91) Hopping Parameters (GU) (see page 2-97) Alarm Parameters (GU) (see page 2-99) IP Parameters (AU, SU and GU) The IP Parameters sub-menu allows configuration of the following parameters: IP Address – Displays the current IP address of the unit and allows Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-37 DHCP Client DHCP Options – Displays the current status of the DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) support, and allows selecting a new operation mode. The available options are: Disable – Use manual procedure for configuring the IP parameters. DHCP Only – Search for a DHCP Server and obtain the IP parameters from it (IP Address, Subnet Mask and Default Gateway Address). Automatic – Search for a DHCP Server for configuration of the IP parameters. If a DHCP Server is not found within approximately 40 seconds, use the currently configured IP parameters. The default is Disable. Access to DHCP – To define the port through which the unit is allowed to communicate with a DHCP server. The options are: From Wlan Only From Ethernet Only From Both Ethernet & WLAN The default for an Access Unit is From Ethernet Only. The default for a Subscriber Unit is From Wlan Only. NOTE: The Access to DHCP option is not available in the GU, as this module does not have a wireless link interface. Show IP Parameters – Displays the current values of the IP Parameters. Air Interface Parameters (AU and SU) Hopping Frequencies Setting Parameters Hopping Sequence –Displays the Hopping Sequence of the unit. A hopping sequence is a pre-defined series of channels (frequencies) that are used in a specific, pseudo-random order as defined in the sequence. The unit “hops” from frequency to frequency according to the selected sequence. When more than one AU is co-located in the same area, it is recommended to assign different hopping sequences to each AU. Hopping Sequences are grouped in three hopping sets (see Hopping Set parameter below). When setting up multiple AUs in the same site, always choose hopping sequences from the same Hopping Set to reduce the possibility of collisions on the wireless media. This BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-38 parameter is only set in the AU. All the SUs learn it from the AU during the association process. The valid values depend on the applicable hopping standard (see Table ý3-2 on page 31). The default value is 1. Hopping Set –Displays the selected hopping set. Each hopping standard has 3 hopping sets. The Hopping Set selected in this screen determines which hopping sequences are available in the Hopping Sequence screen. Always use the same hopping set per site (with different hopping sequences) to minimize the possibility of collisions on the wireless media. This parameter is set only in the AU. All the associated SUs learn its value from the AU during the association process. Valid values are from 1 to 3. The default value is 1. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-39 Table 2-3: Country Standards Supported by BreezeACCESS II Country Standard Frequency Range [MHz] Number of Channels Hopping Sequences per Hopping Set Hopping Sync Support Australia 2402 to 2461 60 20 No Canada 2452 to 2481 30 10 No Europe ETSI 2402 to 2480 79 26 Yes France 2448 to 2482 35 11 Yes Israel 2421 to 2455 35 11 Yes Korea 2430 to 2452 23 Yes Japan 2473 to 2495 23 Yes Netherlands 2454 to 2468 15 Yes Spain 2447 to 2473 27 Yes US FCC 2402 to 2480 79 26 No Mexico 2452 to 2481 30 10 Yes International 2402 to 2480 79 26 Yes Refer to Appendix F for the basic hopping sequence (Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence=1) and the formula for calculating the operational hopping sequences for other Hopping Set/Hopping Sequence combinations for each country standard. Hopping Sync (BS-AU only) –Displays the current Hopping Sync status of the unit and allows defining a new status. When several AUs that use the same hopping set and different hopping sequences are co-located, their operation should be synchronized in terms of hopping sequence initialization and timing. If a BS-GU GPS module is not used for synchronization, then one AU must be specified as a Master unit and all other units must be specified as Slave units. When a BS-GU is used, all AUs must be configured to Slave mode. Available options are: Idle – No synchronization (stand-alone operation) Master – The AU that serves as a Master unit providing synchronization signals to the Slave units Slave – An AU that operates as a Slave The default is Idle. WARNING: When using a GPS system for synchronization, all AUs in the chassis must be set to Slave. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-40 NOTE: Synchronization is not allowed by the radio regulations in certain countries. In units using such standards, the Hopping Sync option is not supported. See Table 2-3‚ page 2-39 for information on synchronization support in the standards of various countries. ESSID Parameters The ESSID is a string used to identify a wireless network. It prevents the unintentional merging of two co-located wireless networks. An SU can only associate with an AU that has an identical ESSID. To facilitate easy additions of SUs to existing deployments, where different ESSIDs are used in neighboring sectors, a secondary “global” ESSID, namely Operator ESSID, is available in the AU. ESSID – The ESSID (Extended Service Set ID) of the unit. Use different ESSIDs to segment the wireless access network and add security to your network. Valid values: A string of up to 31 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. The default value is ESSID1. Operator ESSID Parameters (AU only) – The Operator ESSID is a secondary ESSID that can only be configured in the AU. The Operator ESSID can be used to enhance flexibility and reduce configuration effort when adding new Subscriber Units to operational installations in which different ESSIDs were configured for different sectors that actually belong to the same network. In such installations, all AUs should be configured with the same Operator ESSID. The ESSID as well as the Operator ESSID are included in the AU’s Beacon & Probe Response management frames. The SU shall regard such frames if the ESSID or Operator ESSID matches its own ESSID. The ESSID of the AU with which the SU is associated is defined as the Run-Time ESSID, to be used by the SU when communicating with the AU. The Run-Time ESSID is included in the list displayed upon selecting either Show Air Interface Parameters or Show Basic Parameters options in the SU. In new installations where all units are configured with the same ESSID, Operator ESSID need not be used. The following parameters are available: Operator ESSID Option – Enables/disables the use of the Operator ESSID when communicating with SUs. The default is Enable. Operator ESSID – Defines the Operator ESSID. Valid values: a string of up to 31 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. The default value is ESSID1. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-41 Best AU Selection Parameters In BreezeACCESS systems with software version 3.0 and below an SU can associate with any AU it can communicate with, provided they both use the same ESSID. An SU that can communicate with more than one AU using the same ESSID becomes associated with the first AU it “finds”, not necessarily the best choice in terms of quality of communication or other factors such as number of SUs serviced by each AU. The same limitation also exists if only one AU in the neighborhood has an ESSID identical to the one used by the SU, since it is not always necessarily the best choice. The topology of a fixed access network is constantly changing. Changes in base station deployment and subscriber density can accumulate to create substantial changes in SU performance. The quest for load sharing together with the desire to create best throughput conditions for the SU created the need for the Best AU feature, to enable a SU to connect to the best AU in its neighborhood. When the Best AU feature is used, each of the AUs are given a quality mark based on the level at which it is received by the SU. The SU scans for a configured number of cycles, gathering information from all the AUs it can communicate with. At the end of the scanning period, the SU reaches a Best AU decision according to the information gathered. The AU with the highest quality mark is selected as the Best AU, and the SU will immediately try to associate with it. The quality mark given to each AU depends on the level at which it is received by the SU., as follows: The Best AU selection mechanism can be overridden by defining a specific AU as the preferred AU. NOTE: Although the SU selects the Best AU based on long-term conditions prior to the decision time, it may not always be connected to the instantaneous Best AU at any given time. Note also that the decision is done only once during the scanning interval. The decision may not remain the optimal one for ever. If there are significant changes in deployment of neighboring AUs and the SUs served by them, overall performance may be improved if the applicable SUs are reset intentionally so as to re-initiate the Best AU decision process. Best AU Parameters in SU Best AU Support – Enables or disables the Best AU selection feature. The default is Disable. NOTE: If the Best AU feature is not used, the SU associates with the first AU it finds whose ESSID or Operator ESSID is identical to its own ESSID. Number of Scanning Attempts – Defines the number of scanning cycles to be used for gathering information on BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-42 neighboring AUs. A higher number may result in a better decision at the cost of an increased scanning time during which the SU is not operational. Valid values: 1 - 255. Default value: 20. The scanning time can be calculated based on the following formula: Scanning Time (seconds) = N * C * 0.019 N = Number of scanning attempts C = Number of channels in the hopping sequence 0.019 seconds is the time spent on each channel (dwell time) while in scanning mode. NOTE: When Best AU support is enabled, it is recommended to use Active Scanning. If passive scanning is used, the SU may not hear the best AU (or the preferred AU). The higher the number of hopping channels, the higher the probability that the SU will not hear the best (or preferred) AU when passive scanning is used. Preferred AU MAC Address – Defines a specific AU with which the SU should associate. Gaining control of the SUs association is a powerful tool in network management. The Preferred AU MAC Address parameter is intended for applications where there is a need to dictate the preferred AU with whom the SU should associate. To prevent the SU from associating with the first viable AU it finds, the Best AU Support mechanism should be enabled. Once the SU has identified the preferred AU based on its MAC address, it will associate with it and terminate the scanning process. If the preferred AU is not found, the SU will associate with an AU according to the decision reached using the best AU algorithm. Valid values: MAC address string The default value for the Preferred AU MAC Address is 00-00-00-00-00-00 (12 zeros), meaning that there is no preferred AU. Show Best AU Parameters and Data – Displays the applicable information: Neighboring AU Data table - Displayed for each AU that the unit can communicate with the following parameters: MAC Address Received signal strength – RSSI or dBm Mark – The computed quality mark for the AU. Full – The association load status of the AU. It is defined as full if the number of SUs associated with the AU has reached the maximum allowed according to the value of the Maximum Number of Associations parameter (see Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-43 page 2-48). An AU whose associations load status is full cannot be selected as the Best AU, even if its’ computed mark is the highest. ESSID – The ESSID of the AU In addition to the neighboring AU data table, the following information is displayed: Best AU Support Preferred AU MAC Address Number of Scanning Attempts Associated AU MAC Address (the MAC address of the selected AU) Run Time ESSID (the ESSID of the selected AU). Power Control Parameters The power control parameters enable to optimize the performance of the system through controlling the transmitted power level of BreezeACCESS units. The transmitted power level of the unit should be decreased from the maximum level that is supported by the unit in the following cases: In a Subscriber Unit that is relatively close to the Access Unit, in order to minimize the interference to signals received by the AU from other subscriber units as well as interference to neighboring cells. In an Access Unit typically the maximum supported transmit power is used to enable maximum coverage. However, there may be a need to decrease the transmitted power level in order to support relatively small cells and to minimize the interference with the operation of neighboring cells. If required for compliance with local regulations or other restrictions related to maximum allowable transmitted power. In addition to the ability to set the transmit power to a certain fixed level, IF-Based units (SU-A/E, AU-BS and AU-NI) support an Automatic Transmit Power Control (ATPC) algorithm. The ATPC algorithm automatically adjusts the power level transmitted by each SU according to the actual level at which it is received by the AU. To support proper operation of the system with optimal performance and minimum interference between neighboring sectors, the ATPC algorithm should be enabled in all units. The algorithm is controlled by the AU that calculates for each received frame the average RSSI at which it receives transmissions from the specific SU. The average calculation takes into account the previous calculated average, thus reducing the effect of short temporary changes in link conditions. The weight of history (the previous value) in the formula used for calculating the average RSSI is determined by a configurable parameter. In addition, the higher the time that has passed since last calculation, the lower is the impact of history on the calculated average. If the average RSSI is not in the optimal range (typically between -74dBm to -64dBm), the AU transmits to the SU a power-up or a power-down message. The target is that each SU will be BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-44 received at an optimal level, or as high as possible if the optimal range cannot be reached because of specific link conditions. Each time that the SU tries to associate with the AU (following either a reset or loss of synchronization), it will initiate transmissions using the Current Transmit Power Control, which is the last value that was previously used by the ATPC mechanism. If after a certain configurable time the SU did not succeed to synchronize with the AU, it will start transmitting using the level configured for the Transmit Power Control parameter. (If this is the first time that the SU is powered up, or if the ATPC algorithm was not used, the Current Transmit Power Control equals the value of Transmit Power Control). Transmit Power Control (IF-based units only – SU-A/E, AU-BS and AU-NI) – Controls the relative gain of the Tx power circuits. A value of 15 represents the highest transmit power level, which is the maximum level supported by the specific unit. A lower value represents a lower transmit power level. The effect of this parameter on the transmitted power is not linear, since it is affected by the length (attenuation) of the IF cable. In SUs, if the ATPC Option is enabled this parameter serves for setting the initial value to be used by the ATPC algorithm after the first time of powering-up the unit. It will also be used in the following cases: a. If the unit does not succeed to associate with the AU after reset b. If the unit does not succeed to re-synchronize with the AU after losing synchronization c. If the SU is associated with the AU but there are too many successive dropped frames, indicating that it transmits at a level that may be too low. The actual run-time value that is used to control the transmit power level is determined by the ATPC process. The allowed range is from 0 to 15. The default value is 15 (maximum power) The following tables displays the transmitted power output as a function of the value of the Transmit Power Control parameter and the attenuation of the IF cable. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-45 Table 2-4 -.: Transmit Power Output Cable attenuation 0dB 5dB 10dB 15dB Transmit power Control Outdoor power (dBm) Outdoor power (dBm) Outdoor power (dBm) Outdoor power (dBm) 15 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 14 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 13 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 24+/- 2 12 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 11 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 10 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 22+/- 3 22+/- 3 23+/- 3 23+/- 3 22+/- 4 21+/- 4 22+/- 4 23+/- 3 21+/- 4 20+/- 4 22+/- 4 22+/- 4 20+/- 4 17+/- 4 22+/- 4 21+/- 4 19+/- 4 15+/- 4 21+/- 4 20+/- 4 18+/- 4 12+/- 4 21+/- 4 19+/- 4 16+/- 4 10+/- 4 20+/- 5 18+/- 5 14+/- 5 8+/- 5 19+/- 5 17+/- 5 13+/- 5 7+/- 5 18+/- 5 16+/- 5 11+/- 5 6+/- 5 Power Level - Applicable to all SU-R units and to SU-I/AU-I units. Sets the transmit level according to the unit’s specifications. In SU-R units there are two options: High – An output power level to the antenna port of 28 dBm Low – An output power level to the antenna port of 17 dBm In SU-I/I-D and AU-I/I-D there are two options: High– An output power level to the antenna port of 17 dBm Low – An output power level to the antenna port of 10 dBm The default is High. NOTE: To comply with specific regulatory requirements, certain units may be supplied with the Power Level parameter set to Low, without the option to change it to High. In such units the Power Level parameter is not available. ATPC Parameters in IF Based AU ATPC Option: To enable or disable the Automatic Transmit Power Control (ATPC) algorithm. The default is Disable. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-46 Minimum RSSI Level: Enables you to define the lowest level at which you want each SU to be received at the AU (the lower limit of the optimal reception level range). Available values: -100 to 0dBm. Default value: -74 dBm Maximum RSSI Level: Enables you to define the highest level at which you want each SU to be received at the AU (the higher limit of the optimal reception level range). Available values: -100 to 0 dBm. Default value: -64 dBm NOTE: The value of the Maximum RRSI Level must be higher than the value of the Minimum RRSI Level. The system will not accept a Maximum RRSI Level value that is lower than the current Minimum RRSI Level value, and vice versa. RSSI Memory Factor: Enable you to define the parameter that determines the weight of history (value of last calculated average RSSI) in the formula used for calculating the average RSSI. The higher the value of this parameter, the higher is the weight of history in the formula. Available values: -1 to 32. -1 is for no weight for history, meaning that average RSSI equals the last measured RSSI. Default value: 5 Minimum Interval Between ATPC Messages: To set the minimal time between consecutive power-up/power-down messages to a specific SU. Setting a low value for this parameter may lead to a higher overhead and an excessive rate of power level changes at the SUs. High values for this parameter increase the time it will take until the SUs reach optimal transmit power level. Available values: 0 to 3600 seconds. Default value: 120 seconds. ATPC Power Level Step - The step size in percentages of maximum number of available levels that the SU will use when receiving an ATPC Power-Up/Power-Down message. The formula for calculating the step size is: Step=max{1, [ATPC Step*(No. of Levels-1)/100]} (rounded down). In SU-A/E the number of available levels is 16. Therefore, if ATPC Power Level Step is 14, than Step=2 [ATPC Step*(No. of Levels-1)/100= 14*15/100=2.1], meaning that the SU will increase/decrease the value of the Transmit Power Control parameter by 2. Any value lower than 14 will result in Step=1. Available values: 1-100 (%) Default value: 1 Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-47 ATPC Parameters in IF Based SU ATPC Option: To enable or disable the Automatic Transmit Power Control (ATPC) algorithm. The parameter takes effect immediately. However, when changed from Enable to Disable, the transmit power level shall remain at the last level determined by the ATPC algorithm before it was disabled. It will change to the value configured for the Transmit Power Control parameter only after the next reset. The default is Enable. ATPC Maximum Last Level Time After Reset: The maximum time (in seconds) of attempting to associate with an AU after reset, using the last value of the Current Transmit Power Control. If this time had elapsed without succeeding to associate with the AU, the unit will use the configured value of the Transmit Power Control parameter . Available values: 0-3600 (seconds) Default value: 30 (seconds) ATPC Maximum Last Level Time After Synchronization Loss: The maximum time (in seconds) of attempting to associate with an AU after losing synchronization, using the last value of the Current Transmit Power Control. If this time had elapsed without succeeding to associate with the AU, the unit will use the configured value of the Transmit Power Control parameter. Available values: 0-3600 (seconds) Default value: 120 (seconds) Other Air Interface Parameters Maximum Data Rate – Displays the current maximum data rate, and allows entry of a new value for the maximum data rate. BreezeACCESS units operate at data rates of 3 Mbps, 2 Mbps, and 1 Mbps. Under certain conditions (compatibility reasons or range/speed trade-off), you may decide to limit the use of higher rates. If the quality of the link is not good enough, it is recommended to decrease the value of this parameter (the higher the data rate, the higher the error rate). Otherwise, there is a high probability that the unit will have to retransmit many frames several times before temporarily reducing the data rate (see Number of Retransmissions to Decrease Rate on page 2-69). A high number of retransmissions reduces the overall throughput for the selected SU as well as for all the other SUs served by the same AU. It is recommended to also configure the Maximum Data Rate parameter when the Multi-Rate mechanism is enabled, to avoid unnecessary trials to transmit at higher rates when the probability of successful transmissions at these rates is low. In the SU, the link quality can be estimated based on the RSSI measurement, using the assumption that the link is more or less BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-48 symmetrical and that this value is a good indication to the level at which the SU is received by the AU. If the measured RSSI is less than a certain threshold, it is recommended to decrease the Maximum Data Rate of the SU in accordance with Table 2-5 (including a 3 dB safety margin). For best results it is recommended to acquire the RSSI results from the AU, indicating the level at which the AU receives transmissions from the specific SU (uplink RSSI), and to use this value for reaching a decision on the recommended Maximum Data Rate. Allowed values are 1, 2, 3 Mbps. The default value is 3 Mbps. Table 2-5: Recommended Maximum Data Rate Maximum Data Rate 3Mbps 2Mbps 1Mbps BreezeACCESS 5.7 GHz RSSI>-70 dBm -78 dBm -73 dBm -81 dBm -64dBm -71dBm -65dBm -74dBm Reverse Battery – Change the polarity from forward to reverse Reverse -> Forward Battery – Change the polarity from reverse to forward The default is Forward Battery. Caller ID: Defines whether the unit will support generation of Caller ID (CID) signaling and if CID generation is supported, which standard will be used. The unit supports two CID signaling standards: Voice band Frequency Shift Keying (FSK) signaling in accordance with ETSI ETS 300 659 – 1 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-90 1200-baud tone modulation in accordance with Bellcore 202 standard. The Caller ID parameter is supported only by units using a Voice card HW revision D and higher. The following options are available: Disable ETSI DT-AS: CID signaling in accordance with ETSI ETS 300 659 -1, using Dual Tone Alerting Signal to indicated to the called terminal that CID data transmission is to be expected. ETSI RP-AS: CID signaling in accordance with ETSI ETS 300 659 -1, using Ringing Pulse Alerting Signal to indicate to the called terminal that CID data transmission is to be expected. ETSI – During Ringing: CID signaling in accordance with ETSI ETS 300 659 -1, transmitting CID data during the first long silence between two ring patterns. Bellcore MDMF: CID signaling in accordance with Bellcore 202, using Multiple Data Message Format (MDMF), which includes a name field in addition to the date, time and number. Bellcore SDMF: CID signaling in accordance with Bellcore 202, using Single Data Message Format (SDMF), which includes the date, time and number. The default selection is Disable. Stop Dialing Timeout: The inactivity time following the last dialed digit that will be identified by the unit as an indication to end of dialing. Valid range: 3 to 60 seconds Default value: 5 seconds Stop Dialing Indicator: Uses the # sign to indicate end of dialing, thus to speed the dialing process. The options are: Disable: The # sign is interpreted as a part of the dialed sequence. End of dialing is determined by the Stop Dialing Timeout parameter. Enable: The # sign is interpreted as indicating end of dialing sequence. The default is Disable. Overlap Sending - To enable or disable the overlap sending feature. A gatekeeper or a gateway supporting overlap sending does not require dialing termination signaling for setting up a call. Otherwise a dialing termination signal must be supplied by the unit. When Overlap Sending is enabled, each dialed digit is transmitted immediately. When disabled, dialed digits are accumulated and transmitted according to the rules set by other dialing parameters. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-91 Upon enabling overlap sending, the settings of other dialing parameters are overridden as follows: a. IP Dialing Option, Dialing Prefix Option and Stop Dialing Indicator are disabled even if the applicable parameter is set to Enable. b. Automatic Prefix is not used and Stop Dialing Timeout has no effect. The default selection is Disable. Telephony Signals (Subscriber Units with Voice Support Only) The Telephony Signals menu defines the various call progress tones that indicate the status of a telephone call, the ringer parameters and some timeouts. The call progress tones are generated by the Subscriber Unit in accordance with call progress information as received from the AU or the telephony network. The parameters in the Telephony Signals menu include the following options: Telephony Country Standard – Selects the call progress tones standard. The following options are available: Proprietary – Allows definition of specific tones (see below). Germany Sweden France United Kingdom Belgium USA Chile The default selection is USA. Dial Tone –Defines the dial tone transmitted to the earphone to indicate that the call can be supported by the system and that the caller may start dialing. Ring-Back Tone – Defines the tone transmitted to the earphone to indicate that the telephone of the called party is ringing. Busy Tone – Defines the tone transmitted to the earphone to indicate that the telephone of the called party is busy. Congestion Tone - Defines the tone transmitted to the earphone to indicate that the system cannot currently support the call (e.g. if a line is not available since the AU currently supports the maximum allowed number of voice sessions). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-92 Error Tone – Defines the tone transmitted to the earphone to indicate that the system cannot currently support the call (e.g. if for any reason the call was disconnected because of a problem in the wireless link or incompatible capabilities) or if the user did not hang up after exceeding the specified duration of the Dial, Ring Back, Busy or Congestion Tones. High Level Error Tone – Defines the high level tone transmitted to the earphone to better attract the attention of the user if he did not hang up after exceeding the specified duration of the Error Tone. The various tones are defined by specifying the following parameters: Frequency 1 – One of two frequencies that can be used for generating the applicable tone. Valid values are 0-3000 (in Hz). Frequency 2 – The second of the two frequencies to be used for generating the applicable tone. Valid values are 0-3000 (in Hz). Level 1 – The level (in dBm) of Frequency 1. Valid values are –32 to +3. Level 2 – The level (in dBm) of Frequency 2. Valid values are –32 to +3. Cadence On – The ringing time (on) in the tones-silence sequence of the tone. Valid values are 100 – 10,000 milliseconds, 0 (0 means that the tone is not used). Cadence Off – The silence time (off) in the tones-silence sequence of the tone. Valid values are 100 – 10,000 milliseconds, 0 (0 means no silence – a continuous tone). Duration – The maximum duration of transmitting the tone to the earphone. Tone generation will cease upon hang-up. Valid values are 0 – 10,000 seconds. Ring Frequency - Defines the ring frequency parameters (that define the ringing of the telephone set), if the selected Telephony Country parameter is Proprietary. The following parameters can be defined: Ringer Frequency – the frequency of activating the Ringer. Valid values are: 17Hz, 20Hz, 25Hz, 50Hz. Cadence On – The ringing time (on) in the ringing-silence sequence of the Ringer. Valid values are 100 – 10,000 milliseconds. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-93 Cadence Off – The silence time (on) in the ringing-silence sequence of the Ringer. Valid values are 100 – 10,000 milliseconds. Duration - The maximum duration of activating the ringer. Ringing will cease upon detecting off-hook condition. Valid values are 0 – 10,000 seconds. Timeouts – Defines the following timeouts: Min. Flash Detect Timeout and Max. Flash Detect Timeout – A short on-hook time that is between the values of these two parameters will be considered as Hook Flash. Valid values: 0 – 2,000 milliseconds Disconnect Timeout – The minimum time for decision on an on-hook condition. Valid values: 0 – 2,000 milliseconds Inter-Digit Timeout – Applicable only for pulse dialing. The minimum time between two consecutive pulses to be considered as separating between two digits. Valid values: 0 – 2,000 milliseconds Called Party Release Timeout – The minimum time for an on-hook signal on the called party side to be considered as call disconnect. Valid values: 0 – 10,000 seconds The following tables provide details concerning the values of the parameters of the various call progress tones and the ringer as well as the Timeouts for the available country standards. Table 2-14: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer - Germany Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence On (ms) Duration (s) Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Off (ms) Dial Tone 450 -18 Ring Back 450 -18 1000 4000 60 Busy 450 -18 500 500 15 Congestion 450 -18 250 250 Error 450 -18 200 200 High Level Error Ring Frequency 25 1000 5000 60 15 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-94 Table 2-15: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer - USA Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence On (ms) Duration (s) Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Off (ms) Dial Tone 350 -13 440 -13 Ring Back 440 -19 480 -19 1000 3000 60 Busy 480 -24 620 -24 500 500 15 Congestion 480 -24 620 -24 1000 1000 Error 480 -24 620 -24 200 200 High Level Error Ring Frequency 20 1000 3000 60 15 Table 2-16: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer - Sweden Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence On (ms) Duration (s) Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Off (ms) Dial Tone 425 -18 Ring Back 425 -18 1000 5000 60 Busy 425 -18 250 250 15 Congestion 425 -18 250 750 Error 425 -18 200 200 High Level Error Ring Frequency 25 1000 5000 60 15 Table 2-17: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer - France Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Dial Tone 425 -18 Ring Back 425 -18 1500 3500 60 Busy 425 -18 500 500 15 Congestion 425 -18 500 500 Error 425 -18 200 200 High Level Error Ring Frequency 25 1500 3500 60 Manual Revision: 3.0 On (ms) Duration (s) Off (ms) 15 Menus and Parameters 2-95 Table 2-18: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer – United Kingdom Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence On (ms) Duration (s) Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Off (ms) Dial Tone 350 -18 440 -18 Ring Back 400 -18 450 -18 400 200 60 Busy 400 -18 375 375 15 Congestion 400 -18 400 350 Error 400 -18 200 200 High Level Error Ring Frequency 25 400 200 60 15 Table 2-19: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer - Belgium Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence On (ms) Duration (s) Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Off (ms) Dial Tone 425 -12 Ring Back 425 -18 1000 3000 60 Busy 425 -18 500 500 15 Congestion 425 -18 167 167 Error 425 -18 200 200 High Level Error Ring Frequency 25 1000 3000 60 15 Table 2-20: Parameters of Call Progress Tones and Ringer – Chile Frequency 1 Frequency 2 Cadence On (ms) Duration (s) Tone Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Freq (Hz) Level (dB) Off (ms) Dial Tone 400 -6 Ring Back 400 -6 1000 3000 120 Busy 400 -6 500 500 20 Congestion 400 -6 200 200 20 Error 400 -6 500 500 20 High Level Error 400 500 500 20 Ringer 20 1000 3000 120 20 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-96 Table 2-21: Timeouts Min. Flash Detect (ms) Max Flash Detect (ms) Disconnect (ms) Inter-digit (ms) Called Party Release (s) Germany 120 1000 1000 100 USA 120 1000 1000 100 Sweden 120 1000 1000 100 France 120 1000 1000 100 United Kingdom 120 1000 1000 100 Belgium 120 1000 1000 100 Chile 220 320 320 500 60 Country Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-97 Hopping Parameters (GU) The Hopping Parameters Menu allows configuration of the hopping mechanism. The GPS modules deliver signals to the Access Units that insure that their hopping patterns are fully synchronized. This includes synchronizing the time each unit starts a new hop and ensuring that units start the hopping sequence simultaneously. Number of Hopping Frequencies – Configures the Number of Hopping Frequencies parameter to guarantee that all the Access Units managed by the GPS module will start their hopping sequence simultaneously. To determine the correct number of hopping frequencies, access the monitor program in one of the AU units, select Show Basic Configuration in the Info Screens menu and view the Number of Hopping Frequencies value displayed. You can also determine the Number of Hopping Frequencies using Table ý3-18: Table 2-22: Number of Hopping Frequencies Number of Hopping Frequencies (hopping sequence length) Hopping Standard Australia 60 Canada 30 Europe ETSI 79 France 35 Israel 35 Korea 23 Japan 23 Netherlands 15 Spain 27 US FCC 79 Mexico 30 Rest of America 79 Dwell Time – Applicable only when the ACSE Option is disabled. When the ACSE Option is enabled this parameter is not applicable and the dwell time is the ACSE Dwell Time, set to a fixed value of 60 milliseconds (see page 2-72). ACSE Option – see page 2-51 NOTE: The values of the ACSE Option and Dwell Time (if the ACSE Option is disabled) parameters must be the same for all GPS modules and Access Units in the system to enable synchronized hopping. GPS Antenna Recovery - Under normal operating conditions, the BS-GU module uses the time signals it receives from the GPS BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-98 antenna to generate the synchronization signals for the AUs. When two or more BS-GU modules are daisy-chained, the signals from the GPS antenna are transferred to all "slave" BS-GU modules via the SYNC OUT - SYNC IN cable, and all BS-GUs use these signals to generate synchronization signals for their AUs. The BS-GU can detect whether a daisy-chaining cable is connected to its' SYNC IN port; If a daisy-chaining cable is connected to the SYNC IN port, the unit is a "slave" unit. If a daisy-chaining cable is not connected to the SYNC IN port, the unit will behave like a "master". The BS-GU continuously checks whether it receives proper PPS (Pulse Per Second) signals from the GPS antenna. Proper PPS signals are exactly one second apart. When a BS-GU detects that it does not receive proper timing signals from the GPS antenna, it will behave as follows: a. If the BS-GU is a "master", it will start generating synchronization signals using its internal clock. The synchronization signals will also be transferred to the SYNC OUT port. b. If a BS-GU is a "slave", it will use the synchronization signals it receives from the "master" via the SYNC IN port. It will also transfer these signals to its SYNC OUT port for use by the next slave module if applicable. A slave module continuously monitors the lines from the GPS antenna in its SYNC IN port. If it determines that proper PPS signals are received (at least three consecutive PPS signals one second apart), it will automatically revert to the regular operating mode, using the PPS signals for generating its synchronization signals. A master BS-GU must enter a special antenna recovery mode to check the validity of the signals it receives from the GPS antenna. NOTE: During Antenna Recovery mode the master BS-GU module stops generating synchronization signals for several seconds. Therefore, the rate of entering this mode should be minimal. The antenna recovery mode can be activated either manually or automatically, using the GPS Antenna Recovery menu: Manual Recovery Mode - Enables to initiate a single antenna recovery process during which the unit checks the signals it receives from the GPS antenna. The manual recovery mode is completely independent of the automatic recovery mode, meaning that a manual recovery process can be initiated by the user regardless of the selected option in Automatic Recovery Option. Typically, manual recovery will be initiated after connecting/re-connecting or fixing a problem in the GPS antenna. Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-99 Automatic Recovery Mode - Enables to control an automatic recovery process: Automatic Recovery Option - To enable or disable automatic initiation of antenna recovery process. If a GPS antenna is not used, the Automatic Recovery Option should be disabled. The default selection is Enable. Automatic Recovery Interval - To define the time interval between two consecutive initiations of automatic antenna recovery processes. Valid values: 5 to 1440 (minutes) Default value: 15 (minutes) NOTE: The GPS Antenna Recovery menu is applicable only to a "master" BS-GU module. Alarm Parameters (GU) The GU module serves also as the alarms control unit for the BreezeACCESS system and auxiliary equipment. It has dry contact connections to 4 external alarm inputs (Alarm In 1 through Alarm In 4), that turn on upon contact closure. It also receives alarm indications from BreezeACCESS power supply module (Alarm In 7 through Alarm In 10), that turn on to indicate a power failure or over temperature problem in any of the two optional power supplies. PS1 alarms refer to a power supply module inserted in the left-most slot of the chassis. PS2 alarms refer to a power supply module inserted in the right-most slot of the chassis. Alarm In 5 (GPS Antenna Status) is generated internally in the GU module, and it is turned on to indicate that proper PPS (pulse per second) timing signals are received from the GPS antenna. NOTES: Over Temperature alarm indication is only supported by the AC power supply module. In installations with a single power supply module, the GU module doesn’t function (and therefore will not provide an alarm indication) upon total failure of the power supply or upon failure of the 5 V module. The GU module can also control 3 Alarm Out relay, where each relay has a common contact, a normally open (NO) contact and a normally closed (NC) contact. The Alarm Parameters menu allows access to the following sub-menus: Alarms In Names. Alarms Out Names. Automatic Alarms Out Definition. Alarms Out Control. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-100 Show Alarm Parameters. Alarms In Names The Alarms In Names menu allows names for each of the four external alarm indications that can be connected to the AL IN connector to be defined. These names can reflect the specific environment in which the module is being used (e.g. “Smoke Detector 1” or “Main Door”). Each Alarms In Name can contain up to 31 printable ASCII characters (case sensitive). The default names are Alarm In 1 through Alarm In 4. Alarms Out Names The Alarms Out Names menu allows names for each of the three external devices that can be connected to the AL OUT connector to be defined. These names can reflect the specific environment in which the module is being used (e.g. “Alarm Light 1”). Each Alarms Out Name can contain up to 31 printable ASCII characters (case sensitive). The default names are Alarm Out 1 through Alarm Out 3. Automatic Alarms Out Definition The Automatic Alarms Out Definition menu allows you to define the conditions under which each of the 3 Alarms Outs is to be activated (when operating in Automatic mode). The available options for each of the three Alarms Out are: 1 – Activate if Alarm In 1 turns ON. 2 – Activate if Alarm In 2 turns ON. 3 – Activate if Alarm In 3 turns ON. 4 – Activate if Alarm In 4 turns ON. 5 - Activate if Alarm In 5 (GPS Antenna Status) turns ON 6 - Not Applicable (Alarm In 6 is not defined) 7 - Activate if Alarm In 7 (PS1Over Temperature) turns ON 8 - Activate if Alarm In 8 (PS2 Over Temperature) turns ON 9 - Activate if Alarm In 9 (PS1 Power) turns ON 10 - Activate if Alarm In 10 (PS2 Power) turns ON N – None (never activate this Alarm Out). A - Activate if ANY of the Alarms In turns ON. The default for all three Alarms Out is 0 (None – never activate the alarm). Manual Revision: 3.0 Menus and Parameters 2-101 Alarms Out Control The Alarms Out Control menu allows the functionality of the Alarms Out control mechanism to be defined. Its main purpose is to support “manual” activation/deactivation of each of the Alarms Out either locally or remotely using Telnet or SNMP. For each of the three Alarms Out, the following control options are available: 0 – Turn Alarm OFF (even if it should be ON according to the definition in the Automatic Alarms Out Definition Menu). 1 – Turn Alarm ON (even if it should be OFF according to the definition in the Automatic Alarms Out Definition Menu). 2 – Automatic (activate/deactivate according to the definition in the Automatic Alarms Out Definition Menu). The default for all three Alarms Out is 2 (Automatic). Show Alarm Parameters Shows the current values of the Alarms In and Alarms Out parameters as well as their current status: Alarms In Names And Status Displays the names and current status (ON or OFF) for all Alarm In indications, including “internal” alarms, as follows: Alarm In 1 through Alarm In 4: Name according to the name defined in the Alarms In Names Menu. Alarm In 5: GPS Antenna Status. Alarm In 6: NA (reserved for future use). Alarm In 7: PS1 Over Temperature (over temperature indication for BS-PS Power Supply module 1, which is the module inserted in the left-most slot of the chassis). Alarm In 8: PS2 Over Temperature (over temperature indication for BS-PS Power Supply module 2, which is the module inserted in the right-most slot of the chassis). Alarm In 9: PS1 Power (power fail indication for BS-PS Power Supply module 1, which is the module inserted in the left-most slot of the chassis). Alarm In 10: PS2 Power (power fail indication for BS-PS Power Supply module 2, which is the module inserted in the right-most slot of the chassis). NOTE: In some installations only one Power Supply module (either PS1 or PS2) may be used. Alarms Out Names, Definitions, Control and Status Displays the following information for each of the three Alarms Out: BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Operations and Administration 2-102 Name: Name according to the name defined in the Alarms In Names Menu. Definition: NONE, Alarm In # or ANY, according to the configuration in the Automatic Alarms Out Definition Menu. Control: OFF, ON or AUTO, according to the configuration in the Alarms Out Control Menu. Status: ON or OFF. Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS II Version 4.3 Revision 3.0 System Manual: Appendices Appendix A: Configuration Download/Upload This appendix describes the method of configuring a large number of BreezeACCESS units at once. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual A-2 The Configuration Download/Upload feature in BreezeACCESS units simplifies the task of remotely configuring a large number of units using TFTP protocol. By downloading the configuration file to a PC it is possible to view all the parameters configured at the unit, as it is a plain text ASCII file. It is necessary to edit the file by a using simple editor and to remove certain parameters or change their values prior to uploading the configuration to another unit. When multiple configuration is performed (uploading the file to several units) it is recommended that only the relevant parameters be included in the file . Each parameter is represented in the file by three fields: A symbolic string similar to the name of the parameter in the monitor program, followed by “=”. The value of the parameters (using the same values that are used in the monitor program). A comment (optional). If used, it should start with a “;” character. The unit will ignore an unknown parameter. In the case of a known parameter with an out of range value, the default value will be used. Use the SNMP write community string (the default is “private”) to define both the uploaded file (put) and the downloaded file (get): SnmpWriteCommunity.cfg The file should be transferred in ASCII mode. Example: To upload the configuration file using DOS based TFTP Client to an SU whose IP address is 206.25.63.65: tftp 206.25.63.65 put Suconf private.cfg To download the configuration file from the same unit: tftp 206.25.63.65 get private.cfg Suconf Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix B: Software Version Loading Procedure General Firmware upgrades to the unit's FLASH memory are performed by a simple loading procedure using a TFTP application. Before performing an upgrade procedure, be sure you have the correct files and latest instructions. NOTE: Shutting down power to the unit before completion of the loading procedure may cause the unit to be inoperable. Verify that you have IP connectivity to the unit to be loaded with a new version. Verify that the IP address of the PC from which you intend to perform the upgrade belongs to the same subnet as the unit to be upgraded (unless the unit is behind a router). If the unit is behind a router, verify that the unit is configured with the correct Default Gateway Address. To view the current IP parameters of the unit, use the monitor program by connecting the PC to the unit either directly or via Telnet and use the following procedure: 1. From the Main Menu select 1 – Info Screens. The Info Screens menu opens. 2. From the Info Screen menu select 2 – Show Basic Configuration. A display of the current configuration of the basic parameters appears, including the IP Address, Subnet Mask and Default Gateway Address parameters. To configure any of the IP parameters, use the following procedure: 1. From the Main Menu select 3 – Basic Configuration. The Basic Configuration menu opens. 2. To configure the IP Address, select: 1 – IP Address. 3. To configure the Subnet Mask, select 2 – Subnet Mask. 4. To configure the Default Gateway Address select 3 – Default Gateway Address. 5. Reset the unit in order for the new configuration to apply. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual B-2 6. To verify the connection, ping the unit’s IP address. Verify that ping replies are being received. The procedure to be used depends on the unit’s FLASH memory type. Identify the FLASH memory type by using the monitor program, connecting the PC to the unit either directly or via Telnet. From the Main Menu, select 1 – Info Screens. From the Info Screen menu select 1 – Show Unit Status. The last line of the Unit Status display will indicate the FLASH type (type F or type S). Use the TFTP utility, with the following syntax, to perform the upgrade: tftp –i hostaddress put sourcefile [destinationfile] Where -i is for binary mode, hostaddress is the IP address of the unit to be upgraded, put defines that the PC (client) will send a file to the hostaddress and destinationfile is the name of the file to be loaded. Loading an Upgrade to a Unit with FLASH Type: F Use the following table to determine which source file name to use, according to the unit’s type. Unit Type Source File Name AU AXF.BS SU AXF.SU SU with Voice AXF.SUV GU AXF.GU X, refers to the software version number, up to 5 decimal digits (e.g. for software release 4.0.40, X=4040). Use the SNMP write community .dwn (the default write community is private) to define the destination filename. For example, to load the upgrade file A3011F.BS to an AU whose IP address is 206.25.63.65 use the following syntax: tftp –i 206.25.63.65 put A3011F.BS private.dwn Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix B B-3 NOTE: If you are upgrading a Subscriber Unit which is not associated with an AU, the unit will reset every five minutes (approximately) and the following message will be displayed: FTL: file src\wpscan.c line 262 Too large number of scanning attempts The unit will reset and it will take more than a minute before you can re-establish the connection to it. You should either have the SU associated with an AU before starting the loading process or complete the loading process before the unit resets. Otherwise you will have to try again until you complete the loading process. When version loading is completed the following message is displayed: Loading operation has been completed successfully The FLASH memory can store two software versions. One version is called Current and the second version is called Shadow. The new version is loaded into the Shadow (backup) FLASH memory. To check that the new firmware was loaded properly, view the firmware versions stored in the FLASH using the following procedure: 1. From the Main Menu, select 2 – Unit Control. The Unit Control menu opens. 2. From the Unit Control menu, select 5 – Flash Memory Control. The Flash Memory Control menu opens. 3. From the Flash Memory Control menu, select S – Show Flash Versions. The display appears as follows: Flash Versions =========== Current Version: 3.0.39 Shadow Version: 4.0.40 Version After Reset:3.0.39 From the Flash Memory Control menu select the active software version, using the following procedures: To activate the backup (shadow) version: 1. From the Flash Memory Control menu select 1 - Reset and Boot from Shadow Version. The Reset and Boot from Shadow Version menu opens. 2. Select 1 – Reset Now and press ENTER. 3. The unit resets and the Shadow version is used as the newactive version. Note that after the next reset, the Current version will be activated again. If the active version is the Shadow version and you wish to continue using it after the next Reset, use the following procedure: BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual B-4 1. From the Flash Memory Control menu select 2 - Use Current Version After Reset. The Use Current Version After Reset menu opens. 2. Select 1 – Set As Default Now and press ENTER. This will actually cause the names of the two versions to switch. The previous Shadow version will now be called Current and vise versa. The following message will be displayed: UP (DOWN) Image FLASH will be operational (UP or DOWN refers to the location in the flash memory). The loading procedure is protected. An attempt to load an invalid version (e.g. using .fmr when trying to load a new version to units with a FLASH Type: F) will be rejected. Loading an Upgrade to a Unit with FLASH Type: S Use the following table to determine which source file name to use, according to the unit’s type. Unit Type File Name AU AXS.BS SU AXS.SU SU with Voice AXS.SUV GU AXS.GU X refers to the software version number, up to 5 decimal digits (e.g. for software release 4.0.40, X=4040). Use the SNMP write community .fmr (default write community is private) to define the destination filename. For example: to load the upgrade file A3011S.SU to an SU whose IP address is 206.25.63.55 use the following syntax: >tftp –i 206.25.63.55 put A3011S.SU private.fmr Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix B B-5 NOTE: If you are upgrading a Subscriber Unit which is not associated with an AU, the unit will reset every five minute (approximately) and the following message will be displayed: FTL: file src\wpscan.c line 262 Too large number of scanning attempts The unit will reset and it will take more than a minute before you can re-establish the connection to it. You should either have the SU associated with an AU before starting the loading process or complete the loading process before the unit resets. Otherwise you will have to try again until you complete the loading process. When loading is completed the following message is displayed: Loading operation has been completed successfully. The FLASH memory can store two software versions. One version is called Current and the second version is called Shadow. The new version is loaded into the Shadow (backup) FLASH memory. To check that the new firmware was loaded properly, view the firmware versions stored in the FLASH using the following procedure: 1. From the Main Menu, select 2 – Unit Control. The Unit Control menu opens. 2. From the Unit Control menu, select 5 – Flash Memory Control. The Flash Memory Control menu opens. 3. From the Flash Memory Control menu, select S – Show Flash Versions. The display appears as follows: Flash Versions =========== Current Version: 3.0.39 Shadow Version: 4.0.40 Version After Reset:3.0.39 From the Flash Memory Control menu select the active software version, using the following procedures: To activate the backup (shadow) version: 1. From the Flash Memory Control menu select 1 - Reset and Boot from Shadow Version. The Reset and Boot from Shadow Version menu opens. 2. Select 1 – Reset Now and press ENTER. 3. The unit resets and the Shadow version is used as the newactive version. Note that after the next reset, the Current version will be activated again. If the active version is the Shadow version and you wish to continue using it after the next Reset, use the following procedure: BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual B-6 1. From the Flash Memory Control menu select 2 - Use Current Version After Reset. The Use Current Version After Reset menu opens. 2. Select 1 – Set As Default Now and press ENTER. This will actually cause the names of the two versions to switch. The previous Shadow version will now be called Current and vise versa. The following message will be displayed: UP (DOWN) Image FLASH will be operational (UP or DOWN refers to the location in the flash memory). The loading procedure is protected. An attempt to load an invalid version (e.g. using .fmr when trying to load a new version to units with a FLASH Type: S) will be rejected. Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C: Supported MIBs and Traps BreezeACCESS agents support the following MIBs: MIB-II (RFC1213) BRIDGE-MIB (RFC1286) BreezeCOM brzAccessMib BreezeCOM brzPhoneMib BreezeCOM brznetmib Appendix C C-3 Object OID (Location in parenthesis) Description breezecomAU_I breezecomBreezeACCESS_ACCESS 21 (710.10.2.1.21) AU-I breezecomSU_BS breezecomBreezeACCESS_ACCESS 22 (710.10.2.1.22) SU-BS breezecomAU_BS_WA breezecomBreezeACCESS_ACCESS 23 (710.10.2.1.23) AU-BS-WA breezecomGU_BS breezecomBreezeACCESS_GENERAL 1 (710.10.2.2.1) GU-BS brzAccessMIB Path: breezecom OBJECT IDENTIFIER =1.3.6.1.4.1.710 {(iso(1) org(3) dod(6) internet(1) private(4) enterprises(1) breezecom(710)} breezecomPrvRev {breezecom 3} OBJECT IDENTIFIER = 1.3.6.1.4.1.710.3 brzAccessMib {breezecomPrvRev 3} OBJECT IDENTIFIER = 1.3.6.1.4.1.710.3.3 Note: * is used instead of the brzacc prefix Service Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *ServiceParameters 710.3.3.1 (brzAccessMib 1) MIR/CIR Parameters. *MirCirOption 710.3.3.1.1 (*ServiceParameters 1) Applicable to SU and AU only. The setting in the AU enables/disables the MIR/CIR support feature for all SUs served by the AU, regardless of the setting in the SU. The option exists in the SU only for compatibility with AUs running SW versions 3.X and lower, in which case the MIR/CIR support feature is controlled at the SU. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *MirAUtoSU 710.3.3.1.2 (*ServiceParameters 2) Applicable to SU only. Sets the Maximum Information Rate (MIR) from AU to SU. Integer 32–2200 (Kbps) Must be higher than *CirAUtoSU *MirSUtoAU 710.3.3.1.3 (*ServiceParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. Sets the Maximum Information Rate (MIR) from SU to AU. Integer 32–2200 (Kbps) Must be higher than *CirSUtoAU *CirAUtoSU 710.3.3.1.4 (*ServiceParameters 4) Applicable to SU only. Sets the Committed Information Rate (CIR) from AU to SU. Integer 0–2200 (Kbps) Must be lower than *MirAUtoSU *CirSUtoAU 710.3.3.1.5 (*ServiceParameters 5) Applicable to SU only. Sets the Committed Information Rate (CIR) from SU to AU. Integer 0–2200 (Kbps) Must be lower than *MirSUtoAU *MaxDelay 710.3.3.1.6 (*ServiceParameters 6) Applicable to SU only. Sets the maximal time packets may be delayed by the CIR\MIR mechanism. Above the configured maximal period the packets are discarded. Integer 300 – 10,000 (milliseconds) *MaxBurstDuration 710.3.3.1.7 (*ServiceParameters 7) Applicable to SU and AU. Sets the maximum time during which ìinactivity bonusî time can be accumulated for future burst transmissions. Integer 0 – 2000 (milliseconds) *GracefulDegradationLimit 710.3.3.1.8 (*ServiceParameters 8) Applicable to AU only. Sets the maximum limit for activating the graceful degradation algorithm. Integer 0 – 70 (%) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-4 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *RunTimeMirCirOption 710.3.3.1.9 (*ServiceParameters 9) Applicable to SU only. Indicates the actual status of the MIR/CIR option, which may be different from the setting of this parameter in the SU since it is controlled by the AU. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *MirOnlyOption 710.3.3.1.10 (*ServiceParameters 10) Applicable only to AU when CIR/MIR option is enabled. When enabled, the MIR/CIR algorithm fo determining the actual information rate is overridden and operates only with the configured MIR values. The graceful degradation algorithm is disabled. disable (0) enable (1) na (255) RADIUS General Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *RadiusGeneralParameters 710.3.3.22 (brzAccessMib 22) Applicable to SU only. General RADIUS parameters. *RadiusUserName 710.3.3.22.1 (*RadiusGeneralParameters 1) Applicable to SU only. A string that is used as the User Name when communicating with the RADIUS server. DisplayString (SIZE(64)) Up to 64 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. *RadiusUserPassword 710.3.3.22.2 (*RadiusGeneralParameters 2) Applicable to SU only. A string that is used as the User Password when communicating with the RADIUS server. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community. DisplayString (SIZE(64)) Up to 64 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. *RadiusSharedSecret 710.3.3.22.3 (*RadiusGeneralParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. A string that is used to encrypt the User Password when communicating with the RADIUS server. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community. DisplayString (SIZE(20) Up to 20 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. Accounting Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *AccountingParameters 710.3.3. 3 (brzAccessMib 3) Applicable to SU only. Accounting parameters. *AccountingOption 710.3.3.3.1 (*AccountingParameters 1) Applicable to SU only. Enables or disables the transmission of accounting records to a Radius Server. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *RadiusServerAccounting IpAddress 710.3.3.3.2 (*AccountingParameters 2) Applicable to SU only. IP Address of the Accounting RADIUS server. IP address *AccountingInterval 710.3.3.3.3 (*AccountingParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. Maximum interval, in seconds, between consecutive transmissions of accounting records. Integer 60–6000 (seconds) *RadiusServerAccountingPort 710.3.3.3.4 (*AccountingParameters 4) Applicable to SU only. The accounting port of the RADIUS server. Integer 1000 – 65535 na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-5 RADIUS Authentication Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *RadiusAuthParameters 710.3.3. 21 (brzAccessMib 21) Applicable to SU only. RADIUS Authentication parameters. *RadiusAuthOption 710.3.3. 21.1 (*RadiusAuthParameters 1) Applicable to SU only. Enables or disables the RADIUS Authentication support feature. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) * RadiusServerAuthIpAddress 710.3.3. 21.2 (*RadiusAuthParameters 2) Applicable to SU only. IP Address of the authentication RADIUS server. IP address *RadiusServerAuthPort 710.3.3. 21.3 (*RadiusAuthParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. The authentication port of the RADIUS server. Integer 1000 – 65535 na (255) *RadiusAuthenticationStatus 710.3.3. 21.3 (*RadiusAuthParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. A read-only status of the authentication process. Integer idle (0) sendingRequest (1) waitForResponse(2) sendingChallenge(3) authenticated (4) rejected (5) User Filtering Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *UserFilterParams 710.3.3. 2 (brzAccessMib 2) Applicable to SU only. User Filtering parameters. *UserFilterOption 710.3.3.2.1 (*UserFilterParams 1) Applicable to SU only. Defines user-filtering options. disable: No filtering. iPOnly: Only IP protocol frames pass. userDefinedAddrOnly: Only IP messages to/from user defined IP addresses pass. pPPoE Only: Only PPPoE frames pass. *IpFilterTable 710.3.3.2.2 (*UserFilterParams 2) Applicable to SU only. An IP Filter Table of up to 8 user defined addresses, or address groups, to be used if the selected User Filtering option is userDefinedAddrOnly. Not accessible. *IpFilterEntry 710.3.3.2.2.1 (*IpFilterTable 1) Applicable to SU only. An IP Filter Table entry. Not accessible. *IpID 710.3.3.2.2.1.1 (*IpFilterEntry 1) Applicable to SU only. An IP address of an IP Filter Table entry. IP Address *MaskID 710.3.3.2.2.1.2 (*IpFilterEntry 2) Applicable to SU only. An IP Mask of an IP Filter Table entry. Either a mask or a range, but not both can be used to define an address group. IP Address *IpFilterRange 710.3.3.2.2.1.3 (*IpFilterEntry 3) Applicable to SU only. An addresses range for the IP Filter Table entry. The first address in the range is the IP address (*iPID). Either a mask or a range, but not both can be used to define an address group. Integer 0 - 255 *IpFilterIdx 710.3.3.2.2.1.4 (*IpFilterEntry 4) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. A table index for the IP Filter Table entry. Integer 1-8 Integer disable (0) iPOnly (1) userDefinedAddrOnly(2) pPPoEOnly (3) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-6 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *DeleteOneUserFilter 710.3.3.2.3 (*UserFilterParams 3) Applicable to SU only. Deletes a single selected entry from the IP Filter Table. Integer off (0) firstEntry (1) secondEntry (2) thirdEntry (3) fourthEntry (4) fifthEntry (5) sixthEntry (6) seventhEntry (7) eighthEntry (8) na (255) *DeleteAllUserFilters 710.3.3.2.4 (*UserFilterParams 4) Applicable to SU only. Deletes all entries from the IP Filter Table. Integer off (0) deleteAll (1) off (2) na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-7 Network Management Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *NwMngParameters 710.3.3. 4 (brzAccessMib 4) Network Management parameters. *AccessToNwMng 710.3.3. 4.1 (*NwMngParameters 1) Applicable to AU and SU. The port to be used for remote management. wlanOnly: Management E from Wireless port only. ethOnly: Management enabled from Ethernet port only. bothWlanEth: Management enabled from both Wireless and Ethernet ports. Integer wlanOnly (0) ethOnly (1) bothWlanEth (2) na (255) *NwMngFilter 710.3.3. 4.2 (*NwMngParameters 2) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Disables or enables IP address based filtering of management messages (SNMP/Telnet/ TFTP) on one of the ports, or on both ports. In GU only disable and activateOnEthPort options are available. Integer disable (0) activateOnEthPort (1) activateOnWlanPort (2) activateOnBothWlanAndEth(3) na (255) mngIpFilterTable 710.3.3. 4.3 (*NwMngParameters 3) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. A Management IP Filter Table of up to 3 IP addresses of devices that are authorized to access the unit for management purposes. Not accessible. mngIpFilterEntry 710.3.3. 4.3.1 (mngIpFilterTable 1) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. A Management IP Filter Table entry. Not accessible. *NwMngIpAddress 710.3.3. 4.3.1.1 (mngIpFilterEntry 1) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. An IP address in the Management IP Filter Table. IP address *NwMngIpTableIdx 710.3.3. 4.3.1.2 (mngIpFilterEntry 2) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Read-only. A table index for an entry in the Management IP Filter Table. Integer 1-3 *DeleteOneNwIpAddr 710.3.3. 4.4 (*NwMngParameters 4) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Deletes a single selected entry from the Management IP Filter Table. Integer off (0) firstEntry (1 secondEntry (2) thirdEntry (3) na (255) *DeleteAllNwIpAddrs 710.3.3. 4.5 (*NwMngParameters 5) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Deletes all entries from the Management IP Filter Table. Integer off (0) on (1) na (255) *AccessToNwTrap 710.3.3. 4.6 (*NwMngParameters 6) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Enables or disables sending of SNMP traps. Integer disable (0) enable (1) mngTrapTable 710.3.3. 4.7 (*NwMngParameters 7) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. A Management Trap Table of up to 3 IP addresses of devicess to send traps to. Not accessible. mngTrapEntry 710.3.3. 4.7.1 (mngTrapTable 1) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. A Management Trap Table entry. Not accessible. *NwMngTrapCommunity 710.3.3. 4.7.1.1 (mngTrapEntry 1) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. The trap community associated with the applicable entry in the Management Trap Table. DisplayString (SIZE(14)) Up to 14 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. *NwMngTrapAddress 710.3.3. 4.7.1.2 (mngTrapEntry 2) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. An IP address in the Management Trap Table entry. IP address *NwMngTrapTableIdx 710.3.3. 4.7.1.3 (mngTrapEntry 3) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Read only. Tables Index for an entry in the Management Trap Table. Integer 1-3 *DeleteOneTrapAddr 710.3.3. 4.8 (*NwMngParameters 8) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Deletes a single selected entry from the Management Trap Table. Integer off (0) firstEntry (1) secondEntry (2) thirdEntry (3) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-8 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *DeleteAllTrapAddrs 710.3.3.4.9 (*NwMngParameters 9) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Deletes all entries from the Management Trap Table. *PerTrapControl 710.3.3.4.10 (*NwMngParameters 10) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Per Trap Control parameters. *SendSUAssociatedAUTrap 710.3.3.4.10.1 (*PerTrapControl 1) Applicable to AU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccSUassociatedAUTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendAUDissassociatedTrap 710.3.3.4.10.2 (*PerTrapControl 2) Applicable to AU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccAUdisassociatedTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendAUAgingTrap 710.3.3.4.10.3 (*PerTrapControl 3) Applicable to AU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccAUagingTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendAUWirelessQualityTrap 710.3.3.4.10.4 (*PerTrapControl 4) Applicable to AU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccAUwirelessQualityTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendSUAssociatedTrap 710.3.3.4.10.5 (*PerTrapControl 5) Applicable to SU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccSUassociatedTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendSUWirelessQualityTrap 710.3.3.4.10.6 (*PerTrapControl 6) Applicable to SU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccSUwirelessQualityTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendParameterChangedTrap 710.3.3.4.10.7 (*PerTrapControl 7) Applicable to SU and AU. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccParameterChangedTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendGPSAlarmInTrap 710.3.3.4.10.8 (*PerTrapControl 8) Applicable to GU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccGpsAlarmInTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendGPSAlarmOutTrap 710.3.3.4.10.9 (*PerTrapControl 9) Applicable to GU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccGpsAlarmOutTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendGPSUTCstatusTrap 710.3.3.4.10.10 (*PerTrapControl 10) Applicable to GU only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccGpsUTCstatusTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendPowerUpFromResetTrap 710.3.3.4.10.11 (*PerTrapControl 11) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccPowerUpFromResetTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendMonitorStatusTrap 710.3.3.4.10.12 (*PerTrapControl 12) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccMonitorStatusTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendColdOrWarmStartTrap 710.3.3.4.10.13 (*PerTrapControl 13) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Enables\Disables the sending of Generic Start (Cold\Warm) Trap. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendAULossOfSyncTrap 710.3.3.4.10.14 (*PerTrapControl 14) Applicable to BS-AU in slave mode only. Enables\Disables the sending of brzaccAULossOfSyncTRAP. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *SendAUAlarmsTraps 710.3.3.4.10.15 (*PerTrapControl 15) Applicable to IF-based AU. Enables\Disables the sending of all AU Alarms traps. Integer disable (0) enable (1) Manual Revision: 3.0 Integer 0=off 1=on 2=off 255=na Appendix C C-9 Bridge Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *BridgeParameters 710.3.3. 5 (brzAccessMib.5) Bridge parameters. *EthBroadcastFiltering 710.3.3. 5.1 (*BridgeParameters 1) Applicable to SU only. Enables/disables the filtering of Ethernet (layer2) broadcasts. disable: No filtering. ethOnly: Filter broadcasts received on the Ethernet port only. wlanOnly: Filter broadcasts received on the Wlan port only. bothWlanAndEth: Filter broadcasts received on both ports. *VLANSupport 710.3.3. 5.2 (*BridgeParameters 2) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. VLAN Support Parameters. *VlanID 710.3.3. 5.2.1 (*VLANSupport 1) Applicable to SU only. VLAN ID for data frame tagging. Applicable to Access Link only. Integer 1-4094. 0 means not applicable *EthernetLinkType 710.3.3. 5.2.2 (*VLANSupport 2) Applicable to AU and SU. VLAN support mode (Link Type). The Access Link option is not available for AU. Integer accessLink (1) trunkLink (2) hybridLink (3) *ManagementVID 710.3.3. 5.2.5 (*VLANSupport 5) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. VLAN ID for management frame tagging. For SUs with voice support it is also used for tagging voice frames (RTP packets). Integer 1-4094 65535 means no VLAN tagging. *VoicePriorityTag 710.3.3. 5.2.6 (*VLANSupport 6) Applicable to SU with voice only. Enables prioritization tagging of voice (RTP) frames according to IEEE 802.1p when *ManagementVID is 65535 (No VLAN). Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *VLANForwarding 710.3.3. 5.2.7 (*VLANSupport 7) VLAN Forwarding Feature Parameters *VlanForwardingSupport 710.3.3. 5.2.7.1 (*VLANForwarding 1) Applicable to AU and SU. Enables or disables VLAN Forwarding. (applicable in Trunk links only) *VlanForwardingTable 710.3.3. 5.2.7.2 (*VLANForwarding 2) Applicable to AU and SU. A VLAN Forwarding Table of up to 20 VLAN IDs of devices to which data frames are forwarded when VLAN Forwarding is Enabled. (applicable in Trunk links only). Not accessible. *VlanForwardingEntry 710.3.3. 5.2.7.2.1 (*VlanForwardingTable 1) Applicable to AU and SU. A VLAN Forwarding Table entry. (applicable in Trunk links only). Not accessible. *VlanForwardingIdx 710.3.3. 5.2.7.2.1.1 (*VlanForwardingEntry 1) Applicable to AU and SU. A read only table index for a VLAN entry in the VLAN Forwarding Table. Integer 1 - 20 *VlanIdForwarding 710.3.3. 5.2.7.2.1.2 (*VlanForwardingEntry 2) Applicable to AU and SU. The list of VLAN ID's in the VLAN ID Forwarding Table. To Remove a VLAN ID - SET the corresponding entry to 0. To Add a new VLAN ID SET an entry which is currently 0. Integer 1-4094 0=remove entry. *VLANRelaying 710.3.3. 5.2.8 (*VLANSupport 8) VLAN Relaying Feature Parameters *VlanRelayingSupport 710.3.3. 5.2.8.1 (*VLANRelaying 1) Applicable to AU only. Enables or disables VLAN Relaying. (applicable in Trunk links only) *VlanRelayingTable 710.3.3. 5.2.8.2 (*VLANRelaying 2) Applicable to AU only. A VLAN Relaying Table of up to 20 VLAN IDs of devices to which data frames are relayed when VLAN Relaying is Enabled. (applicable in Trunk links only). Not accessible. Integer disable (0) ethOnly (1) wlanOnly (2) bothWlanAndEth(3) na (255) Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-10 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *VlanRelayingEntry 710.3.3. 5.2.8.2.1 (*VlanRelayingTable 1) Applicable to AU only. A VLAN Relaying Table entry. (applicable in Trunk links only). Not accessible. *VlanRelayingIdx 710.3.3. 5.2.8.2.1.1 (*VlanRelayingEntry) 1 Applicable to AU only. A read only table index for a VLAN entry in the VLAN Relaying Table. Integer 1 - 20 *VlanIdRelaying 710.3.3. 5.2.8.2.1.2 (*VlanRelayingEntry 2) Applicable to AU only. The list of VLAN ID's in the VLAN ID Relaying Table. To Remove a VLAN ID - SET the corresponding entry to 0. To Add a new VLAN ID SET an entry which is currently 0. Integer 1-4094 0=remove entry. *VLANTrafficPriority 710.3.3. 5.2.9 (*VLANSupport 9) VLAN Traffic Priority Parameters *VlanDataPriority 710.3.3. 5.2.9.1 (*VLANTrafficPriority 1) Applicable to SU only. Priority tagging for data frames. Applicable to Access Link only. Integer 0–7 na (255) *VlanVoicePriority 710.3.3. 5.2.9.2 (*VLANTrafficPriority 2) Applicable to SU with voice only. Priority tagging for voice frames. Applicable to Access Link and Trunk Link only. Integer 0–7 na (255) *VlanManagementPriority 710.3.3. 5.2.9.3 (*VLANTrafficPriority 3) Applicable to AU, SU and GU. Priority tagging for management frames. Applicable to units with a *ManagementVID other than 65535. Integer 0–7 na (255) *PriorityQueueThreshold 710.3.3. 5.2.9.4 (*VLANTrafficPriority 4) Applicable to AU and SU. Priority threshold for tagged frames received from Ethernet port. Applicable to Hybrid Link and Trunk Link only. Integer 0–7 na (255) *BridgeAgingTime 710.3.3. 5.3 (*BridgeParameters 3) Applicable to AU and SU. Bridge aging time for devices learned from both the Ethernet and wireless link ports. Integer 100 – 2000 (seconds) *LanToWirelessLinkBridgeMode 710.3.3. 5.4 (*BridgeParameters 4) Applicable to AU only. Controls the flow of information from Ethernet to Wlan. rejectUnknown: Permits only transmission to addresses known to be on the Wlan side. forwardUnknown: Forwards all frames, except those sent to addresses known to be on the Ethernet side. Integer rejectUnknown (0) forwardUnknown (1) na (255) *BroadcastRelaying 710.3.3. 5.5 (*BridgeParameters 5) Applicable to AU only. Enables/disables the relaying of broadcast messages to the wireless link. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *UnicastRelaying 710.3.3. 5.6 (*BridgeParameters 6) Applicable to AU only. Enables/disables the relaying of unicast messages to the wireless link. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *EthBroadcastingParameters 710.3.3. 5.7 (*BridgeParameters 7) Applicable to SU only. Ethernet Broadcasting parameters. *DHCPBroadcastOverrideFilter 710.3.3. 5.7.1 (*EthBroadcastingParameters 1) Applicable to SU only. Enables or disables the broadcasting of DHCP messages, overriding the general *EthBroadcastFiltering Ethernet broadcast filtering option Integer no (0) yes (1) na (255) * PPPoEBroadcastOverrideFilter 710.3.3. 5.7.2 (*EthBroadcastingParameters 2) Applicable to SU only. Enables or disables the broadcasting of PPPoE messages, overriding the general *EthBroadcastFiltering Ethernet broadcast filtering option. Integer no (0) yes (1) na (255) * ARPBroadcastOverrideFilter 710.3.3. 5.7.3 (*EthBroadcastingParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. Enables or disables the broadcasting of ARP messages, overriding the general *EthBroadcastFiltering Ethernet broadcast filtering option. Integer no (0) yes (1) na (255) *VoicePacketsToS 710.3.3. 5.8.1 (*ToSPriorityParameters 1) Applicable to SU with voice only. The Type of Service value to be inserted in the IP header of voice (RTP) packets. Integer 0-255 *ToSPrecedenceThreshold 710.3.3. 5.8.2 (*ToSPriorityParameters 2) Applicable to SU and AU only. Priority threshold (based on the ToS) for frames received from Ethernet port. Integer 0-7 *ToSPriorityParameters 710.3.3. 5.8 (*BridgeParameters 8) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-11 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *PortsControl 710.3.3. 5.9 (*BridgeParameters 9) Applicable to SU only. Port Control parameters *EthernetPortControl 710.3.3. 5.9.1 (*PortsControl 1) Applicable to SU only. Enable/disable the Ethernet port. When disabled, only data frames are blocked. Management frames are accepted. Integer disable (0) *VoicePortControl Applicable to SU with voice only. Enable/ Integer 710.3.3. 5.9.2 (*PortsControl 2) disable the voice port. disable (0) enable (1) enable (1) Air Interface Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *AirInterface 710.3.3. 6 (brzAccessMib 6) *ESSID 710.3.3. 6.1 (*AirInterface 1) Applicable to SU and AU. The Extended Service Set ID (ESSID) used to prevent the merging of collocated systems. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community.Can be viewed (get) with the SNMP Read Community only if *SNMPReadESSID is enabled. DisplayString (SIZE(31)) Up to 31 printable case sensitive ASCII characters. *AckDelayLimit 710.3.3. 6.2 (*AirInterface 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Defines the maximum time the unit waits for a response message to a transmission (e.g. ACK, CTS, response during association process) before deciding that the transmission failed Defining a higher range causes the unit to wait a longer time for a response before retransmission. Low: Up to 10km Medium: Up to 20km High: Greater than 20km. Integer Low (0) Medium (1) High (2) na (255) *FreqOffset 710.3.3. 6.3 (*AirInterface 3) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS XL and BreezeACCESS V 5..7GHz families. Not applicable to BreezeACCESS XL units that support only Flexible Hopping Definition for setting the hopping frequencies (e.g. 3.3a band). Not applicable in Flexible Hopping Definition mode. Integer na (255) In BreezeACCESS XL it determines the beginning of the actual hopping band or single channel frequency relative to the beginning of the radio band. Start of hopping band (channel) = Start of radio band+2 X Frequency Offset. In BreezeACCESS XL the valid range of values is dependent on the bandwidth of the radio and on the selected Hopping Band. Max. Frequency Offset = [Overall radio bandwidth-Hopping Band]/2 In BreezeACCESS V 5.7GHz, the permitted range is 0 to 45 (MHz) in ISM US FCC mode and 0 to 70 (MHz) in ISM International mode. In BreezeACCESS V 5.7GHz operating in ISM US FCC or ISM International mode, it determines the shift in MHz of each channel’s frequency relative to the channel’s frequency in the basic hopping sequence. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-12 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *TransmitDiversity 710.3.3. 6.4 (*AirInterface 4) Applicable to SU-R, SU-I and AU-I units only. Enables the selection of the antenna(s) to be used for transmission. Integer use2Antennasn (0) antenna1 (1) antenna2 (2) na (255) *HoppingSequence 710.3.3. 6.5 (*AirInterface 5) Applicable to AU in BreezeACCESS II family only. Determines the hopping sequence to be used. Different AUs in the same geographical area should use different Hopping Sequences from the same Hopping Set. The valid range is dependant on the Country Standard. Integer Na (255) Australia: 1-20 Canada: 1-10 Europe ETSI: 1-26 France: 1-11 Israel: 1-11 Japan: 1-4 Korea: 1-4 Netherlands: 1-5 Spain: 1-9 US FCC: 1-26 Mexico: 1-10 International: 1-26 *HoppingSet 710.3.3. 6.6 (*AirInterface 6) Applicable to AU in BreezeACCESS II family only. Determines the hopping set to be used. All AUs in the same geographical area should use the same Hopping Set. Integer 1-3 na (255) *HoppingSync 710.3.3. 6.7 (*AirInterface 7) Applicable to BS-AU only. Inter-AU hopping sync functionality of the unit. In the BreezeACCESS II family, synchronization among AUs is not available with the following Country Standards: US FCC, Australia, Canada. In the BreezeACCESS V family, synchronization is not available if the selected hopping band is ISM US FCC. Integer idle (0) slave (1) master (2) na (255) *HoppingShift 710.3.3. 6.8 (*AirInterface 8) Applicable to AU in BreezeACCESS V, XL and MMDS families and in BreezeACCESS II if *HoppingBands is frqFlexibleHopping. Defines a hopping pattern different from the basic hopping sequence (Hopping Shift=0). Different collocated AUs should use different hopping shifts. Integer na (255) Range 0 to [number of operational channels-1] Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) *HoppingBands 710.3.3. 6.9 (*AirInterface 9) C-13 Description Values/Range Applicable to SU and AU only. In BreezeACCESS II units set in the factory to “Country Standard Protected” this is read-only, showing the Country Standard set in the factory. Integer na (255) The available values represent settings that are dependent on the specific radio band. BreezeACCESS II (read only when configured in factory to “Country Standard Protected”): frqSiteProprietary (3) frqISMEuropeETSI (4) frqISMUsFCC (5) frqISMJapan (6) frqISMKorea (7) frqISMAustralia (8) frqISMIsrael (9) frqISMNetherlands (11) frqISMFrance (12) frqISMSpain (13) frqISMCanada (14) frqInternational (22) frqFlexibleHopping (37) frqSingleChannel2_4GHz (41) frqISMMexico (67) MMDS (read only): frqFlexibleHopping (37) BreezeACCESS 2.6b: frqFlexibleHopping (37) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence10MHz (44) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence12MHz (45) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence14MHz (46) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence24MHz (47) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence28MHz (48) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence36MHz (49) frq2_6GhzHoppingSequence42MHz (50) frqSingleChannel2_6Ghz (51) BreezeACCESS 3.3a, 3.5e, 3.6b: (read only) frqFlexibleHopping (37) BreezeACCESS 3.5a: frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence10MHz (15) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence12MHz (16) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence14MHz (17) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence24MHz (18) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence28MHz (19) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence36MHz (20) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence42MHz (21) frqFlexibleHopping (37) frqSingleChannel3_5GHz (40) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence24MhzPropriet ary(69) BreezeACCESS 3.5a1: frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence10MHz (23) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence12MHz (24) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence14MHz (25) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence24MHz (26) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence28MHz (27) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence36MHz (28) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence42MHz (29) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence50MHz (33) frqFlexibleHopping (37) frqSingleChannel3_5a1GHz (39) frq3_5a1GHzHoppingSequence24MhzProprie tary(70) In BreezeACCESS MMDS it is readonly, showing Flexible Hopping Definition. In BreezeACCESS XL products that support only Flexible Hopping Definition for setting the hopping frequencies (e.g. 3.3a band), it is read-only, showing Flexible Hopping Definition. In other BreezeACCESS XL products, supporting the use of the Hopping Band parameter for setting the hopping frequencies, this is readwrite, enabling the selection of a fixed Hopping Band, Single Channel operation or Flexible Hopping Definition. In BreezeACCESS V units in the 5.7GHz band that are configured to support only ISM US FCC hopping standard, it is read-only. Otherwise it is read-write, supporting the selection of ISM US FCC, ISM International and Flexible Hopping Definition, In BreezeACCESS V units in the 5.2GHz band it is read-only, showing Flexible Hopping Definition. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-14 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description *HoppingBands (continued) Values/Range BreezeACCESS 3.5b, 3.5ab: frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence10MHz (15) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence12MHz (16) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence14MHz (17) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence24MHz (18) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence28MHz (19) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence36MHz (20) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence42MHz (21) frq3_5bGHzHoppingSequence50MHz (32) frqFlexibleHopping (37) frqSingleChannel3_5GHz (40) frq3_5aGHzHoppingSequence24MhzPropriet ary(69) BreezeACCESS 3.8: frq3_8GHzBand1 (0) frq3_8GHzSelectable (1) frq3_8GHzApprovalSpectrumMask (2) frqFlexibleHopping (37) frqSingleChannel3_8GHz (42) BreezeACCESS 5.2: (read only) frqFlexibleHopping (37) BreezeACCESS 5.7 frg5_7GHzISMUsFCC(74) frg5_7GHzInternational(75) frg5_7GHzFlexibleHopping(37) *MaxDataRate 710.3.3. 6.10 (*AirInterface 10) Applicable to SU and AU. The maximum transmission data rate. Integer max1Mbps (1) max2Mbps (2) max3Mbps (3) na (255) *TransmitPowerControl 710.3.3. 6.11 (*AirInterface 11) Applicable to IF based units only. Not applicable to AlvariBase, AU-BS-WA Enables reducing the transmit power level. The maximum available value is for maximum power. A lower value reduces the transmitted power. The resulting transmit power level depends on the unit type (band) and on the attenuation of the IF cable. In SU, If ATPC is enabled the algorithm Integer BreezeACCESS II, XL and MMDS: 0-15 BreezeACCESS V: 0-7 na (255) *RxAttenuationControl 710.3.3. 6.12 (*AirInterface 12) Applicable to IF-based SU (SU-A/E) only. Enables to set the attenuation in the receive path to 0, 10 or 25dB. The effect of inserting such attenuation in the receive circuit is equivalent to reducing the level of the received signal (including both signal and noise) by 2dB when selecting 10dB attenuation and 12dB when selecting 25dB attenuation. Integer low0dB (0) med10dB (1) high25dB (2) na (255) *MaximumVoiceSessions 710.3.3. 6.14 (*AirInterface 14) Applicable to AU only. The maximum number of simultaneous voice sessions permitted to guarantee minimum quality. Integer 0-50 na (255) *FlexSubBandDef 710.3.3. 6.15 (*AirInterface 15) Applicable to SU and AU only. Flexible Hopping Definition parameters. uses it as the initial power level. Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-15 Description Values/Range *AddSubBand 710.3.3. 6.15.1 (*FlexSubBandDef 1) Applicable to SU and AU only. In BreezeACCESS II, V and MMDS families it adds sub-bands (f1-f2) or discrete frequencies to the list of sub-bands/frequencies to be used for generating the basic Hopping Sequence after the next reset. In BreezeACCESS XL it defines a new set of sub-bands/frequencies to be used for generating the basic Hopping Sequence after the next reset. DisplayString (SIZE(244)) Up to 244 printable ASCII characters. Use either MHZ resolution ìaaaaî or kHz resolution ìaaaa.bbbî. Use a hyphen between two entries defining a sub-band. Use a comma between sub-bands and/or discrete frequency entries. Do not use spaces. *DelSubBand 710.3.3. 6.15.2 (*FlexSubBandDef 2) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS II, V and MMDS families only. Deletes sub-bands (f1-f2) or discrete frequencies from the list of subbands/frequencies to be used for generating the basic Hopping Sequence after the next reset. DisplayString (SIZE(244)) Up to 244 printable ASCII characters. Use either MHZ resolution ìaaaaî or kHz resolution ìaaaa.bbbî. Use a hyphen between two entries defining a sub-band. Use a comma between sub-bands and/or discrete frequency entries. Do not use spaces. *ErazeAllSubBands 710.3.3. 6.15.3 (*FlexSubBandDef 3) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS II, V and MMDS families only. Deletes all entries from the table of the frequencies to be used. Integer eraseAll (0) noOperation (1) na (255) *SubBandTable 710.3.3. 6.15.4 (*FlexSubBandDef 4) Applicable to SU and AU only. The list of sub-bands to be supported after next reset. Not accessible. *SubBandEntry 710.3.3. 6.15.4.1 (*SubBandTable 1) Applicable to SU and AU only. A Sub-Band Table entry. Not accessible. *SubBand 710.3.3. 6.15.4.1.1 (*SubBandEntry 1) Applicable only to SW version 2.6. Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A Sub-Band in the Sub-Bands Table. Integer *SubBandsTableIdx 710.3.3. 6.15.4.1.2 (*SubBandEntry 2) Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A Sub-Band Table entry index. Integer *SubBandExp 710.3.3. 6.15.4.1.3 (*SubBandEntry 3) Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A Sub-Band in the Sub-Bands Table. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) *CurrentHoppingSeqTable 710.3.3. 6.15.5 (*FlexSubBandDef 5) Applicable to SU and AU only. The list of hopping frequencies in the Current Hopping Sequence. Not accessible. *CurrentHoppingSeqEntry 710.3.3. 6.15.5.1 (*CurrentHoppingSeqTable 1) Applicable to SU and AU only. A Current Hopping Sequence Table entry. Not accessible. *HopSeqSubBand 710.3.3. 6.15.5.1.1 (*CurrentHoppingSeqEntry 1) Applicable only to SW version 2.6. Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A frequency in the Current Hopping Sequence Table. Integer *CurrHopSeqTableIdx 710.3.3. 6.15.5.1.2 (*CurrentHoppingSeqEntry 2) Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A Current Hopping Sequence Table index. Integer *CurrSubBandExp 710.3.3. 6.15.5.1.3 *CurrentHoppingSeqEntry 3) Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A frequency in the Current Hopping Sequence Table. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-16 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *ChannelSpacing 710.3.3. 6.15.5 (*FlexSubBandDef 5) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS XL family only. Applicable only in Flexible Hopping Definition mode. Defines the minimum distances between two frequencies. (Not available in some products that only support a 2MHz Channel Spacing) Integer space1_75MHz (0) space1MHz (1) space2MHz (2) na (255) *AddFlexHopChannels 710.3.3. 6.15.7 (*FlexSubBandDef 7) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS MMDS family only. Adds MMDS channels to the list of channels to be used. DisplayString (SIZE(244)) Up to 244 printable ASCII characters in one of the following formats: 1. A1 2. B2,C3,G4 (no spaces) *DelFlexHopChannels 710.3.3. 6.15.8 (*FlexSubBandDef 8) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS MMDS family only. Deletes MMDS channels from the list of channels to be used. DisplayString (SIZE(244)) Up to 244 printable ASCII characters in one of the following formats: 1. A1 2. B2,C3,G4 (no spaces) *ScramblingDefinition 710.3.3. 6.15.9 (*FlexSubBandDef 9) Applicable to SU and AU. Scrambling parameters. *ScramblingMode 710.3.3. 6.15.9.1 (*ScramblingDefinition 1) Applicable to SU and AU. The method of scrambling the frequencies defined in the Flexible Hopping Definition process for generating the basic hopping sequence. Standard mode - this mode automatically scrambles the frequencies according to the algorithm used in SW version 3.x and lower. It is suitable for up to 6 frequencies. Enhanced mode - this mode automatically scrambles the frequencies according to a new algorithm. Manual mode - The user defines the hopping sequence using the frequencies indexes. Integer standardMode (1) manualMode (2) enhancedMode(3) *ManualSequenceDefinition 710.3.3. 6.15.9.2 (*ScramblingDefinition 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Manual scrambling definition. Configuring the sequence using the frequencies indexes. Display String. Up to 244 printable ASCII characters. Allowed Range of Indexes: '1' to 'Number of Channels'. Sequence Length must be equal to 'Number of Channels'. Use a comma to separate between entries. *EraseManualSequence 710.3.3. 6.15.9.3 (*ScramblingDefinition 3) Applicable to SU and AU. Erase the manually configured sequence. Integer cancelOperation (0) eraseAll (1) *SpanningFactor 710.3.3. 6.15.9.4 (*ScramblingDefinition 4) Applicable to AU only. The Spanning Factor to be used by the Enhanced Scrambling mechanism. The Spanning Factor should be chosen so that the GCD (Greater Common Divisor) of the Spanning Factor and the Number of Frequencies would be 1 (e.g. for 8 frequencies possible values for the Spanning Factor are 1, 3, 5 and 7). The SU learns the value of the Spanning Factor from the AU. Integer From 1 to ‘Number of Frequencies’, provided it meets the GCD requirement. *ScrambledSeqTable 710.3.3. 6.15.9.5 (*ScramblingDefinition 5) Applicable to SU and AU only. The scrambled sequence to be supported after next reset. Not accessible. *ScrambledSeqEntry 710.3.3. 6.15. 9.5.1 (*ScrambledSeqTable 1) Applicable to SU and AU only. A Scrambled Sequence Table entry. Not accessible. Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-17 Description Values/Range *ScrambledSeqTableIdx 710.3.3. 6.15. 9.5.1.1 (**ScrambledSeqEntry 1) Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A Scrambled Sequence Table entry index. Integer *ScrambledSeqFreqIdx 710.3.3. 6.15. 9.5.1.2 (**ScrambledSeqEntry 2) Applicable to SU and AU only. Readonly. A Frequency Index in the Scrambled Sequence Table. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) *CallAgingTime 710.3.3. 6.16 (*AirInterface 16) Applicable to AU only. The aging time for a voice call in the Call Info database. Integer 1-50,000 (seconds) 1=No aging *SecurityParameters 710.3.3. 6.17 (*AirInterface 17) Security Parameters *PrivacyOptionImplemented 710.3.3. 6.17.1 (*SecurityParameters 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Read Only. Enable/disable the privacy option. Normally set to active. Integer notActive (0) active (1) *AuthenticationAlgorithm 710.3.3. 6.17.2 (*SecurityParameters 2) Applicable to SU and AU only. Enables/disables the authentication option. Integer openSystem (0) sharedKey (1) openSystem: authentication messages are not encrypted. supportAll (2) (AU only) sharedKey: Authentication messages are encrypted. supportAll: Applicable for AU only. Allows authentication of all SUs, regardless of the Authentication Algorithm and WEP Key used in the SU. *DefaultKeyID 710.3.3. 6.17.3 (*SecurityParameters 3) Applicable to SU only. The ID of the key to be used for encryption the authentication messages. Integer 1-4 *WEPKey1 710.3.3. 6.17.4 (*SecurityParameters 4) Applicable to SU and AU only. Encryption WEP Key#1. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) Ten hexadecimal digits *WEPKey2 710.3.3. 6.17.5 (*SecurityParameters 5) Applicable to SU and AU only. Encryption WEP Key#2. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) Ten hexadecimal digits *WEPKey3 710.3.3. 6.17.6 (*SecurityParameters 6) Applicable to SU and AU only. Encryption WEP Key#3. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) Ten hexadecimal digits *WEPKey4 710.3.3. 6.17.7 (*SecurityParameters 7) Applicable to SU and AU only. Encryption WEP Key#4. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community. DisplayString (SIZE(10)) Ten hexadecimal digits. *CurrentTxPwrLvl 710.3.3. 6.18 (*AirInterface 18) Applicable only to SU-R units and to SU-I and AU-I units with HW version C or lower. Enables setting the transmitted power level according to the unit capabilities. In SU-R-3.5ab, If ATPC is enabled the algorithm uses it as the initial Integer Low (0) *WirelessTrapThreshold 710.3.3. 6.19 (*AirInterface 19) A wireless link quality threshold for sending the *WirelessStatusTRAP,or *WirelessStatusOfSUsTRAP. These traps indicate whether the quality has gone below or above the specified threshold. Integer SU: 0-255 (RSSI units) AU: 0-100 (% retransmissions) *NumberOfHoppingFrequenciess 710.3.3. 6.20 (*AirInterface 20) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The Number of Hopping Frequencies used in the AU. Integer 0-151 na (255) high (1)medium (2) SU-R-3.5ab – applicable only to power level. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-18 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *OperatorESSID 710.3.3. 6.21 (*AirInterface 21) Applicable to AU only. A secondary ESSID to support upgrade of existing installations. All AUs in the region should be configured to the same Operator ESSID to allow a new SU to associate with any AU. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community DisplayString (SIZE(31)) Up to 31 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. *RunTimeESSID 710.3.3. 6.22 (*AirInterface 22) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. The ESSID of the associated AU. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community.Can be viewed (get) with the SNMP Read Community only if *SNMPReadESSID is enabled. DisplayString (SIZE(31)) Up to 31 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. *BestAu 710.3.3. 6.23 (*AirInterface 23) Best AU Parameters *BestAuSupport 710.3.3. 6.23.1 (*BestAu 1) Applicable to SU only. Disable/ enable the Best AU selection mechanism. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *BestAuNoOfScanningAttempts 710.3.3. 6.23.2 (*BestAu 2) Applicable to SU only. The number of scanning attempts to collect information for the Best AU decision. Integer 1 – 255 *NeighborAuTable 710.3.3. 6.23.3 (*BestAu 3) Applicable to SU only. A table of data on neighboring AUs. Not accessible. *NeighborAuEntry 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1 (*NeighborAuTable 1) Applicable to SU only. An entry in the Neighbor AU Table. Not accessible. *NeighborAuMacAdd 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.1 (*NeighborAuEntry 1) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. A MAC address of an AU in the Neighbor AU Table. MAC address *NeighborAuESSID 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.2 (*NeighborAuEntry 2) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. The ESSID of an AU in the Neighbor AU Table. Accessible only with SNMP Write Community DisplayString (SIZE(31)) Up to 31 printable ASCII characters, case sensitive. *NeighborAuRssi 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.3 (*NeighborAuEntry 3) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. The received signal strength in RSSI units of an AU in the Neighbor AU Table. Integer *NeighborAuAssocLoadStatus 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.4 (*NeighborAuEntry 4) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Neighbor AU association load status in the Neighbor AU Table. Integer notFull (0) full (1) na (255) *NeighborAuMark 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.5 (*NeighborAuEntry 5) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Neighbor AU mark in the Neighbor AU Table. Integer *NeighborAuIdx 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.6 (*NeighborAuEntry 6) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. An index of an entry in the Neighbor AU Table. Integer *NeighborAuDbm 710.3.3. 6.23.3.1.7 (*NeighborAuEntry 7) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. The received signal strength in dBm of an AU in the Neighbor AU Table. Integer *PreferredAuMacAddress 710.3.3. 6.23.5 (*BestAu 5) Applicable to SU only. The MAC address of the preferred AU (overriding the Best AU selection process. 00...00 (all zeros in address) means no preferred AU is set. MAC Address Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-19 Description Values/Range *TransmitLevel 710.3.3. 6.24 (*AirInterface 24) Applicable only to SU-I and AU-I units with HW version D and higher. Sets the level in dBm of the transmitted power at the antenna port. * brzaccAtpc 710.3.3. 6.25 (*AirInterface 25) ATPC Parameters *AtpcOption 710.3.3. 6.25.1 (*Atpc 1) Applicable to IF based units and SUR-3.5ab units only. Enabling/ disabling the ATPC Algorithm. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *AtpcMaximumRSSI 710.3.3. 6.25.2 (*Atpc 2) Applicable to IF based AU only. Defines the maximum desired level of the average RSSI at the AU. Above this level, if *AtpcOption is enabled, the AU will transmit ATPC Power-Down messages to the applicable SU. The *AtpcMaximumRSSI cannot be lower than *AtpcMinimumRSSI. Display String -100 to 0 [dBm] AtpcMinimumRSSI 710.3.3. 6.25.3 (*Atpc 3) Applicable to IF based AU only. Defines the minimum desired level of the average RSSI at the AU. Below this level, if *AtpcOption is enabled, the AU will transmit ATPC Power-Up messages to the applicable SU. The *AtpcMinimumRSSI cannot be higher than *AtpcMaximumRSSI. Display String -100 to 0 [dBm] AtpcMinimumIntervalBetweenMessage 710.3.3. 6.25.4 (*Atpc 4) Applicable to IF based AU only. The minimum interval between two consecutive AU to SU ATPC PowerUp/Power-Down messages. Integer 0 to 3600 (seconds) na (255) RssiMemoryFactor 710.3.3. 6.25.5 (*Atpc 5) Applicable to IF based AU only. The weight of history in average RSSI calculation. The higher is the value, the higher is the weight of history Display String -1 (disregard history) to 32 AtpcLevelSteps 710.3.3. 6.25.6 (*Atpc 6) Applicable to IF based AU only. The step size in percentages of maximum number of available levels that the SU will use when receiving an ATPC Power-Up/Power-Down message. Integer 1-100(%) na (255) AtpcMaxLastLevelTimeAfterReset 710.3.3. 6.25.7 (*Atpc 7) Applicable to IF based SU and SUR-3.5ab units only. The maximum time (in seconds) of scanning attempts after reset, using the last value of *CurrentTransmitPowerControl, before returning to the configured value of *TransmitPowerControl (IFbased SU) or *CurrentTxPwrLvl (SUR-3.5ab). Integer 0 to 3600 [Seconds] AtpcMaxLastLevelTimeAfterSyncLoss 710.3.3. 6.25.8 (*Atpc 8) Applicable to IF based SU and SUR-3.5ab units only. The maximum time (in seconds) of scanning attempts after synchronization loss, using the last value of *CurrentTransmitPowerControl, before returning to the configured value of *TransmitPowerControl (IFbased SU) or brzaccCurrentTxPwrLvl (SU-R3.5ab). Integer 0 to 3600 [Seconds] *ACSEParameters 710.3.3. 6.27 (*AirInterface 27) Applicable for AU, SU and GU. ACSE Voice Scheduler parameters. Integer 0-21dBm na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-20 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *ACSEOption 710.3.3. 6.27.1 (*ACSEParameters 1) Applicable for AU, SU and GU. Read-only in the SU. Disable/enable the ACSE Voice Scheduler mechanism. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *ACSEDwellTime 710.3.3. 6.27.2 (*ACSEParameters 2) Applicable for AU, SU and GU. Read-only. The dwell time when the *ACSEOption is enabled. Currently set to 60 milliseconds. Integer 60 (mseconds) na (255) *ACSEMaximumVoiceSessions 710.3.3. 6.27.3 (*ACSEParameters 3) Applicable to AU only. The maximum number of simultaneous ACSE voice sessions permitted to guarantee minimum quality. Applicable only when the *ACSEOption is enabled. Integer 0-15 na (255) *ACSENumberOfDataRetransmissions 710.3.3. 6.27.4 (*ACSEParameters 4) Applicable to SU and AU. Maximum times to retransmit an unacknowledged data packet. Applicable only when the *ACSEOption is enabled. Integer 0-100 *ACSENumberOfVoiceRetransmission 710.3.3. 6.27.5 (*ACSEParameters 5) Applicable to SU with voice and AU. Maximum times to retransmit an unacknowledged voice packet. Applicable only when the *ACSEOption is enabled. Integer 0-100 *OperatorESSIDOption 710.3.3. 6.28 (*AirInterface 28) Applicable for AU only. The Enabling/disabling the use of the Operator ESSID. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *MaxNumOfAssociations 710.3.3. 6.29 (*AirInterface 29) Sets the upper limit for the number of Subscriber Units that can be associated with the AU. Integer 0-512 *CurrentTransmitPowerControl 710.3.3. 6.30 (*AirInterface 30) Applicable for both AU and SU IF based SU units (SU-A/E) and SU-R3.5ab units. Displays the current value that is used to control the transmit power level of the unit. If brzaccAtpcOption is disabled, it equals the value of brzaccTransmitPowerControl (SU-A/E units) or brzaccCurrentTxPwrLvl (SU-R-3.5ab units). If brzaccAtpcOption is enabled, its' value may change depending on the ATPC algorithm. Integer SU-A/E in BreezeACCESS II, XL and MMDS: 0-15, SU-A/E in BreezeACCESS V: 0-7 SU-R-3.5ab:0-2 * SiteProprietary 710.3.3. 6.31 (*AirInterface 31) Site Proprietary parameters. Applicable only to BreezeACCESS II SU and AU configured to work in the special Site Proprietary hopping standard. *SPNumOfFreqs 710.3.3. 6.31.1 (* SiteProprietary 1) Number of frequencies in the proprietary hopping sets parameters. *FirstSetNumOfFreqs 710.3.3. 6.31.1.1 (*SPNumOfFreqs 1) Read-Only. Number of frequencies in the first set. Integer na (255) *SecondSetNumOfFreqs 710.3.3. 6.31.1.2 (*SPNumOfFreqs 2) Read-Only. Number of frequencies in the second set. Integer na (255) *ThirdSetNumOfFreqs 710.3.3. 6.31.1.3 (*SPNumOfFreqs 3) Read-Only. Number of frequencies in the third set. Integer na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-21 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-22 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *ScanningMode 710.3.3.6.35 (*AirInterface 35) Applicable to SU only. Not applicable if *ACSEOption is enabled. Sets the scanning mode. passive (1) active (2) na (255) *SendRoamingSNAP 710.3.3.6.37 (*AirInterface 37) Applicable to all SUs, except to SUBD and SU-BD1V. Disables/enables the Send Roaming SNAP feature. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *AUTransmissionRateContro l710.3.3.6.38 (*AirInterface 38) Applicable to SU only. When enabled, the maximum rate of transmissions from the AU to this SU is determined by the value of the Maximum Data Rate in the SU. Integerdisable (0) enable (1) na (255) *MacAddressBlackList 710.3.3.6.39 (*AirInterface 36) Applicable to AU only. Not Accessible. MAC Address Black List parameters * MacAddressBlackListTable 710.3.3.6.39.1 (*MacAddressBlackList 1) Applicable to AU only. Not Accessible. A list of up to 100 MAC Addresses of SUs that will not be served by the AU. *MacAddressBlackListTableEntry 710.3.3.6.39.1.1 (*MacAddressBlackListTable 1) Applicable to AU only. Not Accessible. An entry in the Mac Address Black List Table. *MacAddressBlackListTableIdx 710.3.3.6.39.1.1.1 (*MacAAddressBlackListTableEntry 1) Applicable to AU only. A read only table index for a MAC Address entry in the Mac Address Black List Table. Integer 1-100 *MacAddressBlackListId 710.3.3.6.39.1.1.2 (*MacAddressBlackListTableEntry 2) Applicable to AU only. The list of MAC Addresses in the Mac Address Black List Table. To Remove a MAC Address - SET the corresponding entry to 0. To Add a new MAC Address - SET an entry which is currently 0. MacAddress Performance Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *PerformanceParams 710.3.3. 7 (brzAccessMib 7) *NumOfRetransmissions 710.3.3. 7.1 (*PerformanceParams 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Maximum times to retransmit an unacknowledged packet. Applicable only when the *ACSEOption is disabled. Integer 0-100 *NumOfDwellToRetransmit 710.3.3. 7.2 (*PerformanceParams 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Minimum dwell periods during which an unacknowledged packet is retransmitted. Integer 0-9 *NumOfRetransToDecRate 710.3.3. 7.3 (*PerformanceParams 3) Applicable to SU and AU. Number of unsuccessful retransmissions to decrease the transmission rate. Integer 0-10 *MinContentionWin 710.3.3. 7.5 (*PerformanceParams 5) Applicable to SU and AU. Determines the size of the contention window, which is the time to wait before transmission for collision avoidance. Integer 7-255. *MaxMulticastRate 710.3.3. 7.6 (*PerformanceParams 6) Applicable to SU and AU. Maximum rate for transmission of multicast and broadcast messages. Integer max1Mbps (1) max2Mbps (2) max3Mbps (3) na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-23 Description Values/Range *CarrierSenseLevel 710.3.3. 7.7 (*PerformanceParams 7) Applicable to SU and AU. Threshold level for decision on existence of a carrier signal, indicating a transmission from another unit. DisplayString -100 to -40 (dB) *DwellTime 710.3.3. 7.9 (*PerformanceParams 9) Applicable to AU and GU. The time spent on each radio channel (hop). Applicable only when the *ACSEOption is disabled. Integer t32KiloMicroseconds(32) t64KiloMicroseconds(64) t128KiloMicroseconds(128) na (255) *RTSThreshold 710.3.3. 7.10 (*PerformanceParams 10) Applicable to SU and AU. The minimum frame size that requires an RTS/CTS handshake. Integer 20-1600 (bytes) *MultiRate 710.3.3. 7.11 (*PerformanceParams 11) Applicable to SU and AU. Multi-Rate parameters *MultiRateSupport 710.3.3. 7.11.1 (*MultiRate 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Enables/ disables the multi-Rate decision mechanism. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *MultiRateDecisionWinSize 710.3.3. 7.11.2 (*MultiRate 2) Applicable to SU and AU. The size of the decision window for the multi-Rate mechanism (the number of consecutive transmission or retransmission attempts). Integer 1-50 na (255) *NoOfFailuresInDecisionWindow 710.3.3. 7.11.3 (*MultiRate 3) Applicable to SU and AU. The number of failures in the decision window that will cause the window to be defined as unsuccessful. Integer 1 to Decision Window Size. na (255) *GpsHoppingParams 710.3.3. 7.12 (*PerformanceParams 12) GPS Hopping Parameters *NumberOfHoppingFreqs 710.3.3. 7.12.1 (*GpsHoppingParams 1) Applicable to GU Only. The Number of Hopping Frequencies used in the AUs controlled by the GU. *GpsAntennaRecovery 710.3.3. 7.12.3 (*GpsHoppingParams 3) Applicable to GU only. Antenna Recovery parameters. *ManualRecoveryMode 710.3.3. 7.12.3.1 (*GpsAntennaRecovery 1) Applicable to GU only. Enables to initiate an antenna recovery process. Applicable only to master GU. *AutomaticRecoveryMode 710.3.3. 7.12.3.2 (*GpsAntennaRecovery 2) Applicable to GU only. Automatic Antenna Recovery parameters. *AutomaticRecoveryOption 710.3.3. 7.12.3.2.1 (*AutomaticRecoveryMode 1) Applicable to GU only. Enables or disables the automatic GPS antenna recovery mode. Applicable only for a master GU. disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *AutomaticRecoveryInterval 710.3.3. 7.12.3.2.2 (*AutomaticRecoveryMode 2) Applicable to GU only. Defines the time interval in minutes between two consecutive activations of the automatic recovery process. Integer 5-1440 (minutes) *NoiseFloor 710.3.3. 7.13 (*PerformanceParams13) Applicable to SU and AU. Noise Floor Level. Display String -115 to -50[dBm] *CarrierToInterferenceDifference 710.3.3. 7.15 (*PerformanceParams 15 Applicable to SU and AU. The minimal difference between the current estimated noise level and a signal identified as a valid carrier. Integer 6-60 (dB) Integer 0-151 na (255) cancel (0) activateRecoveryProcedureNow (1) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-24 Site Survey Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *SiteSurvey 710.3.3. 8 (brzAccessMib 8) PerHopStatisticsTable 710.3.3. 8.1 (*SiteSurvey 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Statistics accumulated since last reset and average RSSI per frequency for all hopping frequencies in the (sequence). Not Accessible. hopSeqEntry 710.3.3. 8.1.1 (perHopStatisticsTable 1) Applicable to SU and AU. A Per Hop Statistics Table entry. Not accessible. wPperHopStatisticsTable 710.3.3. 8.1.1.1 (hopSeqEntry 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Readonly. The channel number according to the hopping sequence. Integer hopTracerRx 710.3.3. 8.1.1.2 (hopSeqEntry 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Readonly. The accumulated number of frames received since last reset at the applicable frequency. Integer hopTracerTx 710.3.3. 8.1.1.3 (hopSeqEntry 3) Applicable to SU and AU. Readonly. The accumulated number of frames transmitted since last reset at the applicable frequency. Integer hopTracerRetries 710.3.3. 8.1.1.4 (hopSeqEntry 4) Applicable to SU and AU. Readonly. The accumulated number of frames retransmitted since last reset at the applicable frequency. Integer hopTracerRSSI 710.3.3. 8.1.1.5 (hopSeqEntry 5) Applicable to SU and AU. Readonly. The average RSSI of frames received at the applicable frequency. DisplayString (SIZE(20)) * hopTracerFreq 710.3.3. 8.1.1.6 (hopSeqEntry 6) Applicable to SU and AU. Readonly. The frequency in MHz of the entry. DisplayString (SIZE(9)) *TrafficStatistics 710.3.3. 8.2 (*SiteSurvey 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Traffic Statistics parameters. *ResetTrafficCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.1 (*TrafficStatistics 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Resets the Ethernet Counters (*EthCounters) and the Wireless Link Counters (*WlanCounters). *EthCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.2 (*TrafficStatistics 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Ethernet counters. *TotalRxFramesViaEthernet 710.3.3. 8.2.2.1 (*EthCounters 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. Total number of frames received via the Ethernet port. Counter *TxWirelessToEthernet 710.3.3. 8.2.2.2 (*EthCounters 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. Total number of frames transmitted to the Ethernet port. Counter *WlanCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.3 (*TrafficStatistics 3) Applicable to SU and AU. Wireless link counters. *TotalTxFramesToWireless 710.3.3. 8.2.3.1 (*WlanCounters 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of frames transmitted to the wireless media. The count includes one count for each data or RTP frame that was transmitted successfully (excluding retransmissions), and also the number of transmitted control and management frames. Manual Revision: 3.0 Integer noReset (0) reset (1) Counter Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-25 Description Values/Range *TotalRxFramesFromWireless 710.3.3. 8.2.3.2 (*WlanCounters 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The total number of frames that were received from the wireless media. The count includes data and control and management frames, including beacons received from the AU. The count does not include frames that were discarded internally, bad frames and duplicate frames. Counter *TotalRetransmittedFragments 710.3.3. 8.2.3.3 (*WlanCounters 3) For future use Counter *WlanFramesDropped 710.3.3. 8.2.3.4 (*WlanCounters 4) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of dropped frames. The frames that were retransmitted to the extent of the maximum allowed number of retransmissions without being acknowledged. Counter *TransmittedFramesToWirelessDat 710.3.3. 8.2.3.5 (*WlanCounters 5) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The number of data frames transmitted to the wireless media. The count includes one count for each data frame that was transmitted successfully (excluding retransmissions). Counter *TransmittedFramesToWirelessVoi ce 710.3.3. 8.2.3.6 (*WlanCounters 6) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The number of voice frames, including fax and redundant T.38 frames, transmitted to the wireless media. The count includes one count for each frame that was transmitted successfully (excluding retransmissions). Counter *TransmittedFramesToWirelessBea con 710.3.3. 8.2.3.7 (*WlanCounters 7) Applicable to AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The number of beacons transmitted to the wireless media. The count includes one count for each beacon that was transmitted successfully (excluding retransmission attempts). Counter *TotalSubmittedFrames 710.3.3. 8.2.3.8 (*WlanCounters 8) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The total number of data and RTP frames submitted to the bridge for transmission to the wireless media. The count does not include control and management frames, and retransmissions. Counter *SubmittedFramesHigh 710.3.3. 8.2.3.9 (*WlanCounters 9) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. Counts the number of frames submitted to the bridge via the High queue for transmission to the wireless media. When the ACSE Option is enabled, it counts data and RTP frames. When the ACSE Option is disabled, it counts only data frames. Counter *SubmittedFramesMid 710.3.3. 8.2.3.10 (*WlanCounters 10) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. Counts the number of frames submitted to the bridge via the Mid queue for transmission to the wireless media. When the ACSE Option is enabled, it counts data and RTP frames. When the ACSE Option is disabled, it counts only data frames. Counter BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-26 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *SubmittedFramesLow 710.3.3. 8.2.3.11 (*WlanCounters 11) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. Counts the number of frames submitted to the bridge via the Low queue for transmission to the wireless media. When the ACSE Option is enabled, it counts data and RTP frames. When the ACSE Option is disabled, it counts only data frames. Counter *SubmittedFramesVoice 710.3.3. 8.2.3.12 (*WlanCounters 12) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. Counts the number of voice frames, including fax and T.38 redundant frames, submitted to the bridge for transmission to the wireless media. Counter *FramesDroppedData 710.3.3. 8.2.3.13 (*WlanCounters 13) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The number of dropped data frames. The data frames that were retransmitted to the extent of the maximum allowed number of retransmissions for data frames without being acknowledged. Counter *FramesDroppedVoice 710.3.3. 8.2.3.14 (*WlanCounters 14) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The number of dropped voice frames, including fax and T.38 redundant frames. The voice frames that were retransmitted to the extent of the maximum allowed number of retransmissions for voice frames without being acknowledged. Counter *TotalRetransmittedFrames 710.3.3. 8.2.3.15 (*WlanCounters 15) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The total number of retransmissions of frames (counts all unsuccessful transmissions/ retransmissions). Counter *RetransmittedFramesData 710.3.3. 8.2.3.16 (*WlanCounters 16) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The total number of retransmissions of data frames (counts all unsuccessful transmissions/retransmissions). Counter *RetransmittedFramesVoice 710.3.3. 8.2.3.17 (*WlanCounters 17) Applicable to SU and AU only when the ACSE Option is enabled. Read-only. The total number of retransmissions of voice frames, including fax and T.38 redundant frames (counts all unsuccessful transmissions/retransmissions). Counter *TotalTxErrors 710.3.3. 8.2.3.19 (*WlanCounters 19) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred. Counter *TotalTxErrors 710.3.3. 8.2.3.20Hw (*WlanCounters 20) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred due to an hardware problem. Counter *TotalTxErrorsAbr 710.3.3. 8.2.3.21 (*WlanCounters 21) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because transmission has been aborted before completion due to internal problems in the DSP. Counter *TotalTxErrorsCsl 710.3.3. 8.2.3.22 (*WlanCounters 22) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because transmission was cancelled due to the modem being busy receiving data. Counter Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-27 Description Values/Range *TotalTxErrorsAckTOut 710.3.3. 8.2.3.23 (*WlanCounters 23) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because of an Acknowledge Timeout–a frame that was not acknowledged within the time defined by the Acknowledge Delay Limit parameter. Counter *TotalTxErrorsFail 710.3.3. 8.2.3.24 (*WlanCounters 24) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because of an internal timeout in the modem. Counter *TotalTxErrorsAckCrc 710.3.3. 8.2.3.25 (*WlanCounters 25) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because of a CRC error in the ACK message. Counter *TotalTxErrorsRtsc 710.3.3. 8.2.3.26 (*WlanCounters 26) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because RTS was sent but CTS was not received (RTS collision). Counter *TotalTxErrorsEod 710.3.3. 8.2.3.27 (*WlanCounters 27) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of transmit errors that have occurred because there was not enough time left to transmit the message prior to the end of the Dwell. Counter *TotalReceivedDataFrames 710.3.3. 8.2.3.28 (*WlanCounters 28) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The total number of data frames received from the wireless media, including duplicate frames. Counter *ReceivedDataFramesHigh 710.3.3. 8.2.3.29 (*WlanCounters 29) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The total number of data frames received from the wireless media and routed via the receive High queue, including duplicate frames. Counter *ReceivedDataFramesLow 710.3.3. 8.2.3.30 (*WlanCounters 30) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The total number of data frames received from the wireless media and routed via the receive Low queue, including duplicate frames. Counter *BadFragmentsReceived 710.3.3. 8.2.3.31 (*WlanCounters 31) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of frames received from the wireless media with errors (CRC errors). Counter *DuplicatedFramesDiscarded 710.3.3. 8.2.3.32 (*WlanCounters 32) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of frames discarded due to receiving multiple copies. Counter *InternallyDiscardedMirCir 710.3.3. 8.2.3.33 (*WlanCounters 33) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of data frames received from the Ethernet port that were discarded by the MIR/ CIR mechanism to avoid exceeding the maximum allowed information rate. Counter *TotalTxUnicastFramesToWireles 710.3.3. 8.2.3.34 (*WlanCounters 34) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only. The number of unicast frames successfully transmitted to the wireless media, excluding retransmissions. Counter *VoiceCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.4 (*TrafficStatistics 4) Applicable to SU with voice support only. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-28 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *VoiceTrafficTxFrames 710.3.3. 8.2.4.1 (*VoiceCounters 1) Applicable to SU with voice support only. Read-only. Counts the number of voice frames, including fax and T.38 redundant frames, that were transmitted to the wireless link. Counter *VoiceTrafficRxFrames 710.3.3. 8.2.4.2 (*VoiceCounters 2) Applicable to SU with voice support only. Read-only. Counts the number of voice frames, including fax and T.38 redundant frames, that were received from the wireless link. Counter *VoiceTrafficTxBytes 710.3.3. 8.2.4.3 (*VoiceCounters 3) Applicable to SU with voice support only. Read-only. Counts the number of voice bytes, including fax and T.38 redundant bytes, that were transmitted to the wireless link. Counter *VoiceTrafficRxBytes 710.3.3. 8.2.4.4 (*VoiceCounters 4) Applicable to SU with voice support only. Read-only. Counts the number of voice bytes, including fax and T.38 redundant bytes, that were received from the wireless link Counter *VoiceTrafficResetCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.4.5 (*VoiceCounters 5) Applicable to SU with voice support only. Reset the voice counters. noReset (0) reset (1) na (255) *PerRateCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.5 (*TrafficStatistics 5) Applicable to SU and AU. *ResetPerRateCounters 710.3.3. 8.2.5.1 (*PerRateCounters 1) Applicable to AU and SU. Resets the Per Rate Counters. *PerRateCountersSU 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2 (*PerRateCounters 2) SU Per Rate Counters. *TxFrames1M 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2.1 (*PerRateCountersSU 1) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted over the wireless link at 1Mbps. Counter *TxFrames2M 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2.2 (*PerRateCountersSU 2) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted over the wireless link at 2Mbps. Counter *TxFrames3M 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2.3 (*PerRateCountersSU 3) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted over the wireless link at 3Mbps. Counter *ReTxFrames1M 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2.4 (*PerRateCountersSU 4) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted over the wireless link at 1Mbps. Counter *ReTxFrames2M 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2.5 (*PerRateCountersSU 5) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted over the wireless link at 2Mbps. Counter *ReTxFrames3M 710.3.3. 8.2.5.2.6 (*PerRateCountersSU 6) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted over the wireless link at 3Mbps. Counter *AveragePower 710.3.3. 8.3.1 (*ReceivingUnits 1) Applicable to SU only. Read-only. Represents the average Signal Strength of received frames. DisplayString (SIZE(32)) *RssiOrDbm 710.3.3. 8.3.2 (*ReceivingUnits 2) Applicable to SU and AU. Selects the measurement units used to display the average received signal strength. Integer rssi (0) dBm (1) noReset (0) reset (1) na (255) *ReceivingUnits 710.3.3. 8.3 (*SiteSurvey 3) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-29 Description Values/Range *PerHopStatistics 710.3.3. 8.4 (*SiteSurvey 4) Applicable to SU and AU. *ResetPerHopStatistics 710.3.3. 8.4.1 (*PerHopStatistics 1) Applicable to SU and AU. Reset the Per Hop Statistics counters. *MacAddressDatabase 710.3.3. 8.5 (*SiteSurvey 5) Applicable to AU only. Database by MAC Addresses for all SUs associated with the AU. The databse include parameters learned by the AU from the SUs and some counters of wireless traffic between the AU and the relevant SU, as measured by the AU. *AdbResetAllCounters 710.3.3. 8.5.1 (*MacAddressDatabase 1) Applicable to AU only. To reset all the counters for all SUs in the MAC Address Database. This includes the following counters: *AdbTxFramesTotal *AdbTxFrames1M *AdbTxFrames2M *AdbTxFrames3M *AdbRTxFramesTotal *AdbRTxFrames1M *AdbRTxFrames2M *AdbRTxFrames3M *AdbTxDroppedFrames *AdbRxFramesTotal *AdbTable 710.3.3. 8.5.2 (*MacAddressDatabase 2) Applicable to AU Only. Not accessible. MAC Address Database table. *AdbEntry 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1 (*AdbTable 1) Applicable to AU Only. Not accessible. An entry in the MAC Address Database table. *AdbIndex 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.1 (*AdbEntry 1) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The index of an entry in the MAC Address Database table. Integer *AdbMacAddress 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.2 (*AdbEntry 2) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The MAC Address of an SU entry in the MAC Address Database table. MAC Address *AdbMaxRate 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.3 (*AdbEntry 3) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The value configured in the relevant SU for the Maximum Data Rate parameter. Integer 1, 2 or 3 (Mbps) *AdbCurrentTxRate 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.4 (*AdbEntry 4) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The current transmit rate to the SU. Integer 1, 2 or 3 (Mbps) *AdbTxFramesTotal 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.5 (*AdbEntry 5) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted to the SU over the wireless link. Counter *AdbTxFrames1M 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.6 (*AdbEntry 6) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted to the SU over the wireless link at 1Mbps. Counter *AdbTxFrames2M 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.7 (*AdbEntry 7) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted to the SU over the wireless link at 2Mbps. Counter *AdbTxFrames3M 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.8 (*AdbEntry 8) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames (excluding retransmissions) that were transmitted to the SU over the wireless link at 3Mbps. Counter *AdbRTxTotal 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.9 (*AdbEntry 9) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted to the SU over the wireless link. Counter Integer noReset (0) reset (1) noReset (0) reset (1) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-30 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *AdbRTx1M 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.10 (*AdbEntry 10) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted to the SU over the wireless link at 1Mbps. Counter *AdbRTx2M 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.11 (*AdbEntry 11) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted to the SU over the wireless link at 2Mbps. Counter *AdbRTx3M 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.12 (*AdbEntry 12) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were retransmitted to the SU over the wireless link at 3Mbps. Counter *AdbTxDroppedFrames 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.13 (*AdbEntry 13) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames intended to the SU that were dropped because they were retransmitted to the extent of the maximum allowed number of retransmissions without being acknowledged. Counter *AdbRxFramesTotal 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.14 (*AdbEntry 14) Applicable to AU Only. Read-only. Counts the total number of frames that were received from the SU over the wireless link. Counter *AdbCirTx 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.16 (*AdbEntry 16) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The value configured in the relevant SU for the CIR: SU to AU parameter. Integer 0-2200 (Kbps) *AdbMirTx 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.17 (*AdbEntry 17) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The value configured in the relevant SU for the MIR: SU to AU parameter. Integer 32-2200 (Kbps) *AdbCirRx 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.18 (*AdbEntry 18) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The value configured in the relevant SU for the CIR: AU to SU parameter. Integer 0-2200 (Kbps) *AdbMirRx 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.194 (*AdbEntry 19) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The value configured in the relevant SU for the MIR: AU to SU parameter. Integer 32-2200 (Kbps) *AdbCirMaxDelay 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.20 (*AdbEntry 20) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The value configured in the applicable SU for *MaxDelay parameter. Integer *AdbStatus 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.21 (*AdbEntry 21) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The status of the relevant SU. Integer associated (1) authenticated (2) notAuthenticated 3) *AdbSwVersion 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.22 (*AdbEntry 22) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The SW version of the relevant SU. DisplayString *AdbRssi 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.23 (*AdbEntry 23) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The average received signal level based on frames received by the AU from the relevant SU, in RSSI units. Integer *AdbDbm 710.3.3. 8.5.2.1.244 (*AdbEntry 24) Applicable to AU Only. Read only. The average received signal level based on frames received by the AU from the relevant SU, in dBm units. DisplayString *AtpcCounters 710.3.3. 8.6. (*SiteSurvey 6) ATPC Messages Counters. Applicable to IF based AU and to all SU units. *ResetAtpcCounters 710.3.3. 8.6.1 (*AtpcCounters 1) Resets the ATPC Counters. Manual Revision: 3.0 Integer noReset (0) reset (1) Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-31 Description Values/Range AtpcTransmittedMessages 710.3.3. 8.6.2 (*AtpcCounters 2) Applicable to IF based AU. The total number of ATPC messages transmitted by the unit since last reset. Integer AtpcReceivedMessages 710.3.3. 8.6.3 (*AtpcCounters 3) Applicable to SU units only. The number of ATPC messages received by the unit since last reset regardless of whether the unit supports ATPC. Integer *AUAlarms 710.3.3. 8.7 (*SiteSurvey 7) Applicable to IF-based AU only. AU Alarms parameters. *AUAlarmsOption 710.3.3. 8.7.1 (*AUAlarms 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Disable/enable the AU Alarms test mechanism. Integer disable (0) enable (1) *AUAlarmsLearningPeriod 710.3.3. 8.7.2 (*AUAlarms 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. The time period after reset or after enabling the AU Alarms Option that is dedicated to accumulating information only. During this period the AU does not activate alarms, except to the No Associations alarm. Integer 1 – 1440 (minutes) *AUAlarmsTestCycle 710.3.3. 8.7.3 (*AUAlarms 3) Applicable to IF-based AU only. The tine interval between two consecutive polling message transmissions. This is also the time interval used for calculating the current averages for the various traffic statistics. Integer 1 – 1440 (minutes) *AUAlarmsTrafficStatistics 710.3.3. 8.7.4 (*AUAlarms 4) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Traffic Statistics parameters. *TrafficStatisticsTable 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1 (*AUAlarmsTrafficStatistics 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Not accessible. AU Alarms Traffic Statistic Table containing traffic statistics parameters and test results. *TrafficStatisticsEntry 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1 (*TrafficStatisticsTable 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Not accessible. An entry in the AU Alarms Traffic Statistic Table. *TrafficStatisticsType 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1.1 (*TrafficStatisticsEntry 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The traffic statistics’ type of an entry in the AU Alarms Traffic Statistics Table. Serves also as the index of the entry. Integer retransmissionsRate (1) droppedFramesRate (2) crcErrorRate (3) duplicateFramesRate (4) *TrafficStatisticsCurrentRate 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1.2 (*TrafficStatisticsEntry 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The current rate calculated for the relevant statistics type. Integer 0 – 100 (%) na (255) *TrafficStatisticsAverageRate 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1.3 (*TrafficStatisticsEntry 3) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average rate calculated since the last time the unit was reset (or since the AU Alarms Option was enabled) for the relevant statistics type. Integer 0 – 100 (%) na (255) *MinorAlarmMinimumDelta 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1.4 (*TrafficStatisticsEntry 4) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-write. The minimum difference between the Traffic Statistics Current Rate and the Traffic Statistics Average Rate for activating a minor severity alarm for the relevant statistics type. Another prerequisite for activating the alarm is that the Traffic Statistics Current Rate exceeds the Traffic Statistics Minor Alarm Threshold. Integer 0 – 100 (%) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-32 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *MinorAlarmThreshold 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1.5 (*TrafficStatisticsEntry 5) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-write. The threshold for activating a minor severity alarm for the relevant statistics type. Another prerequisite for activating the alarm is that the difference between the Traffic Statistics Current Rate and the previous Traffic Statistics Average Rate exceeds the Traffic Statistics Minor Alarm Minimum Delta. Integer 1 – 100 (%) *MajorAlarmThreshold 710.3.3. 8.7.4.1.1.6 (*TrafficStatisticsEntry 6) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-write. The threshold for activating a major severity alarm for the relevant statistics type. Integer 1 – 100 (%) *AURxPowerTest 710.3.3. 8.7.5 (*AUAlarms 5) Applicable to IF-based AU only. AU Alarms AU Rx Power Tests parameters and measurement results. *AURxPowerAverageDelta 710.3.3. 8.7.5.1 (*AURxPowerTest 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average for all SUs that responded to the last two polling messages of the difference between the last RSSI at the AU and the previous (one before last) RSSI. (A negative value indicates that the average RSSI was decreased). DisplayString -99 to 99 (dBm) *AURxPowerDecreaseThreshold 710.3.3. 8.7.5.2 (*AURxPowerTest 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-write. The Minimum decrease in the value of the AU Rx Power Average Delta that will trigger an alarm. (If the AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold is +X, an alarm will be generated if the AU Rx Power Average Delta is smaller than or equal to –X) Integer 1 – 99 (dBm) *SURxPowerTest 710.3.3. 8.7.6 (*AUAlarms 6 Applicable to IF-based AU only. AU Alarms SU Rx Power Tests parameters and measurement results. *SURxPowerAverageDelta 710.3.3. 8.7.6.1 (*SURxPowerTest 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average for all SUs that responded to the last two polling messages of the difference between the last RSSI at the SU and the previous (one before last) RSSI. (A negative value indicates that the average RSSI was decreased). DisplayString -99 to 99 (dBm) *SURxPowerDecreaseThreshold 710.3.3. 8.7.6.2 (*SURxPowerTest 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-write. The Minimum decrease in the value of the SU Rx Power Average Delta that will trigger an alarm. (If the SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold is +X, an alarm will be generated if the SU Rx Power Average Delta is smaller than or equal to –X) Integer 1 – 99 (dBm) *RespondingSUs 710.3.3. 8.7.7 (*AUAlarms 7) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Responding SUs parameters. *CurrentNumberOfRespondingSUs 710.3.3. 8.7.7.1 (*RespondingSUs 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The number of SUs that responded to the last polling message. Integer na (255) *AverageNumberOfRespondingSU 710.3.3. 8.7.7.2 (*RespondingSUs 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average number of SUs that responded to polling message since power-up or since the AU Alarms Option was enabled. Integer na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-33 Integer 1 – 254 (SUs) *MinimumAverageNumberOfSUs 710.3.3. 8.7.7.3 (*RespondingSUs 3) Applicable to IF-based AU only. The minimum average number of SUs required for association tests *AUAlarmsStatus 710.3.3. 8.7.8 (*AUAlarms 8) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Alarms Status parameters. *AlarmsStatusTable 710.3.3. 8.7.8.1 (*AUAlarmsStatus 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Not accessible. AU Alarms Status Table containing the current status of each of the alarms. *AlarmsStatusEntry 710.3.3. 8.7.8.1.1 (*AlarmsStatusTable 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Not accessible. An entry in the AU Alarms Status Table. *AlarmType 710.3.3. 8.7.8.1.1.1 (*AlarmsStatusEntry 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read only. The alarm type of an entry in the AU Alarms Status Table. Serves also as the index of the entry. Integer noAssociations (1) allAssociationsLost (2) txPowerLevelDecrease (3) rxSignalStrengthDecrease (4) highRetransmissionsRate (5) highDroppedFramesRate (6) highCRCErrorRate (7) highDuplicateFramesRate (8) *AlarmStatus 710.3.3. 8.7.8.1.1.2 (*AlarmsStatusEntry 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read only. The status of the alarm of an entry in the AU Alarms Status Table. Serves also as the index of the entry. Integer off (0) minor (1) major (2) critical (3) *ClearAllAlarms 710.3.3. 8.7.8.2 (*AUAlarmsStatus 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-write. Perform set with value 'clearAllalarms' in order to clear all the alarms of the AU Alarms feature. Setting any value other than 'clearAllalarms' has no effect Integer cancelRequest (0) clearAllAlarms (1) Special Operations Parameters Note: Additional Special Operations parameters are reserved for factory use only. BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-34 Unit Control Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *UnitControl 710.3.3. 10 (brzAccessMib 10) *ResetUnit 710.3.3. 10.1 (*UnitControl 1) Applicable to all products. Resets the unit and applies new parameter values. Integer cancel (0) resetSystemNow (1) *SetDefaults 710.3.3. 10.2 (*UnitControl 2) Applicable to all products. Sets unit configuration to Defaults values after the next reset. completeFactory: All parameters revert to Factory Defaults values partialFactory: All parameters revert to Factory Defaults values, except the parameters required for maintaining wireless connectivity. completeOperator: All parameters revert to Operator Defaults values partialOperator: All parameters revert to Operator Defaults values, except the parameters required for maintaining wireless connectivity. Integer cancel (0) completeFactory (1) partialFactory (2) completeOperator (1) partialOperator (2) *UnitName 710.3.3. 10.3 (*UnitControl 3) Applicable to all products. The unit name. DisplayString (SIZE(32)) A string of up to 32 printable ASCII characters. *FlashMemoryControl 710.3.3. 10.4 (*UnitControl 4) Applicable to all products. Reset And Boot From Shadow Version: Activates the backup version. Use Current Version After Reset : The currently active version is activated after reset. Integer Cancel (0) resetAndBootFrom ShadowVersion (1) useCurrentVersion AfterReset (2) *ConsoleSpeed 710.3.3. 10.5 (*UnitControl 5) Applicable to all products. The communication speed of the Monitor port. Integer s9600bps (1) s19200bps (2) s38400bps (3) s57600bps (4) s115200bps (5) *MonitorLogoutTimer 710.3.3. 10.6 (*UnitControl 6) Applicable to all products. Time-out of management programs (Monitor, Telnet). Automatic exit if the program is inactive for the defined time. Integer 1-999 (minutes) *ReadOnlyPassword 710.3.3. 10.7.1 (*UnitPasswords 1) Applicable to all products. The User (read only) password. DisplayString (SIZE(8)). Up to 8 printable ASCII characters. *InstallerPassword 710.3.3. 10.7.2 (*UnitPasswords 2) Applicable to all products. The Installer password. DisplayString (SIZE(8)). Up to 8 printable ASCII characters. *AdminPassword 710.3.3. 10.7.3 (*UnitPasswords 3) Applicable to all products. The Administrator password. This is also the SNMP Write Community String. DisplayString (SIZE(8)). Up to 8 printable ASCII characters. *EventLog 710.3.3. 10.10 (*UnitControl 10) Applicable to all products. Event Log parameters *EventLogPolicy 710.3.3. 10.10.1 (*EventLog 1) Applicable to all products. Determines which events will be stored in the Event Log. Event from the configured level and higher are stored and can be displayed using the Monitor or by getting a the log file using TFTP. Integer logAll (1) message (2) warning (3) error (4) fatal (5) logNone (6) *NumberOfEventsInLogFile 710.3.3. 10.10.2 (*EventLog 2) Applicable to all products. Readonly. The number of events in the Event Log file. Integer *UnitPasswords 710.3.3. 10.7 (*UnitControl 7) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-35 Description Values/Range *EraseEventLog 710.3.3. 10.10.3 (*EventLog 3) Applicable to all products. Deletes all entries from the Event Log file. Integer cancel (0) erase (1) *SaveCurrentConfigurationAs OperatorDefaults 710.3.3. 10.12 (*UnitControl 12) Applicable to all products. Saves the current configuration as Operator Defaults. Integer cancel (0) saveAsDefaults (1) *ExitMonitorOrTelnet 710.3.3. 10.13 (*UnitControl 13) Applicable to all products. Exit the monitor program. Integer cancelOperation (0) exit (1) *AutoConfig 710.3.3. 10.14 (*UnitControl 14) Auto configuration Parameters *AutoConfigOption 710.3.3. 10.14.1 (*AutoConfig 1) Disable/enable the Auto Configuration feature Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *RequestAutoConfig 710.3.3. 10.14.2 (*AutoConfig 2) Initiate a request for an Auto Configuration file. Integer cancelRequest (0) request (1) *AutoConfigReceived 710.3.3. 10.14.3 (*AutoConfig 3) Indicates whether an Auto Configuration file was received. Integer notReceived (0) received (1) *SNMPReadESSID 710.3.3. 10.15 (*UnitControl 15) Applicable to AU and SU. Enables or disables viewing (get) the values of ESSID and RunTimeESSID with the SNMP Read Community string. Integer disable (1) enable (2) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-36 IP Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *IpParams 710.3.3. 11 (brzAccessMib 11) *UnitIpAddress 710.3.3. 11.1 (*IpParams 1) Applicable to all products. IP address of the unit. IP address *SubNetMask 710.3.3. 11.2 (*IpParams 2) Applicable to all products. Subnet mask of the unit. IP address *DefaultGWAddress 710.3.3. 11.3 (*IpParams 3) Applicable to all products. Default gateway IP address of the unit. IP address *UseDhcp 710.3.3. 11.4 (*IpParams 4) Applicable to all products. DHCP client mode of operation. disabled: Use regular (manual) methods to configure IP parameters. dHCP Only: Use DHCP server to configure IP parameters. automatic: Use DHCP server to configure IP parameters. If a DHCP server is not available, use configured values for *UnitIpAddress, *SubNetMask and *DefaultGWAddress. Integer disable (0) dHCPOnly (1) automatic (2) *RunIPaddr 710.3.3. 11.5 (*IpParams 5) Applicable to all products. Read-only: The run-time IP address. If DHCP is used the Run Time IP Address is the address given to the unit by the server. Otherwise it is the manualy configured address. IP address *RunSubNetMask 710.3.3. 11.6 (*IpParams 6) Applicable to all products. Read-only: The run-time Subnet Mask. If DHCP is used the Run Time Subnet Mask is the mask given to the unit by the server. Otherwise it is the manualy configured mask. IP address *RunDefaultIPGateway 710.3.3. 11.7 (*IpParams 7) Applicable to all products. Read-only: The run-time Gateway IP address. If DHCP is used the Run Time Gateway IP Address is the address given to the unit by the server. Otherwise it is the manualy configured address. IP address *AccessToDHCP 710.3.3. 11.8 (*IpParams 8) Applicable to all products. The port to be used for communicating with a DHCP server. (In GU only the fromEthernetOnly option is available). Integer fromWlanOnly(0) fromEthernetOnly(1) fromBoth(2) System Information Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *SysInfo 710.3.3. 13 (brzAccessMib 13) *UnitHwVersion 710.3.3. 13.1 (*SysInfo 1) Applicable to all products. Read-only: Hardware platform version. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *VoiceHwVersion 710.3.3. 13.2 (*SysInfo 2) Applicable only to SU with voice. Read-only: Voice hardware platform version. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *SoftwareVersion 710.3.3. 13.3 (*SysInfo 3) Applicable to all products. Read-only: Running software version. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *ShadowVersion 710.3.3. 13.4 (*SysInfo 4) Applicable to all products. Read-only: Shadow software version. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *SupportedMibVersion 710.3.3. 13.5 (*SysInfo 5) Applicable to all products. Read-only: The supported private MIB versions. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *UnitMacAddress 710.3.3. 13.6 (*SysInfo 6) Applicable to all products. Read-only, Unit hardware MAC address. MAC address Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-37 Description Values/Range *UnitType 710.3.3. 13.7 (*SysInfo 7) Applicable to all products. Read-only: Unit type. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *AssociatedAU 710.3.3. 13.8 (*SysInfo 8) Applicable to SU only. Read-only: Associated AU MAC address. MAC address *NumOfAssociationsSinceLastReset 710.3.3. 13.9 (*SysInfo 9) Applicable to AU and SU. Read-only: The number of associations since last reset, including duplicate associations (reassociations). Integer *FlashType 710.3.3. 13.10 (*SysInfo 10) Applicable to all products. Read-only: Flash memory type. Type S - Strata Flash. Type F – all other Flash types. DisplayString (SIZE(0..31)) *FlashSize 710.3.3. 13.11 (*SysInfo 11) Applicable to all products. Read-only: Flash size in Mb. Integer *SwVersionAfterReset 710.3.3. 13.12 (*SysInfo 12) Applicable to all products. Read-only: The software version to be used after next reset. DisplayString (SIZE(0..32)) *MaxPowerOutput 710.3.3. 13.13 (*SysInfo 13) Applicable to SU and AU. Read-only: The maximum output power to the antenna port. Integer na (255) *FrequencyDuplex 710.3.3. 13.14 (*SysInfo 14) Applicable to SU and AU in BreezeACCESS XL family only. Read-only: The frequency separation between uplink and downlink. Integer *UnitStatus 710.3.3. 13.15 (*SysInfo 15) Applicable to GU only. The status of the GPS antenna. DisplayString (SIZE(0..100)) *CurrentNumOfAssociations 710.3.3. 13.16 (*SysInfo 16) Applicable to AU only. Read-only. The number of subscriber units currently associated with the AU. Integer *CurrentNumOfVoiceSessions 710.3.3. 13.17 (*SysInfo 17) Applicable to AU only. Read-only. The number of voice sessions currently conducted by SUs served by the AU. Integer *ChannelSpacingApplicable 710.3.3. 13.18 (*SysInfo 18) Applicable to AU and SU in BreezeACCESS XL family only. Read-only. The applicability status of brzaccChannelSpacing Integer no (0) yes (1) *PowerLevelApplicable 710.3.3. 13.19 (*SysInfo 19) Applicable to AU-I and SU-I. Read-only. The applicability status of brzaccCurrentTxPwrLvl (for compliance with certain regulations it may be configured in the factory to low without the ability to change it to high). Integer no (0) yes (1) *GpsMasterOrSlaveStatus 710.3.3. 13.20 (*SysInfo 20) Applicable to GU only. Read-only. GPS Master/ Slave status indication. Integer master (1) slave (2) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-38 Alarms Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values/Range *Alarms 710.3.3. 20 (brzAccessMib 20) Alarms parameters *GpsAlarms 710.3.3. 20.1 (*Alarms 1) Applicable to GU only. GPS Alarms parameters. *AlarmInTable 710.3.3. 20.1.1 (*GpsAlarms 1) Applicable to GU only. Names and status of Alarms-In. Not accessible. *AlarmInTableEntry 710.3.3. 20.1.1.1 (*AlarmInTable 1) Applicable to GU only. An Alarms In table entry. Not accessible. *AlarmInIdx 710.3.3. 20.1.1.1.1 (*AlarmInTableEntry 1) Applicable to GU only. Read-only. Alarms In table index Integer 1-10 *AlarmInName 710.3.3. 20.1.1.1.2 (*AlarmInTableEntry 2) Applicable to GU only. Alarm In name. Alarms 1 to 4 can receive a name. The other are read-only. DisplayString (SIZE(0..31)) *AlarmInStatus 710.3.3. 20.1.1.1.3 (*AlarmInTableEntry 3) Applicable to GU only. Read-only. The status (off or on) of Alarm In entry. Integer off (0) on (1) na (255) *AlarmOutTable 710.3.3. 20.1.2 (*GpsAlarms 2) Applicable to GU only. Names, definition, control and status of Alarms-Out. Not accessible. *AlarmOutTableEntry 710.3.3. 20.1.2.1 (*AlarmOutTable 1) Applicable to GU only. An Alarms Out table entry. Not accessible. *AlarmOutIdx 710.3.3. 20.1.2.1.1 (*AlarmOutTableEntry 1) Applicable to GU only. Read-only. Alarms Out table index Integer 1-3 *AlarmOutName 710.3.3. 20.1.2.1.2 (*AlarmOutTableEntry 2) Applicable to GU only. Alarm Out name. The other are readonly. DisplayString (SIZE(0..31)) *AlarmOutDefinition 710.3.3. 20.1.2.1.3 (*AlarmOutTableEntry 3) Applicable to GU only. Enter an Alarm-In number to activate the Alarm-Out when this Alarm-In is ON. Enter A to activate the Alarm-Out if ANY of the Alarms-In are ON. Enter N for NONE (never activate the Alarm Out). DisplayString (SIZE(0..2)) 1-10, A, N *AlarmOutControl 710.3.3. 20.1.2.1.4 (*AlarmOutTableEntry 4) Applicable to GU only. Alarm out control: off (0) – turn alarm off. on (1) – turn alarm on. auto (2)-activate according to status of relevant alarm-in in accordance with Alarm Out Definition. Integer off (0) on (1) auto (2) na (255) *AlarmOutStatus 710.3.3. 20.1.2.1.5 (*AlarmOutTableEntry 5) Applicable to GU only. Read-only. The status (off or on) of Alarm Out entry. Integer off (0) on (1) na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-39 brzPhoneMIB (applicable to SU with voice only) breezecom OBJECT IDENTIFIER =1.3.6.1.4.1.710 {(iso(1) org(3) dod(6) internet(1) private(4) enterprises(1) breezecom(710)} breezecomPrvRev {breezecom 3} OBJECT IDENTIFIER = 1.3.6.1.4.1.710.3 brzPhoneMib {breezecomPrvRev 4 } OBJECT IDENTIFIER = 1.3.6.1.4.1.710.3.4 Note: * is used instead of the phon prefix Dialing Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values *DialingParams 710.3.4.1 (brzPhonMib 1) *PulseDialing 710.3.4.1.1 (*DialingParams 1) Enables/disables automatic pulse dialing detection. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *GateKeeperOption 710.3.4.1.2 (*DialingParams 2) Enables/disables communicating with the Gatekeeper for call management purposes. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *GkGwIpAddress 710.3.4.1.3 (*DialingParams 3) IP Address of the Gateway/ Gatekeeper The parameters must be specified if the [*GateKeeperOption] is enabled. IP address *MyTelephoneNumber 710.3.4.1.4 (*DialingParams 4) The telephone number as specified in the Gateway, if [*GateKeeperOption] is disabled. If the [*GateKeeperOption] is enabled the number is transmitted to the Gatekeeper. DisplayString (SIZE (0..10)) Up to 10 characters. 0 means no number *H323TerminalID 710.3.4.1.5 (*DialingParams 5) The H323 Terminal ID (name) to be used for calling the unit if the feature is enabled. Applicable only if the [*GateKeeperOption] is enabled. DisplayString (SIZE (0..25)) Up to 24 characters. X=NoID *IpDialingOption 710.3.4.1.8 (*DialingParams 8) Enables/disables dialing using IP addresses. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *IpDialingIndicator 710.3.4.1.9 (*DialingParams 9) Specifies the prefix used to identify an IP dialing string. DisplayString (SIZE (0..15)) Up to three telephone pad digits (0-9, A-D, *, #). X means no IP Dialing Indicator *AutomaticPrefix 710.3.4.1.10 (*DialingParams 10) Specifies a default prefix (number of Gateway trunk) to be automatically inserted before the dialed number. DisplayString (SIZE (0..15)) Up to eight telephone pad digits (0-9, A-D, *, #). X means no Automatic Prefix. *FastStart 710.3.4.1.13 (*DialingParams 13) Enables/disables the fast connect protocol. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-40 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values *InformTransferCap 710.3.4.1.14 (*DialingParams 14) Defines the value of the information transfer capability in the SETUP message. Integer speech (0) unrestricted (1) restricted (2) audio (3) unrestrictedTones (4) video (5) na (255) *DTMFRelay 710.3.4.1.15 (*DialingParams 15) Disable/enable DTMF Relay. 0 ñ Disable. DTMF is transferred inband. 1 ñ Enable. In-band DTMF is filtered. DTMF is relayed via H.245 session.In case of 'Fast Start' H.245 session will be forced upon DTMF detection. 2 - Enable Proprietary. In-band DTMF is filtered. In case of 'Fast Start' DTMF is relayed via Q.931 session. Otherwise DTMF is relayed via H.245 session. Integer disable (0) enable (1) enableProprietary (2) na (255) *DialingPrfxOption 710.3.4.1.16 ( (*DialingParams 16) Defines the Dialing Prefix Option for handling prefixes according to the dialing plan supported by the unit. disable (0): Insert Automatic Prefix (if defined). Otherwise forward as dialed. enable (1): Insert Automatic Prefix (if defined) only if first digit differs from *InterRegionalPrfx. Otherwise forward as dialed. enableBlockInterRegionalPrfx (2): Insert Automatic Prefix (if defined) only if first digit differs from *InterRegionalPrfx. Remove the first digit if it equals *InterRegionalPrfx and the second digit differs from *InterNationalPrfx. Otherwise forward as dialed. Integer disable (0) enable (1) enableBlockInterRegionalPrfx (2) na (255) *InterRegionalPrfx 710.3.4.1.17 (*DialingParams 17) To define the Inter Regional prefix to be handled according to the dialing plan supported by the unit. DisplayString (SIZE (0..1)) One phone keypad digit (0-9, A-D, *, #) or X. X means no Inter Regional Prefix is defined *InterNationalPrfx 710.3.4.1.18 (*DialingParams 18) To define the International prefix to be handled according to the dialing plan supported by the unit. DisplayString (SIZE (0..1)) One phone keypad digit (0-9, A-D, *, #) or X. X means no International Prefix is defined. *RegistrationTTL 710.3.4.1.19 (*DialingParams 19) To define the registration Time To Live. (timeToLive request in the RRQ message to the Gatekeeper). Integer 0 ñ 65535 *EndpointType 710.3.4.1.20 (*DialingParams 20) To define the EndpointType components in H.323 messages for interoperability with other equipment using H.323. Integer terminal (1) gateway (2) na (255) *FaxRelay 710.3.4.1.21 (*DialingParams 21) Disable/enable T.38 fax relay Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *FaxRelayRedundancy 710.3.4.1.22 (*DialingParams 22) Defines redundancy used for transmitting IFP messages Integer 0-5 na (255) *BatteryPolarity 710.3.4.1.23 (*DialingParams 23) To define the battery polarity for supporting an external device, e.g. for coins or tokens charging purpose. This feature is only available in units with voice card from Version D and up. Integer forward (1) reverse (2) forwardToReverse (3) reverseToForward (4) na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-41 Description Values *AlternateGkOption 710.3.4.1.24 (*DialingParams 24) Setting the Alternate Gatekeeper feature. EnableManualDiscovery: the Alternate Gatekeeper IP address is specified by the Alternate Gatekeeper IP Address parameter. EnableAutomaticDiscovery: the Alternate Gatekeeper IP address is received from the Primary GK. Integer disable (0) enableManualDiscovery (1) enableAutomaticDiscovery (2) na (255) *AlternateGkIPAddress 710.3.4.1.25 (*DialingParams 25) To set the Alternate Gatekeeper IP address when Alternate Gatekeeper Option is set to enableManualDiscovery. IP Address *CallerID 710.3.4.1.26 (*DialingParams 26) To defines whether the unit will support generation of Caller ID (CID) signaling and if CID is supported, which standard will be used. disable (0): No CID signalling etsiDtAs (1): CID signalling in accordance with ETSI 300-659-1, using Dual Tone Alerting Signal etsiRpAs (2): CID signalling in accordance with ETSI 300-659-1, using Ringing Pulse Alerting Signal etsiRinging (4): CID signalling in accordance with ETSI 300-659-1, transmitting data during the first long silence between two ring patterns. bellcoreMdmf (5): CID signaling in accordance with Bellcore 202, using Multiple Data Message Format (MDMF) which includes a name field in addition to the date, time and number. bellcoreSdmf (6): CID signaling in accordance with Bellcore 202, using Single Data Message Format (SDMF) which includes the date, time and number. Integer disable (0) etsi3006591DtAs (1) etsi3006591RpAs (2) etsi3006591Ringing (4) bellcore202Mdmf (5) bellcore202Sdmf (6) na (255) *StopDialingIndicator 710.3.4.1.27 (*DialingParams 28) To enable/disable the use of the # sign to indicate end of dialing disable: The # sign is interpreted as a part of the dialed sequence. End of dialing is determined by the *StopDialingTimeOut parameter. enable: The # sign is interpreted as indicating end of dialing sequence. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *StopDialingTimeOut 710.3.4.1.28 (*DialingParams 28) To define the inactivity time following the last dialed digit that will be identified by the unit as an indication to end of dialing. Integer 3 – 60 (seconds) na (255) *OverlapSending 710.3.4.1.29 (*DialingParams 29) Disable/enable overlap sending. When enabled, each dialed digit is transmitted immediately. When disabled, dialed digits are accumulated and transmitted according to the rules set by other dialing parameters. When enabled, it overrides the setting of other dialing parameters as follows: IP Dialing Option, Dialing Prefix Option and Stop Dialing Indicator are disabled even if the applicable parameter is set to Enable. Automatic Prefix is not used and Stop Dialing Timeout has no effect. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-42 Voice Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values *VoiceParams 710.3.4.2 (brzPhonMib 2) *VoiceVolume 710.3.4.2.1 (*VoiceParams 1) Gain of signal to earphone. Integer 0-20 (-dB) na (255) *EchoCancellation 710.3.4.2.3 (*VoiceParams 3) Enables or disables the echo cancellation feature. Integer disable (0) enable (1) na (255) *VoiceCodec 710.3.4.2.4 (*VoiceParams 4) The relative priority of voice codecs. DisplayString (SIZE (0..120)) A priorities vector of up to 7 different numbers in the range 1-7, where 1=G.723.1 2=G.729 3=G.711 uLaw 64k 4=G.711 Alaw 64k 5=G.729AnnexA 6= G.729wAnnexB 7= G.729AnnexAwAnnexB *VoiceActivityDetection 710.3.4.2.5 (*VoiceParams 5) Enables or disables the voice activity detection (VAD) feature when using G7231 codec. off (0) g7231 (1) na (255) *CompressionEfficiency 710.3.4.2.6 (*VoiceParams 6) Compression Efficiency parameters *G723FramesPerPacket 710.3.4.2.6.1 (*CompressionEfficiency 1) Number of G723.1 voice frames in an RTP packet. Integer 1-8 na (255) *G729FramesPerPacket 710.3.4.2.6.2 (*CompressionEfficiency 2) Number of G729A voice frames in an RTP packet. Integer 1-8 na (255) *G711uFramesPer Packet 710.3.4.2.6.3 (*CompressionEfficiency 3) Number of G11 u-Law voice frames in an RTP packet. Integer 1-16 na (255) *G711aFramesPerPacket 710.3.4.2.6.4 (*CompressionEfficiency 4) Number of G11 A-Law voice frames in an RTP packet. Integer 1-16 na (255) Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-43 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-44 MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values *MinimumFlashDetectTimeOut 710.3.4.3.3.1 (*TimeOuts 1) The minimum on-hook time for identifying it as a Hook Flash. Integer 0-2,000 (milliseconds) *MaximumFlashDetectTimeOut 710.3.4.3.3.2 (*TimeOuts 2) The maximum on-hook time for identifying it as a Hook Flash. Integer 0-2,000 (milliseconds) *DisconnectTimeOut 710.3.4.3.3.3 (*TimeOuts 3) The minimum time for decision on an onhook (disconnect) condition. Integer 0-2,000 (milliseconds) *InterDigitTimeOut 710.3.4.3.3.4 (*TimeOuts 4) Applicable only for pulse dialing. The minimum time between two consecutive pulses to be considered as separating between two digits. Integer 0-2,000 (milliseconds) *CalledPartyReleaseTimeOut 710.3.4.3.3.5 (*TimeOuts 5) The minimum time for an on-hook signal on the called party side to be considered as call disconnect. Integer 0-10,000 (milliseconds) General Info MIB MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description *GenInfo 710.3.4.9 (breezecomPrvRev 9) General Info MIB brzHoppingStandardProtected Applicable to AU and SU in BreezeACCESS II family. Read-only. Indicates if the Hopping Standard (Band) can be changed (if protected or not). Values Integer notProtected (1) protected (2) Supported Traps Note: * is used instead of the brzacc prefix Trap Associated Parameters MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) Description Values *Traps 710.3.3.14 (brzAccessMib 14) *TrapSUMacAddr 710.3.3.14.1 (*Traps 1) Applicable to AU only. SU MAC address. MAC address *TrapRssiQuality 710.3.3.14.2 (*Traps 2) Applicable to SU only. RSSI level of the received signal. Integer *TrapLastRssiQuality 710.3.3.14.3 (*Traps 3) Applicable to SU only. RSSI level of the received signal from the last AU with which the SU was associated. Integer *TrapText 710.3.3.14.4 (*Traps 4) Textual string for future use. DisplayString Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C MIB Parameter (Location in Parenthesis) C-45 Description Values *TrapToggle 710.3.3.14.5 (*Traps 5) An On/Off toggle status, indicating a change in status from off to on or vice versa. Integer on (1) off (2) *LastAUMacAddress 710.3.3.14.6 (*Traps 6) Applicable to SU only. The MAC address of the last AU with which the SU was associated. MAC address *TrapLog 710.3.3.14.7 (*Traps 7) Login or logout to the monitor program via the Monitor port or Telnet. Integer monitorLogin (1) monitorLogout(2) telnetLogin (3) telnetLogout (4) *TrapParameterChanged 710.3.3.14.8 (*Traps 8) A modification to one of the parameters related to CIR/ MIR, IP Filtering, Accounting (Billing) or VLAN . Integer cirOrMir (1) ipFilter (2) billing (3) vlan (4) *TrapAccessRights 710.3.3.14.9 (*Traps 9) The access rights used for login. Integer notLoggedIn (0) readOnly (1) installer (2) administrator (3) factory (4) *TrapTelnetUserIpAddress 710.3.3.14.11 (*Traps 11) The IP address of a Telnet user. IP address *TrapAlarmNumber 710.3.3.14.12 (*Traps 12) Applicable to GU only. The number of the alarm whose status has been changed. Integer 1-10 *TrapAlarmName 710.3.3.14.13 (*Traps 13) Applicable to GU only. The Name of the alarm whose status has been changed. DisplayString *TrapRTx 710.3.3.14.14 (*Traps 14) Applicable to AU only. Retransmissions as a percentage of total transmissions. Integer 0-100 *AUAlarmsTraps 710.3.3.14.15 (*Traps 15) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Not accessible. AU Alarms traps variables. *TrapAUAlarmSeverity 710.3.3.14.15.1 (*AUAlarmsTraps 1) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The severity of the alarm. Integer minor (1) major (2) critical (3) *TrapCurrentNumberOfRespondingSUs 710.3.3.14.15.2 (*AUAlarmsTraps 2) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The number of SUs that responded to the last polling message. Integer *TrapAverageNumberOfRespondingSUs 710.3.3.14.15.3 (*AUAlarmsTraps 3) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average number of SUs that responded polling message since power-up or since the AU Alarms Option was enabled. Integer *TrapSURxPowerAverageDelta 710.3.3.14.15.4 (*AUAlarmsTraps 4) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average for all SUs that responded to both of the last two polling messages of the difference between the last RSSI at the SU and the previous (one before last) RSSI. (A negative value indicates that the average RSSI was decreased). DisplayString -99 to 99 (dBm) *TrapAURxPowerAverageDelta 710.3.3.14.15.5 (*AUAlarmsTraps 5) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average for all SUs that responded to both of the last two polling messages of the difference between the last RSSI at the AU and the previous (one before last) RSSI. (A negative value indicates that the average RSSI was decreased). DisplayString -99 to 99 (dBm) *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate 710.3.3.14.15.6 (*AUAlarmsTraps 6) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The current rate calculated for the relevant statistics type. Integer 0-100 (%) na (255) *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate 710.3.3.14.15.7 (*AUAlarmsTraps 7) Applicable to IF-based AU only. Read-only. The average rate calculated since the last time the unit was reset (or since the AU Alarms Option was enabled) for the relevant statistics type. Integer 0-100 (%) na (255) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-46 Traps Trap (Number) Description Variables *SUassociatedAUTRAP(2) An AU trap indicating a new association with an SU. *TrapSUMacAddr *AUdisassociatedTRAP(3) An AU trap indicating that an SU has been disassociated from the AU. The AU decides that an SU has been disassociated from it and remove it from the ADB after receiving from another AU a SNAP frame with the SU MAC address. The SNAP frame indicating a network topology change where the SU has associated with another AU will be received if both AUs are connected to the same Ethernet backbone. *TrapSUMacAddr *AUagingTRAP (4) An AU trap indicating that an SU was aged out and removed from the ADB following its failure to acknowledge a certain number of consecutive frames transmitted to it. *TrapSUMacAddr *SUassociatedTRAP (6) An SU trap indicating association with an AU. In addition to the MAC address information of the AU, the trap also includes information on the average RSSI of frames received from the AU. *AssociatedAU *LastAUMacAddress *TrapRssiQuality *TrapLastRssiQuality *SUWirelessQualityTRAP(7) An SU trap, indicating that the quality of the wireless link has changed and dropped below (On) or has improved above (Off), defined by the *WirelessTrapThreshold. The threshold is in RSSI units. *TrapToggle *UnitMacAddress *TrapRssiQuality *AUWirelessQualityTRAP(20) An AU trap, indicating that the quality of the wireless link with a specific SU has changed and dropped below (On) or has improved above (Off) a threshold defined by *WirelessTrapThreshold. The threshold is a percents (retransmissions as percentage of total transmissions). *TrapToggle *TrapRTx *PowerUpFromReset (101) A trap indicating power up after Reset. *UnitMacAddr *AULossOfSyncTRAP (21) A BS-AU trap indicating that the AU has lost (alarm on) or regained (alarm off) synchronization. Applicable only to units in which the Hopping Sync is configured to slave operation. *TrapToggle *MonitorStatusTRAP (102) A trap indicating that a log-in or log-out has been performed via the Monitor port or Telnet. Includes the log-in access right and the IP address of the PC performing Telnet (if access is via Monitor the address is 0) *TrapLog *TrapAccessRights *TrapTelnetUserIpAddress *ParameterChangedTRAP(103) An AU or SU trap indicating a change in a CIR/MIR, IP Filter, Accounting (billing) or VLAN parameter. *TrapParameterChanged *GpsAlarmInTRAP (104) A GU trap indicating a change in alarmin status *brzaccTrapToggle *AlarmName *AlarmNumber *GpsAlarmOutTRAP (105) A GU trap indicating a change in alarmout status *brzaccTrapToggle *AlarmName *AlarmNumber *GpsUTCstatusTRAP (106) A GU trap indicating a change in UTC status. On status is when the GU module receives UTC information from the GPS antenna. This information is useful only if the GU receives also PPS signals from the GPS antenna, indicated by an on status of Alarm In 5 (GPS Antenna Alarm). *TrapToggle Manual Revision: 3.0 *UnitMacAddress Appendix C C-47 Trap (Number) Description Variables *NoAssociationsOnTRAP (201) An IF-based AU alarm. Alarm was set on: The AU was reset 3 consecutive times as a result of no association with any SU, and before that the AU was associated with at least Minimum Number Of SUs. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *NoAssociationsOffTRAP (202) Alarm was set off: At least one SU became associated with the AU. The alarm will be set off also after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *AllAssociationsLostOnTRAP (203) Alarm was set on: No response from any SU, and the previous average number of responding SUs was at least Minimum Number Of SUs. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapAverageNumberOfRespondingSUs *AllAssociationsLostOffTRAP (204) Alarm was set off: At least one SU responded to last polling messages. The alarm will be set off also after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *TrapCurrentNumberOfRespondingSUs *AUTxPowerLevelDecreaseOnTRAP(205) Alarm was set on: The decrease in the SU Rx Power Average Delta (the inverse value of the SU Rx Power Average Delta) is higher than the SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold, and the number of SUs that responded to both of the last two polling messages is at least 5. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapSURxPowerAverageDelta *AUTxPowerLevelDecreaseOffTRAP (206) The alarm will be set off after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *AURxSignalStrengthDecreaseOnTRAP(207) Alarm was set on: The decrease in the AU Rx Power Average Delta (the inverse value of the AU Rx Power Average Delta) is higher than the AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold, and the number of SUs that responded to both of the last two polling messages is at least 5. *AURxSignalStrengthDecreaseOffTRAP (208) The alarm will be set off after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapAURxPowerAverageDelta BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-48 Trap (Number) Description Variables *HighRetransmissionsRateOnTRAP (209) Alarm was set on: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The Retransmissions Current Rate exceeds the Retransmissions Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the Retransmissions Average Rate by at least Retransmissions Minor Alarm Minimum Delta. b. The Retransmissions Current Rate has dropped below the Retransmissions Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the Retransmissions Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Retransmissions Current Rate became higher than the Retransmissions Major Alarm Threshold. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate *HighRetransmissionsRateOffTRAP (210) Alarm was set off: Minor Severity Alarm: The Retransmissions Current Rate dropped below the Retransmissions Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Retransmissions Current Rate dropped below the Retransmissions Major Alarm Threshold. The alarm will be set off also after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate *HighDroppedFramesRateOnTRAP (211) Alarm was set on: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The Dropped Frames Current Rate exceeds the Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the Dropped Frames Average Rate by at least Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta. b. The Dropped Frames Current Rate has dropped below the Dropped Frames Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Dropped Frames Current Rate became higher than the Dropped Frames Major Alarm Threshold. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate *HighDroppedFramesRateOffTRAP (212) Alarm was set off: Minor Severity Alarm: The Dropped Frames Current Rate dropped below the Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Dropped Frames Current Rate dropped below the Dropped Frames Major Alarm Threshold. The alarm will be set off also after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix C C-49 Trap (Number) Description Variables *HighCRCErrorRateOnTRAP (213) Alarm was set on: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The CRC Error Current Rate exceeds the CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the CRC Error Average Rate by at least CRC Error Minor Alarm Minimum Delta. b. The CRC Error Current Rate has dropped below the CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The CRC Error Current Rate became higher than the CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate *HighCRCErrorRateOffTRAP (214) Alarm was set off: Minor Severity Alarm: The CRC Error Current Rate dropped below the CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The CRC Error Current Rate dropped below the CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold. The alarm will be set off also after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate *HighDuplicateFramesRateOnTRAP (215) Alarm was set on: Minor Severity Alarm: a. The Duplicate Frames Current Rate exceeds the Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold, and is higher than the Duplicate Frames Average Rate by at least Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta. b. The Duplicate Frames Current Rate has dropped below the Duplicate Frames Major Alarm Threshold but is still higher than the Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Duplicate Frames Current Rate became higher than the Duplicate Frames Major Alarm Threshold. *TrapAUAlarmsSeverity *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate *HighDuplicateFramesRateOffTRAP (216) Alarm was set off: Minor Severity Alarm: The Duplicate Frames Current Rate dropped below the Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold. Major Severity Alarm: The Duplicate Frames Current Rate dropped below the Duplicate Frames Major Alarm Threshold. The alarm will be set off also after activating Clear All Alarms or after disabling the AU Alarms Option. *TrapTrafficStatisticsCurrentRate *TrapTrafficStatisticsAverageRate BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual C-50 Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual Appendix D: RSSI to dBm Conversion Table SU-A/E, AU-A/E RSSI 71 72 74 75 77 78 81 82 83 84 85 86 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 110 111 112 113 dBM -100 -99 -98 -97 -96 -95 -94 -93 -92 -91 -90 -89 -88 -87 -86 -85 -84 -83 -82 -81 -80 -79 -78 -77 -76 -75 -74 -73 -72 -71 -70 -69 -68 -67 -66 -65 RSSI 114 115 116 118 119 120 121 122 123 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 141 142 143 144 145 146 148 149 150 151 152 153 dBM -64 -63 -62 -61 -60 -59 -58 -57 -56 -55 -54 -53 -52 -51 -50 -49 -48 -47 -46 -45 -44 -43 -42 -41 -40 -39 -38 -37 -36 -35 -34 -33 -32 -31 -30 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual D-2 SU-R and SU-I RSSI 26 27 29 30 32 33 35 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 50 51 53 54 56 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 74 75 77 78 Manual Revision: 3.0 dBM -100 -99 -98 -97 -96 -95 -94 -93 -92 -91 -90 -89 -88 -87 -86 -85 -84 -83 -82 -81 -80 -79 -78 -77 -76 -75 -74 -73 -72 -71 -70 -69 -68 -67 -66 -65 RSSI 81 82 83 84 85 86 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 118 119 dBM -64 -63 -62 -61 -60 -59 -58 -57 -56 -55 -54 -53 -52 -51 -50 -49 -48 -47 -46 -45 -44 -43 -42 -41 -40 -39 -38 -37 -36 -35 -34 -33 -32 -31 -30 Appendix E: Parameters List Unit Control Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default Run-Time Updated Change Unit Name All Up to 32 printable ASCII Empty String characters Yes Change Readonly Password All Up to 8 printable ASCII characters public Yes – For access from Monitor or Telnet only Change Installer Password All Up to 8 printable ASCII characters user Yes – For access from Monitor or Telnet only Change Administrator Password All Up to 8 printable ASCII characters private Yes – For access from Monitor or Telnet only Console Speed All 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 9600 No Log Out Timer All 1-999 minutes Yes Event Log Policy All Log All (TRC) Level, Message (MSG) Level, Warning (WRN) Level, Error (ERR) Level, Fatal (FTL) Level, Log None Fatal (FTL) Level Yes Auto Configuration Option All Disable, Enable Disable Yes SNMP Read EESSID AU, SU Disable, Enable Disable No BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-2 Site Survey Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated RSSI Display Option AU, SU RSSI, dBm RSSI Yes AU Alarms Option IF-based AU Disable, Enable Disable Yes Learning Period IF-based AU 1 – 1440 (minutes) 30 (minutes) Yes Test Cycle IF-based AU 1 – 1440 (minutes) 10 (minutes) Yes Retransmissions Minor Alarm Minimum Delta IF-based AU 0 – 100 (%) 20 (%) Yes Retransmissions Minor Alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 30 (%) Yes Retransmissions Major Alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 60 (%) Yes Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta IF-based AU 0 – 100 (%) 10 (%) Yes Dropped Frames Minor Alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 10 (%) Yes Dropped Frames Major alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 20 (%) Yes CRC Error Minor Alarm Minimum Delta IF-based AU 0 – 100 (%) 20 (%) Yes CRC Error Minor Alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 40 (%) Yes CRC Error Major Alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 70 (%) Yes Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-3 Range Default RunTime Updated Parameter Unit Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Minimum Delta IF-based AU 0 – 100 (%) 5 (%) Yes Duplicate Frames Minor Alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 5 (%) Yes Duplicate Frames Major alarm Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 100 (%) 15 (%) Yes SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 99 (dBm) 15 (dBm) Yes AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold IF-based AU 1 – 99 (dBm) 15 (dBm) Yes Minimum Number Of SUs IF-based AU 1 – 254 (SUs) 5 (SUs) Yes IP Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated IP Address All IP address 10.0.0.1 No Subnet Mask All IP address 255.0.0.0 No Default Gateway All Address IP address 0.0.0.0 No DHCP Option Disable, DHCP Only, Automatic Disable No From Wlan Only, From Ethernet Only, From Both Ethernet & Wlan AU: From No Ethernet Only SU: From Wlan Only All Access to DHCP AU, SU BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-4 Air Interface Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default Run-Time Updated ESSID AU, SU Up to 31 printable ASCII characters ESSID1 No Operator ESSID Option AU Disable, Enable Enable No Operator ESSID AU Up to 31 printable ASCII characters ESSID1 No Hopping Sequence AU Depends on hopping standard No Hopping Set AU 1-3 No AU, SU Hopping Sync AU Idle, Master, Slave Idle No Best AU Support SU Disable, Enable Disable No Number of Scanning Attempts SU 1 – 255 20 Yes MAC Address 00-00-00-00-00-00 (no Yes preferred AU) Preferred AU MAC SU Address Transmit Power Control AU-A/E, 0 – 15 SU-A/E (IF based units) 15 Yes Power Level SU-R, SU-I/ Low, High AU-I units with HW version C or lower High No Transmit Antenna SU-R SU-I/AU-I Use Antenna Number No Manual Revision: 3.0 Use Two Antennas, Use Antenna No. 1, Use Antenna No. 2 Appendix E E-5 Parameter Unit Range Receive SU-A/E (IF 0, 10dB, 25dB Attenuation Control based units) Default Run-Time Updated No Maximum Data Rate AU, SU 1, 2 and 3Mbps 3Mbps No AU Transmission Rate Control SU Disable, Enable No Acknowledge Delay Limit AU, SU Low, Medium, Low High No Maximum Number of Associations AU 1 – 512 Yes Call Aging Time AU 1 (no aging), 2- 1800 seconds 50,000 (seconds) No Maximum Voice Sessions AU 0 – 50 12 Yes ACSE Option AU and GU Disable, Enable Disable No ACSE Maximum Voice Sessions AU 0 – 21 21 Yes ACSE Number Of Retransmissions For Data AU, SU 0 – 100 No ACSE Number Of Retransmissions For Voice AU, SU with voice 0 – 100 30 No ATPC Option IF Based AU, SU Disable, Enable AU: Disable SU: Enable Yes Maximum RSSI Level IF Based AU -100 to 0 (dBm) -64 (dBm) Minimum RSSI Level IF Based AU -100 to 0 (dBm) Minimum Interval Between ATPC Messages IF Based AU 0-3600 (seconds) 120 (seconds) Yes RSSI Memory Factor IF Based AU -1 to 32 Yes ATPC Power Level IF Based Steps AU 1-100 (%) Yes ATPC Maximum Last Level Time After Reset 0-3600 (seconds) 30 (seconds) Yes SU Disable 512 Yes Yes -74 (dBm) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-6 Parameter Unit Range Default ATPC Maximum Last Level Time After Synchronization Loss SU 0-3600 (seconds) Scanning Mode SU Active, Passive Active MAC Address Black List AU Send Roaming SNAP All SUs, except SU-BD, SU-BD1V Disable, Enable Wireless Trap Threshold AU, SU AU: 0 to 100 % AU: 30 % SU: 0 to 255 IF based SU: 95 RSSI units SU-R: 48 SU-I: 60 Manual Revision: 3.0 120 (seconds) Run-Time Updated Yes No Empty List Yes SU-R: Enable All others: Disable. No Yes Appendix E E-7 Network Management Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Access To Network Management AU, SU From Wlan Only, From Ethernet Only, From Both Ethernet & Wlan From Both Ethernet & Wlan No Network Management Filtering All Disable, Activate Management IP Filter On Ethernet Port, Activate Management IP Filter On Wlan Port (not available in GU), Activate Management IP Filter On Both Ethernet & Wlan Ports (not available in GU), Disable No Set Network Management IP Address All IP address 0.0.0.0 (all 3 entries) Yes Send SNMP Traps All Disable Traps Sending, Enable Traps Sending Disable Traps Sending Yes SNPM Traps IP Destination All IP address 0.0.0.0 (all 3 entries) No SNMP Traps Community All Up to 14 printable ASCII characters public (all 3 entries) No Send SU Associated AU Trap AU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send AU Disassociated Trap AU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send AU Aging Trap AU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send AU Wireless Quality Trap AU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send SU Associated Trap SU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-8 Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Send SU Wireless Quality Trap SU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send Parameter Changed Trap AU, SU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send GPS Alarm GU In Trap Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send GPS Alarm GU Out Trap Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send GPS UTC Status Trap GU Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send Power Up From Reset Trap All Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending AU & GU: Enable Trap Sending SU: Disable Trap Sending Yes Send Monitor Status Trap All Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send Cold \ Warm Start Trap All Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending AU & GU: Enable Trap Sending. SU: Disable Trap Sending Yes Send AU Loss Of BS-AU Sync Trap Disable Trap Sending, Enable Trap Sending Enable Trap Sending Yes Send AU Alarms IF-based AU Traps Disable Traps Sending, Enable Traps Sending Enable Traps Sending Yes Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-9 Bridge Parameters Parameter Unit VLAN ID-Data SU VLAN ID – Management Range 1 – 4094 Default Run-Time Updated No AU, GU, 1 – 4094, 65535 SU without voice 65535 (no VLAN) No VLAN ID – Voice & Management SU with voice 1 – 4094, 65535 65535 (no VLAN) No VLAN Link Type AU, SU Hybrid Link, Trunk Link, Access Link (only in SU) Hybrid Link No Voice Priority Tag Option SU with voice Disable, Enable Disable No VLAN Forwarding Support AU, SU Disable, Enable Disable No VLAN Forwarding ID AU, SU 1 – 4094 (up to 20 entries) Empty list No VLAN Relaying Support AU Disable, Enable Disable No VLAN Relaying ID AU 1 – 4094 (up to 20 entries) Empty list No VLAN Priority – Data AU, SU 0–7 No VLAN Priority – Voice SU with voice 0–7 Yes VLAN Priority – Management AU, SU, GU 0–7 SU with voice: 4 No All other units: 0 VLAN Priority Threshold AU, SU 0–7 Yes Voice Packets ToS SU with voice 0 – 255 Yes ToS Precedence Threshold AU, SU 0–7 Yes Filter Option SU Disable, From Ethernet Only, From Wlan Only, Both From Ethernet & Wlan Disable Yes DHCP Broadcast Override Filter SU Disable, Enable Disable Yes BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-10 Parameter Unit Range Default Run-Time Updated PPPoE Broadcast Override Filter SU Disable, Enable Disable Yes Parameter Unit Range Default Run-Time Updated ARP Broadcast Override Filter SU Disable, Enable Disable Yes LAN to WLAN Bridging Mode AU Reject Unknown, Forward Unknown Forward Unknown Yes Bridge Aging Time AU, SU 100 – 2000 seconds AU, SU-BD, SU-BD1V: 300 All other SUs: 1800 No Broadcast Relaying AU Disable, Enable Enable No Unicast Relaying AU Disable, Enable Enable No Ethernet Port Control SU Disable, Enable Enable No Voice Port Control SU with voice Disable, Enable Enable No Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-11 Performance Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default Run-Time Updated RTS Threshold AU, SU 20 – 1600 bytes AU: 1600 SU: 60 No Number of Retransmissions AU, SU 1 – 100 No Number of Retransmissions to Decrease Rate AU, SU 0 – 10 No Number of Dwells to Retransmit AU, SU 0–9 No Minimum Contention Window AU, SU 7 - 255 31 No Carrier Sense Level AU, SU -100 to -40 (dBm) -85 dBm No Maximum Multicast Rate AU 1, 2, 3Mbps 1Mbps Yes Multi-Rate Support AU, SU Disable, Enable Enable No Multi-Rate Decision Window Size AU, SU 1 – 50 12 No Number of AU, SU Failures in MultiRate Decision Window 1 to Multi-Rate Decision window Size No Dwell Time AU and GU 32, 64, 128 128 No Noise Floor AU, SU -115 to -50 (dBm) IF-based units: 112(dBm) SU-R: -101(dBm) SU-I/AU-I:-97(dBm) No Carrier To Interference Difference Level AU, SU 6 to 60 (dB) IF-based units: 8(dB) SU-R, SU-I, AU-I: 9(dB) No BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-12 Service Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated User Filtering Option SU Disable, IP Only, User Defined Addresses Only, PPPoE Protocol Only Disable Yes Set User Filter Address SU IP address (8 entries) 0.0.0.0 (all 8 entries) Yes Set User Filter Mask SU IP address (8 entries) 255.255.255.25 5 (all 8 entries) Yes Set User Filter Range SU 0 - 255 0 (all 8 entries) Yes MIR/CIR Option AU, SU Disable, Enable Disable No MIR: AU to SU SU 32 – 2200Kbps 128Kbps No MIR: SU to AU SU 32 – 2200Kbps 128Kbps No CIR: AU to SU SU 0 – 2200Kbps 64Kbps No CIR: SU to AU SU 0 – 2200Kbps 64Kbps No Maximum Burst Duration AU, SU 0 – 2000 milliseconds 5 milliseconds No Maximum Delay SU 300 – 10,000 milliseconds 5,000 milliseconds No Graceful Degradation Limit AU 0 – 70 (%) 70 (%) No Disable, Enable Disable Yes MIR Only Option AU Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-13 RADIUS Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated User Name SU Up to 64 printable ASCII characters The units’ MAC Address No User Password SU Up to 64 printable ASCII characters RadiusPassword1 No Shared Secret SU Up to 20 characters RadiusSecret1234 No Authentication Option SU Disable, enable Disable No RADIUS Server SU Authentication IP Address IP Address 0.0.0.0 No RADIUS Server Authentication Port SU 1000 to 65535 1812 No Accounting Option SU Disable, enable Disable No RADIUS Server Accounting IP Address SU IP Address 0.0.0.0 No RADIUS Server Accounting Port SU 1000 to 65535 1813 No Accounting Interval SU 60 to 6000 (seconds) 90 (seconds) No Security Parameters Range Default Run-Time Updated Parameter Unit Authentication Algorithm AU, SU Open System, Shared Key Support All (AU only) Open System No Default Key ID SU 1–4 Yes WEP Key # 1-4 AU, SU 10 Hexadecimal Digits 0000000000 (no No key) BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-14 Voice Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default Run-Time Updated Volume SU with voice -20 to 0 (dB) -3dB Yes Echo Cancellation SU with voice Disable, Enable Enable Yes Voice Codec SU with voice 1 – 7654321 (use only the digits 1 – 7) 2134 No G723 Frames Per SU with Packet voice 1–8 No G729 Frames Per SU with Packet voice 1 – 12 No G711 u-Law Frames Per Packet SU with voice 1 – 16 12 No G729 Frames Per SU with Packet voice 1 – 16 12 No Voice Activity Detection Voice Activity Detection OFF, Voice Activity Detection G7231 Voice Activity Detection OFF No SU with voice Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-15 Dialing Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Pulse Dialing SU with voice Disable, Enable Enable No Gatekeeper Option SU with voice Disable, Enable Disable No Gatekeeper / Gateway IP Address SU with voice IP address 0.0.0.0 No Alternate Gatekeeper Option SU with voice Disable, Enable Disable No Alternate Gatekeeper IP Address SU with voice IP address 0.0.0.0 No Telephone Number SU with voice Up to 10 decimal digits 0000000000 No H323 Terminal ID SU with voice Up to 24 characters X (No terminal ID) No IP Dialing Option SU with voice Disable, Enable Enable Yes IP Dialing Indicator SU with voice up to 3 phone key-pad digits (0-9, *, #, A, B, C, D) Yes Automatic Prefix SU with voice up to 8 phone key-pad digits (0-9, *, #, A, B, C, D) X (No prefix) Yes Fast Start SU with voice Disable, Enable Enable Yes Information Transfer Capability SU with voice Speech, Unrestricted, Restricted, 3.1KHz audio, Unrestricted with tones, Video Speech No Dialing Prefix Option SU with voice Disable, Enable, Enable & Disable Block Inter-Regional Prefix Yes Inter-Regional Prefix SU with voice One phone key-pad digit (0-9, *, #, A, B, C, D) and X (no prefix). Yes BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-16 Parameter International Prefix Unit SU with voice Range Default RunTime Updated One phone key-pad digit (0-9, *, #, A, B, C, D) and X (no prefix). Yes Registration TTL SU with voice 0 (not active), 1 – 65535 No DTMF Relay SU with voice Disable, Enable, Enable Proprietary Enable No Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Endpoint Type SU with voice Terminal, Gateway Terminal No Fax Relay Option SU with voice Disable, Enable Disable No Fax Relay redundancy SU with voice 0–5 No Batter Polarity SU with voice (Voice card rev. D and higher) Forward Battery, Forward Battery No Reverse Battery, Forward->Reverse Battery, Reverse->Forward Battery Caller ID SU with voice (Voice card rev. D and higher) Disable, ETSI 300659-1 DT-AS, ETSI 300659-1 RP-AS, ETSI 300659-1 Ringing, Bellcore 202 MDMF, Bellcore 202 SDMF Disable Yes Stop dialing Timeout SU with voice 3 – 60 seconds 5 seconds Yes Stop Dialing Indicator SU with voice Disable, Enable Disable Yes Overlap Sending SU with voice Disable, Enable Disable No Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-17 Telephony Signals Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Telephony SU with Country Standard voice Proprietary, Germany, Sweden, France, United Kingdom, Belgium, USA, Chile USA No Frequency 1 SU with voice 0 – 3000Hz Dial Tone: 350 No Ring Back: 440 Busy: 480 Congestion: 480 Error: 480 High Level Error: 20 Frequency 1 SU with voice 0 – 3000Hz Dial Tone: 350 No Ring Back: 440 Busy: 480 Congestion: 480 Error: 480 High Level Error: 0 Ring Frequency: 20 Level 1 SU with voice -32 to +3 (dBm) Dial Tone: -13 No Ring Back: -19 Busy: -14 Congestion: -24 Error: -24 High Level Error: 0 Ring Frequency: Null Level 2 SU with voice -32 to +3 (dBm) Dial Tone: -13 No Ring Back: -19 Busy: -14 Congestion: -24 Error: -24 High Level Error: 0 Ring Frequency: Null BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-18 Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Cadence On SU with voice 100-10,000 milliseconds Dial Tone: Ring Back: 1000 Busy: 500 Congestion: 1000 Error: 200 High Level Error: 0 Ring Frequency: 1000 Parameter Unit Range Default Yes Cadence Off SU with voice 100-10,000 milliseconds Dial Tone: Ring Back: 3000 Busy: 500 Congestion: 1000 Error: 200 High Level Error: 0 Ring Frequency: 3000 No Duration SU with voice 0 – 10,000 seconds Dial Tone: 15 Ring Back: 60 Busy: 15 Congestion: 0 Error: 0 High Level Error: 0 Ring Frequency: 60 No Min. Flash Detect SU with Timeout voice 0-2,000 milliseconds 120 No Max. Flash Detect Timeout SU with voice 0-2,000 milliseconds 1000 No Disconnect Timeout SU with voice 0-2,000 milliseconds 1000 No Inter-Digit Timeout SU with voice 0-2,000 milliseconds 100 No Called Party Release Timeout SU with voice 0-10,000 milliseconds No Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix E E-19 Hopping Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Number of Hopping Frequencies GU 2-151 No Automatic Recovery Option GU Disable, Enable Enable Yes Automatic Recovery Interval GU 5 – 1440 (minutes) 15 (minutes) Yes ACSE Option AU and GU Disable, Enable Disable No Dwell Time AU and GU 32, 64, 128 128 No Alarm Parameters Parameter Unit Range Default RunTime Updated Alarm In Names GU Up to 31 printable ASCII Alarm In 1 characters through Alarm In 4 Yes Alarm Out Names GU Up to 31 printable ASCII Alarm Out 1 characters through Alarm Out 3 Yes Automatic Alarm Out Definition GU 1 -10, N (None), A (Any) N (None) for all Yes 3 Alarm Outs Alarm Out Control GU On, Off, Automatic Automatic – for Yes all 3 Alarm Outs BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual E-20 Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual Appendix F: Hopping Sequences Hopping Standard: Australia Each hopping sequence is comprised of 60 channels in the frequency band from 2402 MHz to 2461 MHz (channels 2 to 80). Basic Hopping Sequence: Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence = 1 Index Channel Index Channel Index Channel 21 29 41 39 53 22 42 47 19 23 31 43 56 58 24 17 44 12 16 25 30 45 32 50 26 22 46 38 13 27 47 27 34 28 43 48 11 23 29 61 49 26 10 15 30 41 50 40 11 46 31 24 51 33 12 37 32 14 52 25 13 48 33 42 53 54 14 55 34 35 54 36 15 20 35 55 21 16 60 36 18 56 10 17 52 37 28 57 18 38 51 58 44 19 49 39 57 59 20 59 40 60 45 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual F-2 Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel) MHz Calculating the operational hopping sequence: IF [Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)]>61, than Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)-60, else Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-20 i =Index. Range: 1-60 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. Pi(1, 1) = Channel with index i in the basic sequence (Hopping Set 1, Hopping sequence 1). Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix F F-3 Hopping Standards: Canada, Mexico Each hopping sequence is comprised of 30 channels in the frequency band from 2452 MHz to 2481 MHz (channels 2 to 80). Basic Hopping Sequence: Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence = 1 Index Channel Index Channel 52 16 70 58 17 81 72 18 62 80 19 73 63 20 60 76 21 66 53 22 56 67 23 78 54 24 65 10 64 25 75 11 79 26 55 12 71 27 69 13 59 28 77 14 74 29 68 15 61 30 57 Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz Calculating the operational hopping sequence: IF [Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)]>81, than Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)-30, else Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-10 i =Index. Range: 1-30 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. Pi(1, 1) = Channel with index i in the basic sequence (Hopping Set 1, Hopping sequence 1). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual F-4 Hopping Standards: Europe ETSI, US FCC, International Each hopping sequence is comprised of 79 channels in the frequency band from 2402 MHz to 2480 MHz (channels 2 to 80). Basic Hopping Sequence: Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence = 1 Index Channel Index Channel Index Channel 28 54 41 25 29 39 55 15 64 30 12 56 35 10 31 36 57 67 45 32 68 58 52 18 33 59 58 73 34 70 60 49 35 77 61 50 21 36 62 17 10 63 37 62 63 11 78 38 29 64 19 12 31 39 14 65 13 61 40 27 66 69 14 24 41 16 67 51 15 54 42 59 68 42 16 65 43 43 69 17 28 44 76 70 30 18 79 45 34 71 57 19 33 46 72 72 37 20 47 11 73 55 21 20 48 60 74 26 22 13 49 80 75 46 23 38 50 47 76 53 24 74 51 22 77 40 25 56 52 75 78 32 26 71 53 66 79 48 27 23 Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix F F-5 Calculating the operational hopping sequence: IF [Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)]>80, than Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)-79, else Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-26 i =Index. Range: 1-79 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. Pi(1, 1) = Channel with index i in the basic sequence (Hopping Set 1, Hopping sequence 1). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual F-6 Hopping Standards: France Each hopping sequence is comprised of 35 channels in the frequency band from 2448 MHz to 2482 MHz (channels 28 to 82). Basic Hopping Sequence: Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence = 1 Index Channel Index Channel 65 19 76 53 20 62 66 21 73 80 22 48 71 23 56 55 24 49 64 25 63 52 26 51 61 27 59 10 81 28 78 11 74 29 72 12 58 30 57 13 79 31 75 14 68 32 67 15 77 33 50 16 70 34 69 17 60 35 82 18 54 Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz Calculating the operational hopping sequence: IF [Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)]>82, than Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)-35, else Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1), where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-11 i =Index. Range: 1-35 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. Pi(1, 1) = Channel with index i in the basic sequence (Hopping Set 1, Hopping sequence 1). Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix F F-7 Hopping Standards: Israel Each hopping sequence is comprised of 35 channels in the frequency band from 2421 MHz to 2455 MHz (channels 21 to 55). Basic Hopping Sequence: Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence = 1 Index Channel Index Channel 38 19 49 26 20 35 39 21 46 53 22 21 44 23 29 28 24 22 37 25 36 25 26 24 34 27 32 10 54 28 51 11 47 29 45 12 31 30 30 13 52 31 48 14 41 32 40 15 50 33 23 16 43 34 42 17 33 35 55 Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz Calculating the operational hopping sequence: IF [Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)]>55, than Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)-35, else Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-11 i =Index. Range: 1-35 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. Pi(1, 1) = Channel with index i in the basic sequence (Hopping Set 1, Hopping sequence 1). BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual F-8 Hopping Standards: Japan Each hopping sequence is comprised of 23 channels in the frequency band from 2473 MHz to 2495 MHz (channels 73 to 95). Calculating the operational hopping sequence: Step Size D is defined as D(H, S) = 6 + (S-1) x 3 + (H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-4 D(H, S) = Step Size for Hopping Set H and Hopping Sequence S. Channel calculation: Pi(H, S) = [(i-1) x D (H, S)]modulu23 + 73 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. I = index. Range: 1-23 Example: H=1, S=3 Step Size Calculation: D (1, 3) = 6 + (3-1) x 3 + (1-1) = 12 Hopping sequence channels calculation: P1(1, 3) = [(1-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 0 mod23 + 73 = 0 + 73 = 73 P2(1, 3) = [(2-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 12 mod23 + 73 = 12 + 73 = 85 P3(1, 3) = [(3-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 24 mod23 + 73 = 1 + 73 = 74 P4(1, 3) = [(4-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 36 mod23 + 73 = 13 + 73 = 86 P5(1, 3) = [(5-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 48 mod23 + 73 = 2 + 73 = 75 P6(1, 3) = [(6-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 60 mod23 + 73 = 14 + 73 = 87 P7(1, 3) = [(7-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 72 mod23 + 73 = 3 + 73 = 76 P8(1, 3) = [(8-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 84 mod23 + 73 = 15 + 73 = 88 P9(1, 3) = [(9-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 96 mod23 + 73 = 4 + 73 = 77 P10(1, 3) = [(10-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 108 mod23 + 73 = 16 + 73 = 89 P11(1, 3) = [(11-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 120 mod23 + 73 = 5 + 73 = 78 P12(1, 3) = [(12-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 132 mod23 + 73 = 17 + 73 = 90 P13(1, 3) = [(13-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 144 mod23 + 73 = 6 + 73 = 79 P14(1, 3) = [(14-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 156 mod23 + 73 = 18 + 73 = 91 P15(1, 3) = [(15-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 168 mod23 + 73 = 7 + 73 = 80 P16(1, 3) = [(16-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 180 mod23 + 73 = 19 + 73 = 92 Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix F F-9 P17(1, 3) = [(17-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 192 mod23 + 73 = 8 + 73 = 81 P18(1, 3) = [(18-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 204 mod23 + 73 = 20 + 73 = 93 P19(1, 3) = [(19-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 216 mod23 + 73 = 9 + 73 = 82 P20(1, 3) = [(20-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 228 mod23 + 73 = 21 + 73 = 94 P21(1, 3) = [(21-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 240 mod23 + 73 = 10 + 73 = 83 P22(1, 3) = [(22-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 252 mod23 + 73 = 22 + 73 = 95 P23(1, 3) = [(23-1) x 12]mod23 + 73 = 264 mod23 + 73 = 11 + 73 = 84 Hopping sequence channels for Hopping Sequence 3 in Hopping Set 1: 73, 85, 74, 86, 75, 87, 76, 88, 77, 89, 78, 90, 79, 91, 80, 92, 81, 93, 82, 94, 83, 95, 84. Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual F-10 Hopping Standards: Korea Each hopping sequence is comprised of 23 channels in the frequency band from 2430 MHz to 2452 MHz (channels 30 to 52) Calculating the operational hopping sequence: Step Size D is defined as D(H, S) = 6 + (S-1) x 3 + (H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set. Range: 1-3 H=hopping Sequence. Range: 1-4 D(H, S) = Step Size for Hopping Set H and Hopping Sequence S. Channel calculation: Pi(H, S) = [(i-1) x D (H, S)]modulu23 + 30 Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. I = index. Range: 1-23 Example: H=1, S=3 Step Size Calculation: D (1, 3) = 6 + (3-1) x 3 + (1-1) = 12 Hopping sequence channels calculation: P1(1, 3) = [(1-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 0 mod23 + 30 = 0 + 30 = 30 P2(1, 3) = [(2-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 12 mod23 + 30 = 12 + 30 = 42 P3(1, 3) = [(3-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 24 mod23 + 30 = 1 + 30 = 31 P4(1, 3) = [(4-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 36 mod23 + 30 = 13 + 30 = 43 P5(1, 3) = [(5-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 48 mod23 + 30 = 2 + 30 = 32 P6(1, 3) = [(6-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 60 mod23 + 30 = 14 + 30 = 44 P7(1, 3) = [(7-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 72 mod23 + 30 = 3 + 30 = 33 P8(1, 3) = [(8-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 84 mod23 + 30 = 15 + 30 = 45 P9(1, 3) = [(9-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 96 mod23 + 30 = 4 + 30 = 34 P10(1, 3) = [(10-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 108 mod23 + 30 = 16 + 30 = 46 P11(1, 3) = [(11-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 120 mod23 + 30 = 5 + 30 = 35 P12(1, 3) = [(12-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 132 mod23 + 30 = 17 + 30 = 47 P13(1, 3) = [(13-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 144 mod23 + 30 = 6 + 30 = 36 P14(1, 3) = [(14-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 156 mod23 + 30 = 18 + 30 = 48 P15(1, 3) = [(15-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 168 mod23 + 30 = 7 + 30 = 37 P16(1, 3) = [(16-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 180 mod23 + 30 = 19 + 30 = 49 Manual Revision: 3.0 Appendix F F-11 P17(1, 3) = [(17-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 192 mod23 + 30 = 8 + 30 = 38 P18(1, 3) = [(18-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 204 mod23 + 30 = 20 + 30 = 50 P19(1, 3) = [(19-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 216 mod23 + 30 = 9 + 30 = 39 P20(1, 3) = [(20-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 228 mod23 + 30 = 21 + 30 = 51 P21(1, 3) = [(21-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 240 mod23 + 30 = 10 + 30 = 40 P22(1, 3) = [(22-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 252 mod23 + 30 = 22 + 30 = 52 P23(1, 3) = [(23-1) x 12]mod23 + 30 = 264 mod23 + 30 = 11 + 30 = 41 Hopping sequence channels for Hopping Sequence 3 in Hopping Set 1: 30, 42, 31, 43, 32, 44, 33, 45, 34, 46, 35, 47, 36, 48, 37, 49, 38, 50, 39, 51, 40, 52, 41. Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual F-12 Hopping Standards: Spain Each hopping sequence is comprised of 27 channels in the frequency band from 2447 MHz to 2473 MHz (channels 47 to 73). Basic Hopping Sequence: Hopping Set=1, Hopping Sequence = 1 Index Channel Index Channel 60 14 69 51 15 56 71 16 68 65 17 47 52 18 53 59 19 61 50 20 48 57 21 67 72 22 54 10 66 23 63 11 55 24 49 12 70 25 58 13 62 26 64 27 73 Actual Frequency: (2400+Channel)MHz Calculating the operational hopping sequence: IF [Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)]>73, than Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1)-27, else Pi(H, S) = Pi(1, 1)+(S-1)x3+(H-1) Where: S=Hopping Set Number (1-3) H=hopping Sequence Number (1-9) i =Index Pi(H, S) = Channel with index i in operational sequence with Hopping Set S and Hopping sequence H. Pi(1, 1) = Channel with index i in the basic sequence (Hopping Set 1, Hopping sequence 1). Manual Revision: 3.0 Index 1-1 Index Access Link Parameter Access to DHCP Parameter Access to Network Management Parameter Access Units AU-A/E-NI Accounting Interval Accounting Option Accounting Parameters Menu Acknowledge Delay Limit Parameter ACSE Number Of Retransmissions For Data Parameter ACSE Number Of Retransmissions For Voice Parameter ACSE Option ACSE Option Parameter ACSE Parameters Parameter Add Forwarding VLAN ID Parameter Add Relaying VLAN ID Parameter Advanced Configuration Menu Air Interface Parameters Air Interface Parameters Menu AL In and AL OUT Connectors Alarm Parameters Alarm Parameters Menu Alarms In Names And Status Parameter Alarms In Names Menu Alarms Out Control Menu Alarms Out Names Menu Alarms Out Names, Definitions, Control and Status Parameter Alternate Gatekeeper IP Address Parameter Alternate Gatekeeper Option Parameter Antenna Connection Antenna Diversity Antenna Polarization Antenna Recovery Antenna Seal ARP Broadcast Override Filter Parameter Association Tests AU Alarms AU Alarms Option Parameter AU MAC Address Parameter ..Book 4, 2-59 ..Book 4, 2-37 ..Book 4, 2-53 . Book 1, 2-10 ..Book 4, 2-80 ..Book 4, 2-79 ..Book 4, 2-79 ..Book 4, 2-48 ..Book 4, 2-51 ..Book 4, 2-51 ..Book 4, 2-97 ..Book 4, 2-51 ..Book 4, 2-50 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-36 ..Book 4, E-4 ..Book 4, 2-37 ..Book 3, 3-2 ..Book 4, E-19 ..Book 4, 2-99 ..Book 4, 2-101 ..Book 4, 2-100 ..Book 4, 2-101 ..Book 4, 2-100 ..Book 4, 2-101 ..Book 4, 2-85 ..Book 4, 2-85 . Book 2, 1-12 ..Book 2, 2-4, Book 2, 3-4 ..Book 2, 2-4, Book 2, 3-5 ..Book 4, 2-97, Book 4, 2-98 ..Book 2, 2-4, Book 2, 3-5 ..Book 4, 2-66 ..Book 4, 2-35 ..Book 4, 2-24 ..Book 4, 2-33 ..Book 4, 2-4 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-2 AU Rx Power Decrease Threshold Parameter AU Transmission Rate Control (SU only) AU-A/E-BS Packing List AU-A/E-NI Packing List AU-I/I-D Installation Packing List AU-NI Installation Authentication Algorithm Parameter Authentication Option Authentication Parameters Menu Automatic Alarms Out Definition Menu Automatic Prefix Parameter Automatic Recovery Interval Automatic Recovery Option Bad fragments received Parameter Base Station Equipment Basic Configuration Menu Battery Polarity Parameter Best AU Parameters in SU Parameter Best AU Selection Parameters Best AU Support Parameter BreezeACCESS Introduction BreezeCONFIG BreezeMANAGE Bridge Aging Time Parameter Bridge Parameters Bridge Parameters Menu Broadcast Relaying Parameter BS-AU Installation BS-PS Installation Packing List BS-PS-AC Installation Packing List BS-SH Installation Packing List BS-SH-AC Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index ...Book 4, 2-34 ...Book 4, 2-48 ..Book 2, 1-2 ...Book 1, 2-10 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 3-7 ..Book 2, 3-2 ..Book 2, 1-13 ...Book 4, 2-81 ...Book 4, 2-79 ...Book 4, 2-79 ...Book 4, 2-100 ...Book 4, 2-86 ...Book 4, 2-99 ...Book 4, 2-98 ...Book 4, 2-18 ...Book 1, 2-6 ...Book 4, 2-13 ...Book 4, 2-89 ...Book 4, 2-41 ...Book 4, 2-41 ...Book 4, 2-41 ..Book 1, 1-2 ...Book 1, 2-14 ...Book 1, 2-13 ...Book 4, 2-67 ...Book 4, 2-56, Book 4, E-9 ...Book 4, 2-56 ...Book 4, 2-67 ..Book 2, 1-18 ..Book 2, 1-16 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 1-17 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 1-15 ..Book 2, 1-2 Index 1-3 Packing List Busy Tone Parameter . Book 2, 1-2 ..Book 4, 2-91 Cadence Off Cadence Off Parameter Cadence On Cadence On Parameter Call Aging Time Parameter Called Party Release Timeout Parameter Carrier Sense Level Parameter Carrier to Interference Difference Level Change Password Parameter Change Unit Name Parameter CIR - AU to SU Parameter CIR - SU to AU Parameter Commissioning AL IN and AL OUT Connectors Aligning External SU-I-D Antenna Aligning External SU-R Antennas Aligning SU-A/E Antenna GU-A-BS Maximum Data Rate Positioning SU-I Antennas Positioning SU-R Antennas Compression Efficiency Parameter Configuring Basic Parameters GU-A-BS units RSSI and Maximum Data Rate Congestion Tone Parameter Connecting the unit to the power supply ..Book 4, 2-93 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-49 ..Book 4, 2-93 ..Book 4, 2-70 ..Book 4, 2-73 ..Book 4, 2-10 ..Book 4, 2-9 ..Book 4, 2-76 ..Book 4, 2-76 . Book 3, 3-2 . Book 3, 2-6 . Book 3, 2-6 . Book 3, 2-3 . Book 3, 1-6 . Book 3, 2-2 . Book 3, 2-5 . Book 3, 2-5 ..Book 4, 2-83 . Book 3, 1-5 . Book 3, 1-6 . Book 3, 2-2 ..Book 4, 2-91 ..Book 2, 2-6, Book 2, 3-11 Connectors AL IN and AL OUT Console Speed Parameter . Book 3, 3-2 ..Book 4, 2-4, Book 4, 2-10 ..Book 4, 2-20 Continuous Link Quality Display Counters Ethernet Per-Rate Wireless Link CRC Error Rate Parameters Current Number of Associations Parameter . Book 4, 2-15 . Book 4, 2-23 . Book 4, 2-16 ..Book 4, 2-33 ..Book 4, 2-4 Default Gateway Address Parameter Default Key ID Parameter ..Book 4, 2-36 ..Book 4, 2-82 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-4 Defaults Settings Parameter Delete a Network Management IP Address Parameter Delete a User Filtering Entry Parameter Delete All Network Management IP Addresses Parameter Delete All User Filtering Entries Parameter Destination IP Address Parameter DHCP Broadcast Override Filter Parameter DHCP Client Parameter DHCP Options Parameter Dial Tone Parameter Dialing Parameters Dialing Parameters Menu Dialing Prefix Option Parameter Dialing Prefix Parameter Disconnect Timeout Parameter Display Association Info Parameter Display Bridging & Association Info Display Bridging & Association Info Parameter Display CIR/MIR Info Parameter Display Counters Parameter Display Event Log Parameter Dropped Frames Rate Parameters DTMF Relay Parameter Duplicate frames discarded Parameter Duplicate Frames Rate Parameters Duration Duration Parameter Dwell Time Parameter BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index ...Book 4, 2-6 ...Book 4, 2-54 ...Book 4, 2-74 ...Book 4, 2-54 ...Book 4, 2-74 ...Book 4, 2-19 ...Book 4, 2-66 ...Book 4, 2-37 ...Book 4, 2-37 ...Book 4, 2-91 ...Book 4, E-15 ...Book 4, 2-84 ...Book 4, 2-87 ...Book 4, 2-87 ...Book 4, 2-93 ...Book 4, 2-21 ...Book 4, 2-20 ...Book 4, 2-20 ...Book 4, 2-22 ...Book 4, 2-18 ...Book 4, 2-11 ...Book 4, 2-33 ...Book 4, 2-88 ...Book 4, 2-18 ...Book 4, 2-33 ...Book 4, 2-93 ...Book 4, 2-92 ...Book 4, 2-72, Book 4, 2-97 Echo Cancellation Parameter Endpoint Type Parameter Erase Event Log Parameter Error Tone Parameter ESSID Parameter ESSID Parameters Ethernet Broadcast Filtering Ethernet Counters Ethernet Port Control Event Log Menu Parameter Event Log Policy Parameter ...Book 4, 2-83 ...Book 4, 2-88 ...Book 4, 2-11 ...Book 4, 2-92 ...Book 4, 2-40 ...Book 4, 2-40 ...Book 4, 2-65 ...Book 4, 2-15 ...Book 4, 2-68 ...Book 4, 2-10 ...Book 4, 2-11 Fast Start Parameter Fax Relay Option Parameter Fax Relay Parameter Fax Relay Redundancy Parameter ...Book 4, 2-86 ...Book 4, 2-89 ...Book 4, 2-89 ...Book 4, 2-89 Manual Revision: 3.0 Index 1-5 Filter Options Parameter Flash Memory Control Parameter Flash Type Parameter Flash Versions Parameter Frames dropped (too many retries) Parameter Frequency 1 Parameter Frequency 2 Parameter G711A-law Frames Per Packet Parameter G711u-law Frames Per Packet Parameter G723 Frames Per Packet Parameter G729 Frames Per Packet Parameter Gatekeeper Option Parameter GateKeeper/GateWay IP Address Parameter General RADIUS Parameters Menu GPS and Alarms System Installation GPS and Alarms system Graceful Degradation Limit Parameter GU-A-BS Configuring Installation Packing List GU-BS AL IN and AL OUT Connectors H323 Terminal ID Parameter High Level Error Tone Parameter Hopping Parameters Hopping Parameters Menu Hopping Sequence Hopping Sequences Hopping Set Hopping Standard Australia Canada, Mexico Europe ETSI, US FCC, International France Israel Japan Korea Spain Hopping Sync Hybrid Link Parameter ..Book 4, 2-66 ..Book 4, 2-10 ..Book 4, 2-3 ..Book 4, 2-3 ..Book 4, 2-16 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-84 ..Book 4, 2-84 ..Book 4, 2-84 ..Book 4, 2-84 ..Book 4, 2-84 ..Book 4, 2-85 ..Book 4, 2-78 . Book 2, 1-21 ..Book 1, 2-8 ..Book 4, 2-76 ..Book 1, 2-8 . Book 3, 1-6 . Book 2, 1-21 . Book 2, 1-3 . Book 3, 3-2 ..Book 4, 2-85 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, E-19 ..Book 4, 2-97 ..Book 4, 2-37 ..Book 4, F-1 ..Book 4, 2-38 . Book 4, F-1 . Book 4, F-3 . Book 4, F-4 . Book 4, F-6 . Book 4, F-7 . Book 4, F-8 . Book 4, F-10 . Book 4, F-12 ..Book 4, 2-39 ..Book 4, 2-61 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-6 Info Screens Menu Information Transfer Capability Parameter Installation AU-I/I-D Connecting the Antenna Cable GU-A-BS GPS and Alarms System Indoor Units Modular Base Station Equipment Outdoor Units Pole Mounting Outdoor Units SU-I/I-D SU-NI and AU-NI SU-R SU-R Guidelines Installation Guidelines SU-I/I-D Inter-Digit Timeout Parameter Interference Avoidance Parameters Internally discarded MIR/CIR Parameter International Prefix Parameter Inter-Regional Prefix Parameter Introducing BreezeACCESS IP Address Parameter IP Dialing Indicator Parameter IP Dialing Option Parameter IP Parameters IP Parameters Menu LAN to Wireless Link Bridging Mode Parameter Learning Period Parameter Level 1 Parameter Level 2 Parameter Lightning Protection Locating Units AU-RA AU-RE IF Cable Indoor Equipment SU-RA SU-RE Log Out Timer Parameter MAC Address Black List Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index ...Book 4, 2-3 ...Book 4, 2-86 ..Book 2, 3-7 ..Book 2, 1-12 ..Book 2, 1-21 ..Book 2, 1-13 ..Book 2, 1-15 ..Book 2, 1-7 ..Book 2, 1-9 ..Book 2, 3-7 ..Book 2, 1-13 ..Book 2, 2-5 ..Book 2, 2-3 ..Book 2, 3-4 ...Book 4, 2-93 ...Book 4, 2-72 ...Book 4, 2-18 ...Book 4, 2-87 ...Book 4, 2-87 ...Book 1, 1-2 ...Book 4, 2-36 ...Book 4, 2-85 ...Book 4, 2-85 ...Book 4, E-3 ...Book 4, 2-36 ...Book 4, 2-67 ...Book 4, 2-33 ...Book 4, 2-92 ...Book 4, 2-92 ...Book 2, 2-4, Book 2, 3-5 ..Book 2, 1-5 ..Book 2, 1-5 ..Book 2, 1-6 ..Book 2, 1-6 ..Book 2, 1-5 ..Book 2, 1-5 ...Book 4, 2-10 ...Book 4, 2-7, Book 4, 2-52 Index 1-7 MAC Address Database Main Menu Management Systems BreezeCONFIG BreezeMANAGE Max. Flash Detect Timeout Parameter Maximum ACSE Voice Sessions Parameter Maximum Burst Duration Parameter Maximum Data Rate Configuring Maximum Data Rate Parameter Maximum Delay Parameter Maximum Multicast Rate Parameter Maximum Number of Associations Parameter Maximum RSSI Level Maximum Voice Sessions Parameter Menus Advanced Configuration Air Interface Parameters Alarm Parameters Alarms In Names Alarms Out Control Alarms Out Names Automatic Alarms Out Definition Basic Configuration Bridge Parameters Dialing Parameters Ethernet Broadcast Filtering Hopping Parameters Info Screens IP Parameters Main Network Management Parameters Performance Parameters Security Parameters Service Parameters Show Advanced Parameters Show Alarm Parameters Show All Parameters Show Basic Parameters Show Unit Status Site Survey Telephony Signals Unit Control Voice Parameters Micro-Cell Access Unit Min. Flash Detect Timeout Parameter Minimum Average Number Of SUs Parameter ..Book 4, 2-20 ..Book 4, 2-2 ..Book 1, 2-12 . Book 1, 2-14 . Book 1, 2-13 ..Book 4, 2-93 ..Book 4, 2-51 ..Book 4, 2-76 . Book 3, 2-2 ..Book 4, 2-47 ..Book 4, 2-76 ..Book 4, 2-70 ..Book 4, 2-48 ..Book 4, 2-46 ..Book 4, 2-49 . Book 4, 2-36 . Book 4, 2-37 . Book 4, 2-99 . Book 4, 2-100 . Book 4, 2-101 . Book 4, 2-100 . Book 4, 2-100 . Book 4, 2-13 . Book 4, 2-56 . Book 4, 2-84 . Book 4, 2-65 . Book 4, 2-97 . Book 4, 2-3 . Book 4, 2-36 . Book 4, 2-2 . Book 4, 2-53 . Book 4, 2-69 . Book 4, 2-81 . Book 4, 2-73 . Book 4, 2-5 . Book 4, 2-101 . Book 4, 2-5 . Book 4, 2-5 . Book 4, 2-3 . Book 4, 2-15 . Book 4, 2-91 . Book 4, 2-6 . Book 4, 2-83 ..Book 1, 2-10 ..Book 4, 2-93 ..Book 4, 2-35 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-8 Minimum Contention Window Parameter Minimum Number Of SUs Minimum RSSI Level MIR - AU to SU Parameter MIR - SU to AU Parameter MIR and CIR Parameters MIR/CIR Option Parameter Multi-Rate Decision Window Size Parameter Multi-Rate Support Parameter BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index ...Book 4, 2-70 ...Book 4, 2-27 ...Book 4, 2-46 ...Book 4, 2-75 ...Book 4, 2-75 ...Book 4, 2-74, Book 4, 2-89, Book 4, 2-90 ...Book 4, 2-75 ...Book 4, 2-71 ...Book 4, 2-71 Network Management Filtering Parameter Network Management Parameters ...Book 4, 2-53 ...Book 4, 2-53, Book 4, E-7 Network Management Parameters Menu ...Book 4, 2-53 Networking Equipment ...Book 1, 2-12 No. of Pings Parameter ...Book 4, 2-19 Noise Floor ...Book 4, 2-73 Number of Associations Since Last Reset Parameter ...Book 4, 2-4 Number of Dwells to Retransmit Parameter ...Book 4, 2-69 Number of Failures in Multi-Rate Decision Window Parameter ..Book 4, 2-71 Number of Hopping Frequencies Parameter ...Book 4, 2-97 Number of Retransmissions Parameter ...Book 4, 2-69 Number of Retransmissions to Decrease Rate Parameter ...Book 4, 2-69 Number of Scanning Attempts Parameter ...Book 4, 2-41 Operator ESSID Parameter Outdoor Units Bottom Panel Installation Pole Mounting Overlap Sending ..Book 2, 1-7 ..Book 2, 1-7 ..Book 2, 1-9 ...Book 4, 2-90 Packing Lists AU-A/E-BS AU-A/E-NI AU-I/I-D BS-PS BS-PS-AC BS-SH BS-SH-AC GU-A-BS SU-A/E SU-I/I-D ..Book 2, 1-2 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 3-2 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 1-2 ..Book 2, 1-2 ..Book 2, 1-3 ..Book 2, 1-2 ..Book 2, 3-2 Manual Revision: 3.0 ...Book 4, 2-40 Index 1-9 SU-R Per Hop Statistics Per Trap Control Performance Parameters Performance Parameters Menu Per-Rate Counters Physical Specifications Ping Frame Length Parameter Ping Frame Timeout Parameter Ping Test Ports Control Parameter Power Level Parameter PPPoE Broadcast Override Filter Parameter Precautions Preferred AU MAC Address Parameter Pulse Dialing Parameter . Book 2, 2-2 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-69 ..Book 4, 2-69 ..Book 4, 2-23 ..Book 1, 3-7 ..Book 4, 2-19 ..Book 4, 2-19 ..Book 4, 2-19 ..Book 4, 2-68 ..Book 4, 2-45 ..Book 4, 2-66 ..Book 2, 3-6 ..Book 4, 2-42 ..Book 4, 2-84 RADIUS Parameters RADIUS Parameters Menu RADIUS Record Structure RADIUS Server Accounting IP Address Radius Server Accounting Port RADIUS Server Authentication IP Address Radius Server Authentication Port Rate Parameter Receive Attenuation Control Parameter Registration TTL Parameter Remove Forwarding VLAN ID Parameter Remove Relaying VLAN ID Parameter Reset Counters Parameter Reset Unit Parameter Retransmissions Rate Parameters Ring Frequency Parameter Ring-Back Tone Parameter Ringer Frequency Parameter RSSI Display Option RSSI Memory Factor RTS Threshold Parameter ..Book 4, E-13 ..Book 4, 2-77 ..Book 4, 2-80 ..Book 4, 2-80 ..Book 4, 2-80 ..Book 4, 2-79 ..Book 4, 2-79 ..Book 4, 2-70 ..Book 4, 2-50 ..Book 4, 2-88 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-6 ..Book 4, 2-33 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-91 ..Book 4, 2-92 ..Book 4, 2-23 ..Book 4, 2-46 ..Book 4, 2-69 Save Current Configuration As Operator Defaults Parameter Security Parameters Security Parameters Menu Send AU Aging Trap Send AU Alarms Trap Send AU Loss Of Sync Trap ..Book 4, 2-9 ..Book 4, 2-81, Book 4, E-13 ..Book 4, 2-81 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-56 ..Book 4, 2-55 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-10 Send AU Wireless Quality Trap Send GPS Alarm In Trap Send GPS Alarm Out Trap Send Monitor Status Trap Send Parameter Changed Trap Send Power Up From Reset Trap Send Roaming SNAP Send SNMP Traps Parameter Send SU Associated AU Trap Send SU Associated Trap Send UTC Status Trap Service Parameters Service Parameters Menu Set Factory Defaults Parameter Set Full Operator Defaults Parameter Set Network Management IP Addresses Parameter Set Partial Factory Defaults Parameter Set Partial Operator Defaults Parameter Set User Filter Address Parameter Set User Filter Mask Parameter Set User Filter Range Parameter Shared Secret Show Advanced Parameters Menu Show Alarm Parameters Menu Show All Parameters Menu Show All User Filtering Parameters Parameter Show Basic Parameters Menu Show IP Parameters Parameter Show Ping Test Values Parameter Show Unit Status Menu Site Survey Menu Site Survey Parameters SNMP Traps Community Parameter SNMP Traps IP Destination SNMP Traps IP Destination Parameter SNMP Traps Parameter Specifications AU-A/E-NI AU-I/I-D Configuration and Managemen Data Communication Environmental GU-RA GPS Radio GU-RA to BS-GU Communication IF Indoor Outdoor Communication Modular Base Station Equipmen Physical Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-53 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-73 ...Book 4, 2-73 ...Book 4, 2-6 ...Book 4, 2-9 ...Book 4, 2-54 ...Book 4, 2-6 ...Book 4, 2-9 ...Book 4, 2-74 ...Book 4, 2-74 ...Book 4, 2-74 ...Book 4, 2-78 ...Book 4, 2-5 ...Book 4, 2-101 ...Book 4, 2-5 ...Book 4, 2-74 ...Book 4, 2-5 ...Book 4, 2-37 ...Book 4, 2-20 ...Book 4, 2-3 ...Book 4, 2-15, Book 1, D-2 ...Book 4, E-2 ...Book 4, 2-56 ...Book 4, 2-55 ...Book 4, 2-56 ...Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 1, 3-8 ..Book 1, 3-12 ..Book 1, 3-5 ..Book 1, 3-3 ..Book 1, 3-6 ..Book 1, 3-5 ..Book 1, 3-5 ..Book 1, 3-4 ..Book 1, 3-9 ..Book 1, 3-7 Index 1-11 Radio and Modem Standards Compliance, General SU-A/E SU-I/I-D SU-R Telephony Voice/Fax Start Sending Parameter Statistics Per Hop Traffic Voice Stop Sending Parameter SU Rx Power Decrease Threshold Parameter SU-A/E Aligning Antenna Packing List Subnet Mask Parameter Subscriber Units SU-A/E SU-R SU-I Positioning Antennas SU-I/I-D Installation Installation Guidelines Packing List SU-I-D Aligning External Antennas SU-NI Installation Support All (AU only) SU-R Aligning External Antenna Installation Installation Guidelines Packing List Positioning Antennas SUs System Specifications Telephone Number Parameter Telephony Country Standard Parameter Telephony Signals Telephony Signals Menu Test . Book 1, 3-2 . Book 1, 3-6 . Book 1, 3-7 . Book 1, 3-11 . Book 1, 3-13 . Book 1, 3-4 . Book 1, 3-4 ..Book 4, 2-20 . Book 4, 2-18 . Book 4, 2-15 . Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-20 ..Book 4, 2-34 ..Book 1, 2-2 . Book 3, 2-3 . Book 2, 1-2 ..Book 4, 2-36 ..Book 1, 2-2 . Book 1, 2-2 . Book 1, 2-6 . Book 3, 2-5 . Book 2, 3-7 . Book 2, 3-4 . Book 2, 3-2 . Book 3, 2-6 . Book 2, 1-13 . Book 4, 2-82 ..Book 1, 2-6 . Book 3, 2-6 . Book 2, 2-5 . Book 2, 2-3 . Book 2, 2-2 . Book 3, 2-5 ..Book 1, 2-2 ..Book 1, 3-2 ..Book 4, 2-85 ..Book 4, 2-91 ..Book 4, E-17 ..Book 4, 2-91 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-12 Ping Test Cycle Parameter Timeouts Parameter ToS Precedence Threshold Parameter ToS Priority Parameter ToS Priority Parameters Total received data frames Parameter Total received frames from wireless Parameter Total received frames via Ethernet Parameter Total retransmitted frames Parameter Total submitted frames (bridge) Parameter Total transmitted frames to wireless Parameter Total Tx errors Parameter Traffic Statistics Transmit Antenna Parameter Transmit Power Control Algorithm Transmit Power Control Parameter Transmitted wireless to Ethernet Parameter Trap Send AU Aging Send AU Loss Of Sync Send AU Wireless Quality Send GPS Alarm In Send GPS Alarm Out Send Monitor Status Send Parameter Changed Send SU Associated Send SU Disassociated AU Traps Send AU Alarms Trunk Link Parameter Unicast Relaying Parameter Unit Control Menu Unit Control Parameters Unit Hardware Version Parameter Unit MAC Address Parameter Unit Status - GU Parameter Unit Status - SU Parameter Unit Type Parameter Units Base Station Equipment Subscriber User Filtering Option Parameter User Filtering Parameters Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index ..Book 4, 2-19 ...Book 4, 2-33 ...Book 4, 2-93 ...Book 4, 2-65 ...Book 4, 2-65 ...Book 4, 2-65 ...Book 4, 2-17 ...Book 4, 2-17 ...Book 4, 2-15 ...Book 4, 2-17 ...Book 4, 2-16 ...Book 4, 2-16 ...Book 4, 2-17 ...Book 4, 2-15, Book 4, 2-33 ...Book 4, 2-50 ...Book 4, 2-45, Book 4, 2-47 ...Book 4, 2-44 ...Book 4, 2-15 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-55 ..Book 4, 2-56 ...Book 4, 2-60 ...Book 4, 2-67 ...Book 4, 2-6 ...Book 4, E-1 ...Book 4, 2-3 ...Book 4, 2-3 ...Book 4, 2-5 ...Book 4, 2-4 ...Book 4, 2-3 ..Book 1, 2-6 ..Book 1, 2-2 ...Book 4, 2-73 ...Book 4, 2-73 Index 1-13 User Name User Password ..Book 4, 2-78 ..Book 4, 2-78 VLAN VLAN Forwarding Parameter VLAN Forwarding Support Parameter VLAN ID-Data Parameter VLAN ID-Management Parameter VLAN ID-Voice & Management Parameter VLAN Link Type Parameter VLAN Parameters VLAN Priority - Data Parameter VLAN Priority - Management Parameter VLAN Priority - Voice Parameter VLAN Priority Threshold Parameter VLAN Relaying Parameter VLAN Relaying Support Parameter VLAN Support Parameter VLAN Traffic Priority Parameter Voice Activity Detection Parameter Voice Bytes Received Parameter Voice Bytes Transmitted Parameter Voice Codec Parameter Voice Frames Received Parameter Voice Frames Transmitted Parameter Voice Hardware Version Parameter Voice Packets ToS Parameter Voice Parameters Voice Parameters Menu Voice Port Control Voice Priority Tag Option Parameter Voice Statistics Volume Parameter ..Book 4, 2-56 ..Book 4, 2-61 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-57 ..Book 4, 2-57 ..Book 4, 2-58 ..Book 4, 2-59 ..Book 4, 2-56 ..Book 4, 2-63 ..Book 4, 2-64 ..Book 4, 2-64 ..Book 4, 2-64 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-62 ..Book 4, 2-56 ..Book 4, 2-63 ..Book 4, 2-84 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-83 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-4 ..Book 4, 2-65 ..Book 4, E-14 ..Book 4, 2-83 ..Book 4, 2-68 ..Book 4, 2-61 ..Book 4, 2-18 ..Book 4, 2-83 WEP KEY # Parameter Wireless Link Counters WLAN Aging Time Parameter ..Book 4, 2-82 ..Book 4, 2-16 ..Book 4, 2-49 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual 1-14 Manual Revision: 3.0 BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 Index
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.4 Linearized : No Encryption : Standard V1.2 (40-bit) User Access : Print, Copy, Fill forms, Extract, Assemble, Print high-res Modify Date : 2003:06:01 20:44:46+03:00 Create Date : 2003:06:01 19:18:32Z Keywords : BreezeACCESS 4.3, Version 4.3 Page Count : 346 Creation Date : 2003:06:01 19:18:32Z Mod Date : 2003:06:01 20:44:46+03:00 Producer : Acrobat Distiller 5.0.5 (Windows) Author : Alvarion Metadata Date : 2003:06:01 20:44:46+03:00 Creator : Alvarion Title : BreezeACCESS Version 4.3 System Manual Revision 3.0 Page Mode : UseOutlinesEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools